Analysis B
Analysis B
Analysis B
; 0-470-84578-3 (Electronic)
Analytical Techniques in the Sciences (AnTS) Series Editor: David J. Ando, Consultant, Dartford, Kent, UK A series of open learning/distance learning books which covers all of the major analytical techniques and their application in the most important areas of physical, life and materials sciences. Titles Available in the Series Analytical Instrumentation: Performance Characteristics and Quality Graham Currell, University of the West of England, Bristol, UK Fundamentals of Electroanalytical Chemistry Paul M. S. Monk, Manchester Metropolitan University, Manchester, UK Introduction to Environmental Analysis Roger N. Reeve, University of Sunderland, UK Forthcoming Titles Polymer Analysis Barbara H. Stuart, University of Technology, Sydney, Australia Chemical Sensors and Biosensors Brain R. Eggins, University of Ulster at Jordanstown, Northern Ireland, UK Analysis of Controlled Substances Michael D. Cole, Anglia Polytechnic University, Cambridge, UK
Copyright 2002 University of Sunderland Published in 2002 by John Wiley & Sons, Ltd Bafns Lane, Chichester, West Sussex, PO19 1UD, England National 01243 779777 International (+44) 1243 779777 e-mail (for orders and customer service enquiries): cs-books@wiley.co.uk Visit our Home Page on http://www.wiley.co.uk or http://www.wiley.com All Rights Reserved. No part of this publication may be reproduced, stored in a retrieval system, or transmitted, in any form or by any means, electronic, mechanical, photocopying, recording, scanning or otherwise, except under the terms of the Copyright, Designs and Patents Act 1988 or under the terms of a licence issued by the Copyright Licensing Agency Ltd, 90 Tottenham Court Road, London, W1P 0LP, UK without the permission in writing of the Publisher and the copyright owner, with the exception of any material supplied specically for the purpose of being entered and executed on a computer system, for the exclusive use by the purchaser of the publication. Other Wiley Editorial Ofces John Wiley & Sons, Inc., 605 Third Avenue, New York, NY 10158-0012, USA Wiley-VCH Verlag GmbH, Pappelallee 3, D-69469 Weinheim, Germany John Wiley & Sons Australia, Ltd 33 Park Road, Milton, Queensland 4064, Australia John Wiley & Sons (Asia) Pte Ltd, 2 Clementi Loop #02-01, Jin Xing Distripark, Singapore 129809 John Wiley & Sons (Canada) Ltd, 22 Worcester Road, Rexdale, Ontario M9W 1L1, Canada Library of Congress Cataloging-in-Publication Data Reeve, Roger N. Introduction to environmental analysis/Roger N. Reeve. p. cm. (Analytical techniques in the sciences) Includes bibliographical references and index. ISBN 0-471-49294-9 (cloth: alk. paper) ISBN 0-471-49295-7 (pbk.:alk. paper) 1. Pollutants Analysis. 2. Environmental chemistry. 3. Chemistry, Analytic. I. Title. II. Series. TD193.R44342001 628.5dc21 British Library Cataloguing in Publication Data A catalogue record for this book is available from the British Library ISBN 0-471-49294-9 (Cloth) ISBN 0-471-49295-7 (Paper) Typeset in 10/12pt Times by Laser Words, (India) Ltd. Printed and bound in Great Britain by Antony Rowe, Chippenham, Wiltshire. This book is printed on acid-free paper responsibly manufactured from sustainable forestry in which at least two trees are planted for each one used for paper production. 2001026255
Contents
Series Preface Preface Acronyms, Abbreviations and Symbols About the Author 1 Introduction 1.1 The Environment 1.2 Reasons for Concern 1.2.1 Todays World 1.2.2 Past and Current Crimes 1.3 Pollution 1.4 The Necessity of Chemical Analysis 2 Transport of Pollutants in the Environment and Approaches to their Analysis 2.1 Introduction 2.2 Sources, Dispersal, Reconcentration and Degradation 2.3 Transport and Reconcentration of Neutral Organic Compounds 2.3.1 Bioconcentration 2.3.2 Accumulation in Sediments 2.3.3 Biomagnication 2.3.4 Degradation 2.4 Transport and Reconcentration of Metal Ions 2.4.1 Solubilization
11 11 12 15 16 17 18 19 20 22
viii
Introduction to Environmental Analysis 2.4.2 Deposition in Sediments 2.4.3 Uptake by Organisms What is a Safe Level? Sampling and Sample Variability 2.6.1 Representative Samples 2.6.2 Sample Storage 2.6.3 Critical Paths and Critical Groups General Approach to Analysis The Choice of Laboratory or Field Analysis Quality Assurance 2.9.1 Finding a Suitable Method 2.9.2 Laboratory Standards 22 22 23 24 24 25 26 26 28 30 32 33 35 35 41 46 46 47 54 55 57 59 61 61 68 69 73 77 77 78 80 81 88 101 105 110 112 112 113
2.5 2.6
3 Water Analysis Major Constituents 3.1 Introduction 3.2 Sampling 3.3 Measurement of Water Quality 3.3.1 Suspended Solids 3.3.2 Dissolved Oxygen and Oxygen Demand 3.3.3 Total Organic Carbon 3.3.4 pH, Acidity and Alkalinity 3.3.5 Water Hardness 3.3.6 Electrical Conductivity 3.4 Techniques for the Analysis of Common Ions 3.4.1 Ultraviolet and Visible Spectrometry 3.4.2 Emission Spectrometry (Flame Photometry) 3.4.3 Ion Chromatography 3.4.4 Examples of the Use of Other Techniques 4 Water Analysis Trace Pollutants 4.1 Introduction 4.2 Organic Trace Pollutants 4.2.1 Guidelines for Storage of Samples and their Subsequent Analysis 4.2.2 Extraction Techniques for Chromatographic Analysis 4.2.3 Gas Chromatography 4.2.4 Liquid Chromatography 4.2.5 Immunoassay 4.2.6 Spectrometric Methods 4.3 Metal Ions 4.3.1 Storage of Samples for Metal Ion Analysis 4.3.2 Pretreatment
Contents 4.3.3 4.3.4 4.3.5 4.3.6 4.3.7 Atomic Spectrometry Visible Spectrometry Anodic Stripping Voltammetry Liquid Chromatography Metal Speciation: A Comparison of Techniques
ix 114 124 125 128 131 135 135 138 138 139 140 140 141 141 142 142 142 144 145 146 146 146 148 148 149 150 150 151 152 154 156 156 158 160 161 164
5 Analysis of Land, Solids and Waste 5.1 Introduction 5.2 Common Problem Areas in the Analysis of Solids 5.2.1 Sampling 5.2.2 Pretreatment 5.2.3 Extraction of the Analyte 5.2.4 Sample Clean-up 5.2.5 Analytical Determination 5.2.6 Quality Assurance and Quality Control 5.3 Specic Considerations for the Analysis of Biological Samples 5.3.1 Sampling and Storage of Plant Material 5.3.2 Pretreatment 5.3.3 Extraction Techniques for Organic Contaminants 5.3.4 Ashing and Dissolution Techniques for Trace Metals 5.3.5 Analysis of Animal Tissues 5.4 Specic Considerations for the Analysis of Soils 5.4.1 Sampling and Storage 5.4.2 Pretreatment 5.4.3 Extraction of Organic Contaminants 5.4.4 Extraction of Available Ions 5.4.5 Dissolution Techniques for the Determination of Total Metal Concentrations in Soil 5.4.6 Determination of pH 5.5 Specic Considerations for the Analysis of Contaminated Land 5.5.1 Steps in the Investigation of Contaminated Land 5.5.2 Sampling, Sample Storage and Pretreatment 5.6 Specic Considerations for the Analyses Involved in Waste and its Disposal by Landll 5.6.1 Types of Waste and their Disposal 5.6.2 Sampling and Storage 5.6.3 Pretreatment of Solids and Liquids with a High Solid Content 5.6.4 Analysis of Leachate 5.6.5 Introduction to Gaseous Emissions
Introduction to Environmental Analysis 5.7 Specic Considerations for the Analysis of Sediments and Sewage Sludge 5.7.1 Sampling and Storage 5.7.2 Pretreatment 5.7.3 Extraction Techniques for Organic Contaminants 5.7.4 Dissolution Techniques for Trace Metals 5.7.5 Analysis of Sewage Sludge 5.8 New Extraction and Dissolution Techniques 5.8.1 Automated Soxhlet 5.8.2 Accelerated Solvent Extraction 5.8.3 Microwave Digestion and Microwave-Assisted Extraction 5.8.4 Sonication 5.8.5 Supercritical Fluid Extraction 5.8.6 Comparison of the Techniques 165 165 165 167 167 168 168 169 169 169 170 170 172 175 175 181 183 183 186 189 191 191 199 201 205 206 213 213 216 216 217 218 219 220 222 224
6 Atmospheric Analysis Gases 6.1 Introduction 6.1.1 A Note on Units 6.2 Determination of Time-Weighted Average Concentrations 6.2.1 Absorption Trains 6.2.2 Solid Adsorbents 6.2.3 Diffusion (or Palmes) Tubes 6.3 Determination of Instantaneous Concentrations 6.3.1 Direct-Reading Instruments 6.3.2 Gas Detector Tubes 6.3.3 Gas Chromatography and Mass Spectrometry 6.3.4 Monitoring Networks and Real-Time Monitoring 6.3.5 Remote Sensing and other Advanced Techniques 7 Atmospheric Analysis Particulates 7.1 Introduction 7.2 Sampling Methods 7.2.1 High-Volume Samplers 7.2.2 Personal Samplers 7.2.3 Cascade Impactors 7.2.4 Further Considerations for Organic Compounds 7.2.5 Sampling Particulates in Flowing Gas Streams 7.2.6 PM10 Sampling 7.2.7 Sampling of Acid Deposition
Contents 7.3 Analytical Methods Involving Sample Dissolution 7.3.1 Metals 7.3.2 Organic Compounds 7.4 Direct Analysis of Solids 7.4.1 X-Ray Fluorescence 7.4.2 X-Ray Emission 7.4.3 Neutron Activation Analysis 7.4.4 Infrared Spectrometry 7.4.5 Methods for Asbestos Analysis 8 Ultra-Trace Analysis 8.1 Introduction 8.1.1 What Groups of Compounds are We Discussing? 8.2 Analytical Methods 8.2.1 General Considerations 8.2.2 Factors Affecting Detection Sensitivity 8.2.3 Mass Spectrometric Detection 8.2.4 Quantication 8.2.5 Quality Control 8.3 A Typical Analytical Scheme 8.3.1 Pretreatment 8.3.2 Gas Chromatography Responses to Self-Assessment Questions Bibliography Glossary of Terms Units of Measurement and Physical Constants Periodic Table Index
xi 225 225 226 227 227 229 230 230 230 233 233 234 236 236 237 239 245 246 246 248 250 253 273 279 285 291 293
Series Preface
There has been a rapid expansion in the provision of further education in recent years, which has brought with it the need to provide more exible methods of teaching in order to satisfy the requirements of an increasingly more diverse type of student. In this respect, the open learning approach has proved to be a valuable and effective teaching method, in particular for those students who for a variety of reasons cannot pursue full-time traditional courses. As a result, John Wiley & Sons Ltd rst published the Analytical Chemistry by Open Learning (ACOL) series of textbooks in the late 1980s. This series, which covers all of the major analytical techniques, rapidly established itself as a valuable teaching resource, providing a convenient and exible means of studying for those people who, on account of their individual circumstances, were not able to take advantage of more conventional methods of education in this particular subject area. Following upon the success of the ACOL series, which by its very name is predominately concerned with Analytical Chemistry, the Analytical Techniques in the Sciences (AnTS) series of open learning texts has now been introduced with the aim of providing a broader coverage of the many areas of science in which analytical techniques and methods are now increasingly applied. With this in mind, the AnTS series of texts seeks to provide a range of books which will cover not only the actual techniques themselves, but also those scientic disciplines which have a necessary requirement for analytical characterization methods. Analytical instrumentation continues to increase in sophistication, and as a consequence, the range of materials that can now be almost routinely analysed has increased accordingly. Books in this series which are concerned with the techniques themselves will reect such advances in analytical instrumentation, while at the same time providing full and detailed discussions of the fundamental concepts and theories of the particular analytical method being considered. Such books will cover a variety of techniques, including general instrumental analysis,
xiv
spectroscopy, chromatography, electrophoresis, tandem techniques, electroanalytical methods, X-ray analysis and other signicant topics. In addition, books in the series will include the application of analytical techniques in areas such as environmental science, the life sciences, clinical analysis, food science, forensic analysis, pharmaceutical science, conservation and archaeology, polymer science and general solid-state materials science. Written by experts in their own particular elds, the books are presented in an easy-to-read, user-friendly style, with each chapter including both learning objectives and summaries of the subject matter being covered. The progress of the reader can be assessed by the use of frequent self-assessment questions (SAQs) and discussion questions (DQs), along with their corresponding reinforcing or remedial responses, which appear regularly throughout the texts. The books are thus eminently suitable both for self-study applications and for forming the basis of industrial company in-house training schemes. Each text also contains a large amount of supplementary material, including bibliographies, lists of acronyms and abbreviations, and tables of SI Units and important physical constants, plus where appropriate, glossaries and references to original literature sources. It is therefore hoped that this present series of text books will prove to be a useful and valuable source of teaching material, both for individual students and for teachers of science courses. Dave Ando Dartford, UK
Preface
Interest in the environment continues to expand and develop. It is now very much part of our everyday lives. As a consequence, the need for chemical analysis of the environment continues to grow. This book is a thorough revision and expansion of the ACOL text Environmental Analysis which was rst published in 1994. It is an introduction into how, sometimes familiar, at other times less familiar, chemical analytical techniques are applied to the environment. A knowledge of basic analytical techniques is thus assumed. This could have been acquired, for instance, in the rst two years of an undergraduate programme in chemistry or a related discipline. For the more familiar techniques the emphasis of the book is on the application of the technique, rather than on description of the basic principles. Examples include titration, UV/visible spectrometry and gas chromatography. More specialized techniques which would not be found in more general chemistry textbooks are described in more detail in the text, along with their application(s). Examples of these would be ion chromatography and solid extraction methods. Little more than a background knowledge of the environment is assumed, although an interest to learn about the subject is essential. A glossary, presented at the end of the book, provides a description of some of the less familiar terms. The original (ACOL) book was aimed largely at background monitoring of the environment. Current interest requires a much wider area of coverage, in particular in monitoring liquid and gaseous discharges and surveying areas of past pollution. In this present text there is a larger section on solid sampling and extraction and sections on analysis of contaminated land and landll are also included. More emphasis is placed on source monitoring. There is an expansion of quality assurance and quality control and more detail on quantication of the techniques. A number of techniques which were emerging during the preparation of the original book have now become acceptable as alternatives to more long-standing
xvi
methods. This is particularly the case with solid sample preparation, where a number of automated techniques have been developed and are now nding use in high-throughput laboratories. The monitoring of metals in water has also been transformed in the intervening years with the widespread introduction of inductively coupled plasma mass spectrometry (ICP-MS) and developments in the sensitivity of ICP-optical emission spectrometry (ICP-OES). Interest in eld methods continues to grow, particularly in the area of rapid assessment to minimize the number of samples taken to the laboratory for analysis. This has included developments in techniques unfamiliar to many chemists, such as immunoassay and X-ray uorescence spectrometry. The techniques discussed develop in complexity, starting with simple volumetric measurements for water quality and nishing with ultra-trace analysis. Chapter 1 introduces you to simple concepts needed in the study of the environment, to what we mean by the term pollution and the role of analytical chemistry. Chapter 2 starts by discussing pollution dispersion, reconcentration and nal degradation important concepts to understand when setting up a monitoring scheme. This chapter then goes on to describe simple concepts about sampling and the subsequent analysis, the choice of laboratory or eld analysis, and also introduces quality assurance and quality control. The remaining six chapters, in turn, cover the analysis of water, solid and atmospheric samples. Where there is a choice of techniques available, the questions (SAQs and DQs) guide you into understanding why one specic technique is often preferable. One of the main themes of this book is to demonstrate how an understanding of the principles of the analytical techniques is vital for good analytical choice. Chapters 3 and 4 are devoted to water, while Chapter 5 is concerned with solids and the techniques used to extract pollutants for subsequent analysis. This is an area of great current interest due to concern over waste dumping and potential problems with the reuse of old industrial sites. Chapters 6 and 7 are concerned with sampling and analysis of gases and particulates in external atmospheres, buildings and ues (chimneys or exhausts). Many of the techniques may already be familiar to you in the laboratory, although you will often nd in the instruments very novel applications. Chapter 8 is concerned with the special problems of ultra-trace analysis. A book of this length can only be seen as an introduction to environmental analysis. A bibliography is provided to guide you into more specialized texts in the area and to where you can nd the various standard methods. It also gives examples of current usage of the techniques. I would like to thank many people for their help in the production of this book in particular to Rose Reeve for her support and endurance during its preparation, and for producing the drawings used as a basis for the illustrations in Figures 3.2, 3.4 and 6.3, and in the Response to SAQ 2.2. Some of these drawings are based on scenes around our home in Durham. Thanks are also due to colleagues at the University of Sunderland, to staff at the Environment
Preface
xvii
Agency, Leeds (UK), to Peter Walsh (HSE) for the diagram provided in the Response to SAQ 6.8, to Shirley and Steven Forster, Dorothy Hardy and Colin Edwards and to my students for all that I have learnt from their questioning. I would also like to thank the University of Sunderland for permission to use the following gures from the ACOL Environmental Analysis book: 1.11.3, 2.52.8, 3.53.8, 3.103.12, 3.14, 3.173.19, 4.4, 4.5, 4.9, 4.14, 4.15, 4.20, 4.21, 5.15.3, 6.1, 6.2, 6.4, 6.76.10, 6.12, 6.13, 6.156.17, 6.20, 8.2, 8.3, 8.6 and 8.7. Finally, I hope that this book will be a true introduction to the subject and will lead you into further study in the exciting area of environmental analysis. Roger Reeve University of Sunderland, UK
AAS AC amu ASTM ASV BOD BSI BTEX CFC COD Da DC DDT DOAS EA EDTA EEC ELISA emf EPA EU eV FTIR GC GFAAS GL
atomic absorption spectrometry alternating current atomic mass unit (dalton) American Society for Testing and Materials (USA) anodic stripping voltammetry biochemical oxygen demand British Standards Institute (UK) benzenetolueneethylbenzenexylene(s) chlorinated uorocarbon chemical oxygen demand dalton (atomic mass unit) direct current p, p -dichlorodiphenyltrichloroethane differential optical absorption spectrometry Environment Agency (UK) ethylenediaminetetraacetic acid European Economic Community enzyme-linked immunosorbent assay electromotive force Environmental Protection Agency (USA) European Union electronvolt Fourier-transform infrared gas chromatography graphite furnace atomic absorption spectrometry guide level (EU)
xx GLP GQA HCFC HFC HMIP HMSO HPLC HSE IC ICP i.d. IR ISO J LC LIDAR MAC MDHS MEL MS NAMAS NAQS NIOSH NOx NTIS ODS OECD OES PAH PAN PCB PCDD PCDF PM10 ppb ppm PTFE PVC RF rms sd SFC SFE
Introduction to Environmental Analysis Good Laboratory Practice (OECD) General Quality Assessment (UK) hydrochlorouorocarbon hydrouorocarbon Her Majestys Inspectorate of Pollution (UK) Her Majestys Stationary Ofce (UK) high performance liquid chromatography Health and Safety Executive (UK) ion chromatography inductively coupled plasma internal diameter infrared International Organization for Standardization joule liquid chromatography light detection and ranging maximum admissible concentration (EU) Methods for the Determination of Hazardous Substances (UK) maximum exposure limit (UK) mass spectrometry National Accreditation Management Service (UK) National Air Quality Standard (USA) National Institute of Occupational Safety and Health (USA) NO + NO2 National Technical Information Service (USA) octadecylsilane Organization for Economic Co-operation and Development optical emission spectrometry; occupational exposure standard (UK) polynuclear aromatic hydrocarbon peroxyacetyl nitrate polychlorinated biphenyl polychlorinated dibenzo-p-dioxin polychlorinated dibenzofuran particle with aerodynamic diameter less than 10 m parts per billion (1 part in 109 ) parts per million polytetrauoroethylene poly(vinyl chloride) radiofrequency root mean square standard deviation supercritical uid chromatography supercritical uid extraction
Acronyms, Abbreviations and Symbols SI (units) SOx SPE TDLAS TDS TEOM TEQ TOC TPH TWA UNEP UV V VOC W XRF c e E f I m m/z Mr (X) p Q R t T V z Z 2
xxi
Syst` me International (dUnit` s) (International System of Units) e e SO2 + SO3 solid-phase extraction tuneable diode laser absorption spectroscopy total dissolved solids tapered element oscillating microbalance toxic equivalent concentration total organic carbon total petroleum hydrocarbon time-weighted average United Nations Environmental Programme ultraviolet volt volatile organic compound watt X-ray uorescence speed of light; concentration electronic charge (charge on an electron) energy; electric eld strength (linear) frequency electric current mass mass/charge ratio (mass spectrometry) relative molecular mass (of X) pressure electric charge (quantity of electricity) molar gas constant; resistance time; Student factor thermodynamic temperature electric potential ionic charge atomic number wavelength frequency (of radiation) standard deviation variance
Introduction to Environmental Analysis Roger Reeve Copyright 2002 John Wiley & Sons Ltd ISBNs: 0-471-49294-9 (Hardback); 0-470-84578-3 (Electronic)
Chapter 1
Introduction
Learning Objectives To explain what is meant by the term environment. To identify reasons for concern over the current and future quality of the environment. To appreciate the diversity of pollution. To evaluate the role of chemical analysis in dealing with these problems.
Denitrification N2O
Industrial fixation
Biological fixation
Anyone who has more than a passing interest in the environment has to learn and understand a very broad range of subjects. The purpose of this introduction is rst of all to show how analytical chemistry ts into this broad spectrum, and later to demonstrate how it is an essential part of any scientic study of the environment and its problems. The book then goes on to discuss how analytical chemistry is applied to the three spheres of the environment, namely water, land and atmosphere. In order to understand the environment, we must rst realize that it is never static. Physical forces continuously change the surface of the earth through weather, the action of waves and natural phenomena, such as volcanoes. At the same time, they release gases, vapour and dust into the atmosphere. These can return to the land or sea a great distance away from their sources. Chemical reactions high up in the atmosphere continuously produce ozone which protects us from harmful ultraviolet radiation from the sun. Living organisms also play a dynamic role through respiration, excretion, and ultimately, death and decay, thus recycling their constituent elements through the environment. This is illustrated by the well-known nitrogen cycle (Figure 1.1). There are similar cycles for all elements which are used by living organisms.
Introduction
6
1890
1910
1930
1950
1970
1990
1890
1910
1930
1950
1970
1990
consequential growth in energy consumption shown in Figure 1.3. Not only will the earth be depleted of its resources, with the inevitable environmental damage that will result, but there will almost certainly be a parallel increase in waste produced and in pollution of the earth. The increase in production of carbon dioxide follows an almost identical curve to the energy consumption increase.
Population (billions)
This concern has become heightened by a greater awareness of problems than in previous ages, due to greater ease of communication, which bring news from distant parts of the world. It seems ironic that the greater prosperity of the developed world, giving sufcient leisure time for concern over global problems, but also giving increased resource consumption, is currently a large contributing factor to the problems themselves.
1.3 Pollution
All of us have concepts of what pollution is but have you considered how it may be dened? DQ 1.1 What you would consider to be a denition of pollution?
Introduction Answer The following denition is from the Organization of Economic Cooperation and Development: Pollution means the introduction by man, directly or indirectly, of substances or energy into the environment resulting in deleterious effects of such a nature as to endanger human health, harm living resources or interfere with amenities or other legitimate use of the environment.
Before we concentrate on the chemical aspects of pollution, it is worth remembering that this is not the only form of pollution. Noise is an example of physical pollution. Simply adding water to a river at a different temperature to the ambient can effect life in the river. This is a form of thermal pollution. Pollution is, however, often associated with the introduction of chemical compounds into the environment. Popular opinion usually sees these as unnatural (and therefore harmful) substances. Perhaps one of the best known recent examples was the concern over the emission of chlorouorocarbons (CFCs). These have been used in aerosol sprays and other applications. They are linked with the depletion of ozone in the stratosphere, which could lead to an increase in the intensity of harmful ultraviolet radiation from the sun reaching the earths surface and increasing the incidence of skin cancer. Although the production of CFCs themselves is now banned in developed countries, the existing CFCs will take many years to be removed from the atmosphere and related ozone-depleting compounds (e.g. hydrochlorouorocarbons, (HCFCs)) are still being manufactured. The effects on the ozone layer will therefore remain for many decades. More frequently, problems occur by the release of substances into the environment which are naturally present, with the problem arising simply from an increase in concentration above the natural levels. Carbon dioxide is a natural component of the atmosphere produced by the respiration of living organisms. The potential problem of global warming is primarily associated with an increase in its concentration in the atmosphere as a result of fuel combustion, together with a decrease in the worlds forests which recycle the carbon. Increasing concentrations of a number of other naturally occurring gases, such as methane and nitrous oxide, add to the problem. Nitrates occur naturally as part of the constant cycling of nitrogen in the environment (see Figure 1.1). The over-use of fertilizers can, however, produce a build-up of nitrate in water courses which leads, rst of all, to excessive plant growth, but ultimately to the death of all living species in the water. The process is known as eutrophication. Apart from nitrogen itself, all of these species in the nitrogen cycle have been shown to exhibit environmental problems if their concentration increases greatly above the natural level in water or in the atmosphere. This is summarized in Table 1.1 You should be able to think of many pollution examples of your own. Try grouping the problems into different categories, for instance, whether the pollution is a global problem (e.g. ozone-depletion) or a more local issue (e.g. waste dumping). When you read the next chapter, which deals with the transport of
Table 1.1 Examples of problems caused by excessive concentrations of nitrogen species Species N2 O NH3 NO2 NO3 Problem Contributes to the greenhouse effect and is a potential ozone-depleter Highly poisonous to sh, particularly in its non-protonated form Highly poisonous in water to animals Contributes to eutrophication (excessive plant growth) in watercourses; associated with blue-baby syndrome which can cause fatalities in infants
pollutants, you may nd that you change your mind about some of the problems. Lead pollution, which has been associated with the retardation of intellectual development in children, is normally thought to be a highly localized problem. Increased lead concentrations in the environment, largely from the use of leaded petrol in cars, can be detected hundreds of kilometres from likely sources. DQ 1.2 If a pollutant is discharged into the environment, what causes the effect on individual living organisms: the total amount discharged; its concentration in the environment? Answer It is the concentration which is of concern with respect to individual living organisms. This statement may seem surprising but consider the following facts. All compounds are toxic at high enough concentrations. Even something apparently as innocuous as sodium chloride has adverse effects when present in high concentration. For example, you cannot drink more than a small quantity of sea water without being made ill. Some metals, which are necessary for plant growth when found in small concentrations in the soil, would kill the plant life when found in larger concentrations on, let us say, a waste dump. These include elements such as chromium, cobalt and manganese, and are often known as essential elements. Of course, if we are considering the effect of a particular pollutant on the global environment, we would have to consider the total quantity emitted. Excessive amounts would ultimately increase the background concentration, as is the case with carbon dioxide emissions. It would then appear, that in order to limit the adverse effect of a particular ion or compound, it is necessary to ensure that the concentration in water or in the atmosphere is maintained below a pre-determined safe level. As will be shown in the next section, the establishment of such levels is fraught with difculty. Nonetheless, much of the worlds environmental legislation is drafted in terms of specifying maximum concentration of ions and compounds (Table 1.2).
Introduction
Table 1.2 Extract from European Community Directive 80/778/EEC relating to the quality of water intended for human consumption parameters concerning substances undesirable in excessive amountsa . Reproduced by permission of the Ofcial Journal of the European Communities Parameter Expression of the resultsa NO3 (mg l1 ) NO2 (mg l1 ) NH4 (mg l1 ) N (mg l1 ) O2 (mg l1 ) C (mg l1 ) Guide level (GL) 25 0.05 Maximum admissible concentration (MAC) 50 0.1 0.5 1 Comments
20 Nitrates 21 Nitrites 22 Ammonium 23 Kjeldahl nitrogen (excluding N in NO2 and NO3 ) 24 (KMnO4 ) oxidizability 25 Total organic carbon (TOC)
26 Hydrogen sulde
S (g l1 )
0.1
27 Substances Dry residue extractable in (mg l1 ) chloroform 28 Dissolved or g l1 emulsied hydrocarbons (after extraction by petroleum ether); mineral oils 29 Phenols (phenol C6 H5 OH (g l1 ) index) B (g l1 ) Lauryl sulfate (g l1 )
Undetectable organoleptically
Measured when heated in acid medium The reason for any increase in the usual concentration must be investigated
10
0.5
1000
200
Certain of these substances may even be toxic when present in very substantial quantities.
Introduction to Environmental Analysis DQ 1.3 What are the maximum concentrations that the substances listed in Table 1.2 can be considered to be acceptable in drinking water? Answer These, of course, vary from substance to substance, but you should have noted that most of the maximum admissible concentrations are expressed in units of mg l1 (sometimes called parts per million (ppm)), whereas others are expressed as g l1 (or parts per billion (ppb)).
SAQ 1.1 How would you see the following situations as contributing to pollution problems? 1. 2. 3. 4. An increase in the developed worlds population. Volcanic emissions. Production of methane by cows, as part of their natural digestion. Excessive quantities of nitrate fertilizers used in farming.
Introduction contribution of other chemical compounds, such as nitrogen oxides (NO and NO2 ), to acid rain was only acknowledged several years later. Alternatives to the ozone-depleting CFCs were introduced in the late 1980s and early 1990s. These included hydrouorocarbons (HFCs) which have no ozone-depleting potential. There was little regard originally taken of their large greenhouse-warming effect. Currently, there is much concern over endocrine disruptors, known in the popular press by terms such as gender benders or sex-change chemicals, which have recently been shown to effect the early stages of foetal development in some species. This leads to mixed sexual characteristics, usually seen as the feminization of males. Such compounds are widespread in the environment. Some have long been known to have environmental effects (e.g. polychlorinated biphenyls and the pesticide DDT), while others had been previously considered completely benign (e.g. phthalate esters which are used as plasticizers in PVC materials). 2. Monitoring to Determine the Extent of the Problem As we have already seen, this may either involve analysis of a compound not naturally found in the environment, or determination of the increase in concentration of a compound above the natural level. The determination of natural levels could itself involve a substantial monitoring exercise since these levels may vary greatly with location and season. Large quantities of waste materials have been produced for many centuries, and it may even be a difcult task to assess what an unpolluted environment is. For example, it has been discovered that the highly toxic and potentially carcinogenic compounds commonly referred to as dioxins, which were originally assumed to be completely anthropogenic (man-made), occur naturally at trace levels. 3. Determination of Control Procedures Determination of the most appropriate method should involve testing the options with suitable analytical monitoring. Possibilities include technological methods, such as the use of ue gas desulfurization processes to lower sulfur oxide emissions from coal-red power stations, and socially orientated methods, such as the promotion of the use of public rather than private transport to reduce vehicle emissions. 4. Legislation to Ensure the Control Procedures are Implemented Few pollution control methods are taken up without the backing of national or international legislation. As shown in Table 1.2, this legislation is very often drafted in terms of analytical concentrations. 5. Monitoring to Ensure the Problem has been Controlled A large proportion of current monitoring is to ensure compliance with legislation. This may range from national programmes to conrm air and
10
Introduction to Environmental Analysis water quality to local monitoring of discharges from industries and to the yearly checking of emissions from individual automobiles. Monitoring also provides scientic evidence for possible further developments in legislation.
Have you noticed the cyclical nature of the process which includes monitoring to show that a problem exists, reduction of the problem by control procedures, and monitoring to conrm that the problem has been reduced, with the nal stage leading back to the start for improvement in the control procedures? You should also have noticed that chemical analysis is a necessary component of almost all of the stages!
SAQ 1.2 Consider a factory producing a liquid discharge, consisting partly of side products of the process and partly of contaminants present in the starting materials. What analytical monitoring programme would be useful to assess and control the efuent?
Summary
This introduction answers the question of what is meant by the terms environment and pollution. Pollutants are often materials which are naturally present in the environment, with their adverse effects being caused by concentrations higher than those which would be expected from natural causes. A study of pollution would then involve a large amount of quantitative chemical analysis. Analytical chemistry is also involved in devising pollution control procedures, in drafting legislation and in monitoring the effect of any control procedure. In fact, analytical chemistry is a necessary component in almost all aspects of scientic investigations of the environment, the problems caused by mankind and their possible solution.
Introduction to Environmental Analysis Roger Reeve Copyright 2002 John Wiley & Sons Ltd ISBNs: 0-471-49294-9 (Hardback); 0-470-84578-3 (Electronic)
Chapter 2
Learning Objectives To predict the possible movements of a pollutant in the environment. To suggest sampling locations where high-molecular-mass organic compounds and metals may accumulate. To dene what is meant by the terms critical path and critical group. To introduce sampling and sample variability. To understand the range of methods needed for subsequent chemical analysis. To introduce quality assurance.
2.1 Introduction
We have learnt how the environmental effects of compounds are dependent on their concentration and also that the environment is not static. Materials are constantly being transported between the three spheres of the environment the atmosphere, the hydrosphere and the lithosphere (the earths crust). At each stage of the transportation, the concentration of the compounds will be altered either by phase transfer, dilution or, surprisingly, reconcentration. Before discussing analytical methods, we need to understand these processes so that we can:
12
predict where large concentrations of the pollutant are likely to occur; assess the signicance of measured concentrations of pollutants in different regions of the environment. For this we need to discuss the chemical and physical properties of the pollutant. This will also help us to identify species which may be of particular concern, and to understand why, of the many thousands of ions and compounds regularly discharged into the environment, particular concern often centres on just a few classes.
13
Dust 10 3
Figure 2.1 Transport of lead in the environment; concentrations are given in parentheses. Reproduced with the permission of Nelson Thornes Ltd from Environmental Chemistry 3rd Edition ISBN No 0 7514 04837 rst published in 1998.
in the form of photochemical smog. If the compound is stable, or is only slowly degraded, in the lower atmosphere, as is the case with many chlorine- or brominecontaining compounds, some may eventually reach the stratosphere (the portion of atmosphere at an altitude of 1050 km). Decomposition, promoted by the intensity of low-wavelength radiation at this altitude, initiates a series of chemical reactions which deplete the protective layer of ozone. Distances which are travelled by pollutants in the atmosphere may be as long as hundreds or thousands of kilometres. The movement of sulfur oxides has been studied over distances covering the whole of Europe, and when Mount St. Helens volcano erupted in the USA, the particulate material which was discharged resulted in the production of vivid sunsets several thousand kilometres away. Dispersal of a pollutant in water or in the atmosphere will inevitably lead to a dilution of the pollutant. As we have seen that the effect of a chemical compound in the environment can be related directly to its concentration, you may think that the dispersal process will simply spread out the pollutant such that it could have little effect away from the source. This would especially be the case when we consider that most forms of pollution are eventually broken down by microbial attack, photochemical or other degradation, and so there would be little chance of the concentration building up to toxic levels. Indeed the phrase Dilution is the solution to pollution was often heard in the early days of environmental concern.
14
Introduction to Environmental Analysis DQ 2.1 What factors do you think this statement does not take into account? Answer (a) The possibility that some pollutants can reconcentrate at particular locations or within organisms remote from the original source. (b) The non-degradation or slow degradation of some pollutants so that there is a gradual concentration buildup in the environment at large. (c) Contamination of large areas before sufcient dilution has taken place.
Examples may be given for all these cases, as follows: (a) Toxic metals, such as cadmium, may be found in the organs of shellsh in concentrations up to 2 million times greater than in the surrounding water (Table 2.1). (b) The major constituent of the pesticide DDT (p,p -dichlorodiphenyltrichloroethane) is now a universal contaminant due to its widespread use over several decades and its slow degradation. There is little organic material on the earth which does not contain traces of this at the ng 11 level or greater concentration. (c) Dilution does not take into account localized pollution effects which may occur around discharge pipes or chimneys before dispersion occurs. One of the observed effects of pollution by endocrine disruptors is the feminization of male sh. This particularly occurs close to sewage outfalls where several of the compounds rst enter the environment. The effects of pollution have also been often underestimated in the past. The discharge of sulfur dioxide in gases from tall chimneys was, until recently, seen as an adequate method for its dispersal. The potential problem of acid rain was not considered.
Table 2.1 Examples of metal enrichment in shellsh relative to the surrounding water Metal Cadmium Chromium Iron Lead Manganese Molybdenum Nickel
a
Relative concentration in shellsha 2 260 000 200 000 291 500 291 500 55 500 90 12 000
Water = 1.
15
The following sections will discuss two major categories of pollutants which have caused environmental concern due to their ability to reconcentrate (accumulate) in specic areas and within living organisms. These provide good examples of how a knowledge of the transport of pollutants can be used to determine suitable sampling locations where high concentrations may be expected.
SAQ 2.1 What general physical and chemical properties would you expect in a compound which has become a global pollution problem?
Cl p,p-DDT Dieldrin (an organochlorine pesticide) (an organochlorine pesticide) Cl Cl Cl Cl Cl 2,3,7,8-Tetrachloro-p-dioxin (a dioxin) 2,2,4,5,5-Pentachlorobiphenyl (a polychlorinated biphenyl (PCB)) O Cl Cl Cl O Cl
16
discharged in such great quantities that they can build up globally (as is the case with methane), they will remain local, rather than global, pollutants. We will now discuss the mechanisms by which organic compounds can reconcentrate within organisms, and will discover one of the reasons why it is the compounds of higher relative molecular mass that are of greatest concern.
2.3.1 Bioconcentration
Unless organic compounds contain polar groups such as OH, or NH2 , or are ionic, they will have low solubility in water. Within related groups of compounds, the solubility decreases with increasing molecular mass. As the solubility in water decreases, the solubility in organic solvents increases (Figure 2.3). This increase in solubility is equally true if we consider solubility in fatty tissues in sh and aquatic mammals rather than solubility in laboratory solvents. Any dissolved organic material will readily transfer into fatty tissue, particularly that found in organs in closest contact with aqueous uids, e.g. kidneys. DQ 2.2 What rule can you deduce concerning the solubility of a compound in water, and its ability to accumulate in organisms? Answer We arrive at a very unexpected general rule that the lower the solubility of an organic compound in water, than the greater is its ability
2,4,5,2,4,5-PCB Octanol: water partition coefficient = solubility in octanol/solubility in water 106 DDT 2,4,5,2,5-PCB DDE 105 104 103 102 10 103 Diphenyl ether Carbon tetrachloride Chloroform
Malathion Tetrachlorobenzene
Benzene
102
101
10
102
103
1
104
105
Figure 2.3 Partition coefcients versus aqueous solubilities of environmentally signicant organic compounds. Reprinted with permission from Chiou, C.T., Freed, V.H., Schnedding, D.W. and Kohnert, R.L., Environ. Sci. Technol., 11, 475478 (1977). Copyright (1977) American Chemical Society.
17
104
2,4,2,4-PCB Hexachlorobenzene
103
Biphenyl
p-Dichlorobenzene
Diphenyl ether 102 Tetrachloroethylene Carbon tetrachloride 10 102 101 1 10 102 Solubility in water (mol l1) 103 104
Figure 2.4 Bioconcentration factors versus aqueous solubilities of environmentally significant organic chemicals in rainbow trout. Reprinted with permission from Chiou, C.T., Freed, V.H., Schnedding, D.W. and Kohnert, R.L., Environ. Sci. Technol., 11, 475478 (1977). Copyright (1977) American Chemical Society.
to accumulate in fatty tissues and the greater is the potential for toxic effect. In addition, because the solubility in water decreases with increasing molecular mass for related groups of compounds, we could also deduce that higher-molecular-mass compounds will pose greater aquatic environmental problems than compounds of lower molecular mass. The rule is illustrated in Figure 2.4, where the ability to accumulate in an organism is measured by the bioconcentration factor, as dened in the following equation: Bioconcentration factor = Concentration of a compound in an organism (2.1) Concentration in surrounding water
18
the particle size, then the greater is the accumulation of organic compounds in the sediment. These organics may then be ingested by organisms which feed by ltration of sediments (e.g. mussels, scallops, etc.) or, if the solid is sufciently ne to be held in suspension, by bottom-dwelling sh.
2.3.3 Biomagnication
Animals obtain their food by feeding on other plants or animals. Food chains can be built up where one species is dependent for survival on the consumption of the previous species. If a pollutant is present in the rst organism, then as we proceed down the food chain there will be an increase in concentration in each subsequent species. This is illustrated in Figure 2.5. Although the concept of such food chains is much simplied from the situation which occurs in nature (few species have just one source of food), it does provide an explanation for why the greatest concentration of pollutants is found in birds of prey at the end of the food chain, rather than in organisms in closest contact with the pollutant when originally dispersed.
Concentration of (DDT) pesticide (mg kg 1) Lake water 0.02
Plankton
5.0
Non-predatory fish
Predatory fish
19
2.3.4 Degradation
Even if a compound has a tendency to transfer into organisms by the routes described, it will not build up in concentration within the organism if it is rapidly metabolized. Compounds will break down until a molecule is produced with sufcient water solubility to be excreted. The solubility may be due either to polar groups being attached to the molecule or to its low relative molecular mass. The rate of metabolism is highly dependent on the structure of the molecule. One of the reasons why so many organic compounds of environmental concern contain chlorine atoms is due to the slow metabolism of many of these compounds. If we take p,p -DDT as an example, the metabolism of this compound occurs in two stages, as shown in Figure 2.6. The rst stage is rapid, and normally takes only a few days for completion, while the second stage is extremely slow, taking many months in some species. It is, in fact, the rst degradation product which is often the predominant species in environmental samples. A minor component of
H Cl C CCl3 p,p-DDT
Fast
Cl
Cl
C CCl2 p,p-DDE
Slow
Cl
H Cl C CO2H p,p-DDA Water solubility is increased by the presence of the CO2H group Cl
20
H Cl C
CCl3 o,p-DDT
Fast
commercial DDT is the o,p -isomer. This is metabolized rapidly by the reaction shown in Figure 2.7, and so does not accumulate signicantly in organisms.
SAQ 2.2 Consider a pesticide such as DDT being sprayed on to a eld from an aeroplane. Sketch routes by which the pesticide may disperse from the area of application.
1
1
1 H
1.008
13
3 Al 5
24 25 26 27 28 29 30
3 Cr
51.996 48 54.938 55.847 58.933 58.71 63.546 65.37
4 Mn Fe Co Ni Cu Zn
10
11
12
26.98
Periods
50
Cd
112.40
Sn
118.69
80
82
Hg
200.59
Pb
207.19
21
Figure 2.8 Metals of common environmental concern as found in the Periodic Table.
22
The following paragraphs introduce you to the chemical principles which can govern the transportation of metals in the aquatic environment and give indications as to where high concentrations may be found.
2.4.1 Solubilization
Metals entering the environment are often in an insoluble form in industrial waste, in discarded manufactured products, or as part of naturally occurring mineral deposits. Deposition from the atmosphere is often in the form of insoluble salts. However, the solubility of metals increases with a decrease in pH. Some of the problems of acid rain in causing the death of sh have been attributed to the leaching of toxic metals from the soil, as well as the direct effect of pH on the sh. The use of lead pipes for domestic water supplies is more problematic in areas of soft, acidic water than where the water is hard and slightly alkaline. Solubilization is often aided by the formation of complexes with organic material. These may be anthropogenic (e.g. complexing agents in soap powders) but may also occur naturally. Humic and fulvic acids produced by the decay of organic material can help solubilize metals.
23
Scallop Gills Muscle Fatty tissue Intestine Kidney Gonads Sediment Sea water (mg l1 )
10 24 17 1 1 20
organometallic compounds. These will behave in a similar fashion to the covalent organic compounds described previously and will preferentially accumulate in fatty tissues. The distribution of the metal within an organism is thus very dependent on the individual metal and its detailed chemistry. Compare the distribution of lead and cadmium in shellsh in Table 2.2. DQ 2.3 One metal which is of current environmental concern cannot be described either as a transition metal or as a heavy metal. What is this metal? Answer Aluminium, which is found in great abundance in the aluminosilicate structures of clays, but is usually xed in this insoluble form. When the acidity increases sufciently, this solubilizes the aluminium.
SAQ 2.3 Compare the routes by which high-molecular-mass organic compounds and toxic metals may disperse and reconcentrate in the environment and in organisms.
24
Interpretation of the analytical data needs to be based on the relationship between the analytical concentration and the effect on organisms. This correlation may not be as easy to determine as rst may be thought. Toxicological testing has been performed on many (but by no means all) compounds which produce major environmental problems. The testing is generally under short-term, high exposure (acute exposure) conditions. This may take the form of determining the dose or concentration likely to cause death to a percentage of test organisms. The LD50 test, for example, determines the lethal dose required for the death of 50% of the sample organisms. This testing is, however, not generally relevant to environment problems, where it is much more likely that the exposure is over a long term in small doses or low concentrations (chronic exposure). The effect may be non-lethal, such as a reduction in the rate of growth or an increase in the proportion of mutations in the offspring, but over several generations still leads to a decrease in population of the species. Monitoring of chronic effects may not be easy outside of the laboratory, and may be complicated by the presence of other pollutants, or other uncontrollable effects (e.g. climate). One of the reasons why the environmental problems of p,p -DDT are often discussed is that its initial release in the early 1940s was into an environment largely free from similar pollutants. Possible effects could be readily correlated with analytical concentrations. This is not as easy nowadays as any compound under investigation will invariably be present in organisms as part of a cocktail with other compounds. This leads us to the next problem that the effect of two or more pollutants together may be greater (synergism) or less (antagonism) than that predicted from the two compounds individually. For instance, the effect of sulfur dioxide and dust particles in some forms of smog is much greater than the separate effects of the two components. The toxicity of ammonia in water decreases with a decrease in pH (i.e. with an increase in the hydrogen ion concentration). The ammonium ion, which is the predominant species under acidic conditions, is less toxic than the non-protonated molecule predominating under alkaline conditions. The consequence of this for the interpretation of analytical data is that information on the concentration of secondary components is often as important as the major analysis. This complicates the analytical task signicantly.
25
50
if a factory does not operate at night or over the weekend or if the process producing the efuent is not continuous. Concentrations in soil can be different even in adjacent samples. With water or atmospheric samples the concentrations may change hour by hour, day by day or with the seasons. If you have a look at Figure 2.9, which shows a typical variation of nitrate concentrations at a single location in a river, you will be able to see a cyclical variation over the year. Even some consecutive sampling points are signicantly different, thus showing a large short-term variation. Different analytical results would be found a few kilometres downstream due to transfer of components into and out of the river and the chemical and biological reactions taking place within the river. Any comprehensive sampling strategy would involve taking a number of samples at different times and from different locations to take into account this variability. The strategy will be discussed in each of the following chapters for specic analytes. Analytical results obtained from single samples may have very little meaning.
26
The importance of correct sampling and sample storage cannot be overestimated as no matter how sophisticated the available analytical equipment may be, it can only analyse the sample that is brought into the laboratory. The phrase often used when inaccurate data are sent for computer analysis, i.e. rubbish in. . . . . .rubbish out, is just as applicable to chemical analysis!
27
dioxin and PCB groups of compounds which are routinely monitored at ng l1 concentrations. At the other end of the concentration scale, monitoring is often required in water for components which may be present in tens or hundreds of mg l1 . In these cases, the analysis may not necessarily be specic to individual ions or compounds as the measurements are often concerned with the bulk properties of the water (e.g. acidity and water hardness). These are often known as water quality parameters. DQ 2.4 From your knowledge of analytical techniques, list briey the types of method which may nd use in environmental analysis for organic compounds and metals. Answer The broadest categories which you may have listed are probably: (a) classical methods of analysis, i.e. volumetric methods and gravimetric methods; (b) instrumental methods. You may then have subdivided the instrumental methods, but we will start with these broad divisions. Volumetric analyses (titrations) are rapid, accurate, use simple and inexpensive apparatus, and can be used for direct measurements of the bulk properties. Water hardness, for instance, can be measured by a single titration, regardless of the nature of the ions producing the effect. They are, however, of limited use for concentrations below the mg l1 concentrations, and (although automation is possible) can be labour-intensive. Gravimetric techniques can be of extreme accuracy, but very prone to interference from other species. A high degree of skill is necessary for accurate analyses. These tend to be slow techniques due to the time taken for precipitation, ltration and drying. In the few instances where they are used, gravimetric methods are used as reference methods to check the accuracy of other techniques. Instrumental methods are usually more suited to low concentrations. The linear operating range (i.e. the range in which the reading is directly proportional to the concentration) of instrumentation is generally at the mg l1 level, often corresponding very closely to environmental concentrations. The analysis of the sample is generally rapid, and can easily be automated. You should, however, be aware that sample preparation time and instrument calibration, if not themselves automated, can often be more time-consuming. Accuracy is lower than for the classical techniques, although sufcient for most applications. The majority of
28
the instrumental methods we will be discussing t into one of the following categories: chromatographic methods spectrometric methods electrochemical methods As already mentioned, the methods may be sufciently sensitive for many analyses, often with little sample preparation. Preconcentration of the sample may be used to decrease the lower detection limits of the techniques. In addition, a preanalytical separation stage may be included to remove interfering components. We can then construct a typical analytical scheme which will cover many of the methods discussed in later sections, as follows: Sample extraction Separation of interfering compounds Concentration of extract Analysis Results calculation and assessment You will be able to see that the analytical stage is just one in what can sometimes be a long series of steps. In the following chapters, each step is described for the different sample types of interest. You will nd that there have recently been several advances in terms of sample preparation and in the sensitivity of the analytical stage. These new techniques tend to be faster and more capable of automation than the well established existing techniques and are aimed at highthroughput laboratories. Where new techniques are described, they are compared and contrasted with the existing methods.
Transport and Analysis of Pollutants DQ 2.5 What do you think are the relative merits of laboratory and eld analyses? Answer In the laboratory, the analyses are performed under optimum conditions which will lead to maximum accuracy. Since such analyses are performed in one location, perhaps with a single apparatus, precision will also be maximized. Samples do, however, need to be taken and transported back to the laboratory. There is a time delay in producing the results. Errors may occur from changes which may occur to the sample during storage either by reaction, by loss of sample or by contamination. Laboratories are expensive to build and operate. Field analysis will produce instantaneous results, although the analytical conditions under which they are measured may be far from optimum, even on a sunny and dry day! Analytical accuracy and precision will be expected to be lower than for a laboratory analysis, but errors due to sample storage will be removed. There is the possibility, with suitable equipment, of continuous monitoring in the eld. This is obviously not possible with laboratory analyses.
29
An advantage of eld sampling which you would probably not have considered is that it may be possible to analyse for species in situ which are so reactive that they would not survive transportation to the laboratory. This is particularly the case with reactive atmospheric components. Field analysis could use the following equipment: (i) Portable monitors for specic ions or compounds. Simple monitors (mg/l concentration range) have been available for water samples for many years and have found large-scale use with organizations which need rapid and simple tests for water quality. Newer types of monitors can determine pollutants at g/l concentrations and are often used for screening samples to minimize the number of expensive laboratory analyses. Portable gas monitors are standard for health monitoring and for site analysis. Instruments are available to detect specic pollutants in contaminated and reclaimed land. (ii) More complex instruments which can be left at secure locations or used in mobile laboratories. These have long been used in air analysis where they can be part of networks for monitoring air quality. Mobile laboratories nd use in urban atmosphere investigations and for contaminated and reclaimed land. Continuous monitoring is sometimes undertaken on major rivers, e.g. the Thames and the Rhine. You could also include in this category ship-board laboratories used for marine investigations.
30
(iii) On-line monitors for discharge pipes or ue gases. These may be used to warn of high concentrations in ue gases or aqueous discharges for compliance with the relevant legislation. You should not underestimate the degree of sophistication needed for instruments which must operate automatically in the eld. At the design stage, you would have to consider minimization of the use of consumables, ensuring that the sampling system never becomes blocked and that the measurement device (often spectrometric or electrochemical) can be kept continuously clean. The instrument should be self-calibrating and the results should be automatically logged or transmitted to a remote location. Although the main route for chemical analysis is by laboratory analysis, eld analysis is playing an important and increasing role, particularly for screening. Examples are described in subsequent chapters following discussions of the laboratory methods.
Transport and Analysis of Pollutants DQ 2.7 What areas would you consider to be important in producing an accurate analysis? Answer The sampling procedure should produce a representative sample. The sample should not become contaminated or alter chemically during storage. There should be no contamination of the sample within the laboratory or during the analysis. Any losses in extraction, separation and concentration procedures should be minimized. There should be no interference in the nal analysis from other components in the sample. Results should be correctly calculated and archived for future reference.
31
Most of these concerns would be applicable to any area of analytical chemistry but the potential contamination of the sample during sampling, sample storage or in the analytical determination is of particular importance in environmental analysis. Many of the compounds are universal contaminants and so will be found in the materials used for sample containers, the apparatus used, solvents and even in the laboratory atmosphere. It may be surprising for you to realize that reliable data for the concentrations of trace metals in sea water have only been available for the last two decades. The values that are now accepted can be an order of magnitude lower than the previous best gures. The earlier values were very largely due to the metal ions picked up during the analytical procedure. A second major area of concern in environmental analysis is that of interfering compounds. When working at trace or ultra-trace levels, it is easy for there to be components in the sample which remain unseparated from the analyte even after extensive pretreatment. This would lead to an increase in the analytical result above the true value. From the nature of many environmental samples it can often be very difcult to predict what these potential interferences would be. The samples could include many unexpected components. You may have already come across the terms Quality Assurance and Quality Control. Their precise denition varies between organizations and countries, although the following would be generally acceptable: Quality Assurance the overall methodology needed to minimize the potential errors. Quality Control the measures used to ensure the validity of individual results.
32
Sampling and sample storage procedures which ensure that the sample is truly representative and that it reaches the laboratory unchanged. Sampling and analysis in duplicate. Specications within the analytical scheme for reagent purity and apparatus cleanliness. Repeated checks on the instrument performance or chromatographic resolution. Traceability in any standards used. This means that the stated concentrations in any standard used must be traceable back to primary international standards. Inclusion in each analytical batch of additional samples of known composition. These will conrm the reliability of the method and could include the following: Blank samples samples made up as close as possible in composition to the unknown, excluding the compound being determined. These are introduced before stages in the analysis when contamination is likely. A positive determination of the analyte in the blank would indicate contamination. Spiked samples these are samples to which a known quantity of the compound being determined has been added. A valid analysis of the spiked and unspiked sample will be able to determine accurately the quantity added. Reference samples these are materials which are similar in type to the unknown sample and have an accurately determined composition.
Whenever you are assessing an analytical scheme, look out for quality assurance steps in the analytical procedures. Some examples of these are given in Table 2.3.
For less routine work, you may have to search the literature for investigations similar to your own. The techniques used may need some modication. For example, you may discover a technique which had been investigated and validated for sea water which you need for monitoring fresh water. You should revalidate
33
the methods for your own investigation and sample type before starting the new analytical programme.
34
Summary
Pollutants travel through the environment by routes which can be predicted from their chemical and physical properties. High-molecular-mass neutral organic compounds and many metals are of considerable concern. Such species are capable of reconcentrating in certain areas and within organisms and it is in these areas where they have their greatest effect. An understanding of such routes is needed for the correct choice of sampling positions for the subsequent analytical determinations. Analysis is normally carried out in a laboratory, although eld analyses can sometimes be found useful. An introduction is given in this chapter to the available techniques and the quality assurance necessary to produce reliable data.
Introduction to Environmental Analysis Roger Reeve Copyright 2002 John Wiley & Sons Ltd ISBNs: 0-471-49294-9 (Hardback); 0-470-84578-3 (Electronic)
Chapter 3
Learning Objectives To list the major constituents of environmental waters, their concentrations and to describe how the concentrations may change during passage through the environment. To appreciate the importance of correct methods of sampling and sample storage. To be able to describe methods for the measurement of water quality. To determine the most suitable analytical techniques for the analysis of the major constituents of water.
3.1 Introduction
Water is vital for life. Not only do we need water to drink, to grow food and to wash, but it is also important for many of the pleasant recreational aspects of life. DQ 3.1 List the uses which we can make of water. Answer This should include the following, although you may have thought of some extra ones of your own:
36
Introduction to Environmental Analysis Domestic water supply Industrial water supply Efuent and waste disposal Fishing Irrigation Navigation Power production Recreation, e.g. sailing and swimming
Each different use has its own requirements over the composition and purity of the water and each body of water to be used will need to be analysed on a regular basis to conrm its suitability. The types of analysis could vary from simple eld testing for a single analyte to laboratory-based, multi-component instrumental analysis. Water is found naturally in many different forms. In the liquid state it is found in rivers, lakes and groundwater (water held in rock formations), and also as sea water and rain. As a solid, it is found as ice and snow. Water in the vapour state is found in the atmosphere. You will certainly be familiar with the fact that sea water contains large quantities of dissolved material in the form of inorganic salts but it may come as a surprise that nowhere in the environment can you consider water to be chemically pure. Even the purest snow contains components other than water. DQ 3.2 Write down some of the constituents which you consider might be found in natural river water. Answer Ions derived from commonly occurring inorganic salts, e.g. sodium, calcium, chloride and sulfate ions. Smaller quantities of ions (e.g. transition metal ions) derived from less common inorganic salts, perhaps derived from leaching of mineral deposits. Insoluble solid material, either from decaying plant material, or inorganic particles from sediment and rock weathering. Soluble or colloidal compounds derived from the decomposition of plant material. Dissolved gases. You will probably have written down most of these. The category which many forget to include is the dissolved gases. This, of course, includes oxygen which is so vital in supporting aquatic life. Dissolved gases occur through contact with the atmosphere and through respiration and photosynthesis. A fast
37
owing turbulent river will usually be saturated in atmospheric gases. Respiration of aquatic animals releases energy from foodstuffs, consuming oxygen and producing carbon dioxide, as follows: C6 H12 O6 + 6O2 6CO2 + 6H2 O + energy glucose (3.1)
Photosynthesis by plants reverses this process, producing organic compounds and oxygen from carbon dioxide by using sunlight as an energy source: 6CO2 + 6H2 O + h C6 H12 O6 + 6O2 (3.2)
Oxygen levels in water are depleted by slow oxidation of organic and, in some cases, inorganic material. The presence of large quantities of oxidizable organic material (e.g. from sewage efuents) is often the most serious form of pollution in watercourses. Ions commonly found in the mg l1 concentration range are shown in Table 3.1. Others (e.g. uoride ions) may occur depending on the mineral deposits in the locality. Your list should also have included the compounds derived from decomposition of plant material. Did you include inorganic as well as organic products, as shown in Figure 1.1? Dont forget ammonia. This can occur in water in the 02 mg l1 range. Concentrations never usually increase to greater than these values as ammonia is rapidly oxidized to nitrate. It has signicant toxicity to sh, particularly when it is present as the neutral molecule, rather than when protonated to form the ammonium ion. Now look at Figure 3.1, which shows typical comparative analyses for rain water, river water and sea water. You will nd similar ions in all three, with the only difference being the concentration range. Sea water contains the common ions at the g l1 level, whereas for river and rain water the values are at the mg l1 level. All are easily measurable with modern instrumentation. The situation would be a little different if we tabulated the less common species. The range of ions (particularly metal ions) would be limited in river water by the chemical composition of the rocks over which it was owing. On the other hand, sea water contains trace quantities of virtually every element, with the highest concentrations being found close to the surface and in coastal areas. This is a very complicated analytical matrix indeed.
Table 3.1 Ions found in mg l1 concentrations in natural waters Concentration range (mg l1 ) 0100 025 01 00.1 Cations Ca2+ , Na+ Mg , K
2+ +
38
X15
X400
15 g l1
10
Na
Mg
Ca
Cl
SO4
HCO3
Figure 3.1 Typical comparative analyses for rain water, river water and sea water; note the different scales for each histogram. Reprinted with permission from Gibbs, R.J., Science, 170, 10881090 (1970). Copyright (1970) American Association for the Advancement of Science.
Have you noticed that, although the absolute concentrations within rain water and sea water are very different, the relative concentrations are often very similar, thus giving us a clue as to the origin of these ions? DQ 3.3 Estimate and comment on the concentration ratios of the following in the rain, river and sea water concentrations: Calcium/Chloride and Chloride/Sulfate
Water Analysis Major Constituents Answer Rain, especially when falling close to the sea, has sea water as a major constituent and can often be regarded as diluted sea water.
39
A detailed comparison of the concentration of ions from a large number of rivers, compared with the concentrations in sea water (which appears depleted in a number of elements, including calcium), is one of the methods of studying the complexities of marine chemistry. Unfortunately, further discussion of this is outside the scope of this present book. Water authorities often feel it necessary to analyse a river at many locations along its course. This is because the composition of water is never static. It changes by interaction with the atmosphere and crust, and by chemical and biological processes occurring within the water. This does not even include the possibility of extra material being added in the form of pollution. Let us consider a river owing from its source to the sea. Even at its source, water will contain dissolved salts from the passage of water through the earth to form the river. Some of the natural processes which will affect the constituents are listed below and are also illustrated in Figure 3.2. (i) Weathering of rocks. This will produce an increase in inorganic salt content. The composition may also be affected by interaction with material on the river bed. Clays, often found on river beds, are natural ion exchangers. (ii) Sedimentation of suspended material. As the river progresses downstream it will generally become less turbulent and so less capable of supporting suspended material. (iii) Effect of aquatic life. Consumption and production of oxygen and carbon dioxide by plants has already been mentioned. Living plants will also absorb nutrients (including nitrate and phosphate) necessary for growth. The death and decay of organisms will release ions and also produce suspended material. This will slowly decompose into simpler chemical compounds. If the process proceeded to completion in the presence of oxygen, the nal products would be carbon dioxide and water. At the same time, the oxygen concentration would fall. If the oxygen concentration was already low, then the nal products would include ammonia and methane. Dense beds of vegetation can also very effectively lter out suspended solids. (iv) Aeration. The generation of oxygen by plants is not the only method by which the gas enters water. There is continuous transfer of gases between the atmosphere and water. The oxygen can replenish the oxygen removed by oxidation of organic material.
40
Aeration
(v) Volatilization and evaporation. Low-relative-molecular-mass organic compounds tend to have a high vapour pressure and will be readily lost from water. A signicant percentage of the water itself in the river can be lost through evaporation (the rate depending on the ambient temperature) and this will have the effect of increasing the concentration of all dissolved material in the river. (vi) Additional water volumes. Any water entering from tributaries or directly from overland ow will alter the analytical concentrations and may bring new constituents to the river. Similar considerations should allow you to understand the composition of waters in other areas in the environment. DQ 3.4 Groundwater is sub-surface water in soils and geological formations where the ground has become saturated with water. If held in permeable rock the water can be extracted for use. Keeping in mind the passage of water from the surface, how would you expect the composition of groundwater to be different from surface water?
Water Analysis Major Constituents Answer The groundwater could be more concentrated in salts leached from mineral deposits. During passage through the earth, the water will have been in contact with degradable organic material. This can lower the oxygen content of the water.
41
Even if you disregard the introduction of new compounds by pollution, any environmental water will contain a large number of components. In fact, if you start considering components which may be found at trace levels (less than mg l1 ) the task would be almost impossible as new components are constantly being identied in natural waters. Thankfully, it is very rare that all of the components would need to be analysed. This present chapter includes methods for the analysis of major components of water which may be routinely undertaken by water authorities. Even so, it would be unusual for all of the methods to be used on one sample. Water authorities or others undertaking the analyses will in general have a reasonable idea of what species to expect in the water. Unless there is a specic reason for more complete analysis, the analytical scheme will usually be restricted to components which are likely to cause environmental problems or exceed prescribed limits. Remember that consideration of the analytical process has to start with sampling and sample storage (see Section 2.6 above).
SAQ 3.1 Using the list you produced of likely chemical species in a river, decide which would be likely to increase or decrease downstream from a sampling point close to the source.
SAQ 3.2 Lakes may have a complicated chemical structure. At some times of the year, some lakes can be well-mixed and so will be chemically homogeneous. At other times, there is little movement of water and the lake becomes stratied with the top surface of less dense water heated by the sun, a central layer and a lower more dense layer of colder water. There is little transfer between the layers. What differences in composition in the water would you expect between the top and bottom layers?
3.2 Sampling
Let us now consider developing a sampling programme for a river. The sample or samples (often only 250 or 500 ml each) must be representative of the whole body of water requiring analysis. The sample must also be kept in
42
such a manner that the concentration of the species to be analysed is unchanged during transportation and storage. (i) Before starting, decide on what analyses are required. The analytical techniques to be used will affect the sample size taken, the type of sample bottle and also the method of storage. It will be too late to alter these by the time you get back to the laboratory. You should also conrm that laboratory time is available for analysis of the samples. Sample preservation times should be kept to a minimum (hours to days, depending on the analysis). The maximum holding times may have already been dened in quality assurance schemes (see Section 2.9 above). (ii) Decide on a sampling programme. We have already discussed how the composition of natural water is always changing (see Sections 2.6 and 3.1 earlier). Sometimes the variation in composition may be periodic: Seasonal the concentration is affected by natural growth processes. Weekly a pollutant may only be emitted from a factory during the working week. Daily the concentration of some components may be changed due to biological processes needing the presence of sunlight. You may wish to monitor these regular uctuations but you may be more concerned with the longer-term variation of concentrations. Your sampling programme, the number of samples, and the timing of the sampling will be affected. If you are interested in long-term variations it may be benecial to take samples at the same stage of each periodic cycle, whereas for short-term variations you would take several samples each cycle. DQ 3.5 What regular variations would you expect in concentrations of the following: Dissolved oxygen; Nitrate? Answer Oxygen is produced by photosynthesis in daytime but is consumed by respiration or by oxidation of organic material continuously. There will be a continuous but slow replenishment from the atmosphere. A drop in oxygen concentration during the night would be expected. Variation of nitrate would be more complex. This is a nutrient which is necessary for growth and so if there were no additional inputs it would decrease in the spring growing season and increase in winter; however, if a farmer put an excessive amount of nitrate-containing fertilizer on a
Water Analysis Major Constituents neighbouring eld, there would be a sudden increase in any river into which the eld drained.
43
You should recall Figure 2.9 which gives an example of seasonal nitrate concentration changes. (iii) Decide on the total number of samples you are taking, remembering that each location should be sampled in duplicate. Although it is good practice to start by taking as many samples as you feel necessary for complete monitoring, you do also have to take into consideration the time required for the analyses. It is very common to severely underestimate the time involved in the laboratory analyses. A further consideration if there is to be any statistical treatment of results is that there are sufcient samples for the treatment to be signicant. (iv) Decide on the location of the sampling and the sampling apparatus. If you are to take samples regularly from one location, the rst consideration must be ease of access. Remember that the weather may not always be perfect. Surface water sampling requires little sophistication in sampling apparatus (often directly into a sample bottle or a bucket) but the surface may not be the best location for sampling. It may not provide the most representative sample. There also is the possibility of contamination by surface pollutants. Surface contamination can be largely overcome by inserting the bottle upside down in the water and inverting to ll it from just below the surface. Ideally, however, the river should be sampled further underneath the surface, in its main ow and at similar depths for each sample. A simple sub-surface sampler would be a weighted, stoppered bottle on an attachment line. The stopper is removed at the required depth by a cable. More complex designs, such as the Van Dorn sampler shown in Figure 3.3, are open cylinders with valves at each end and produce less disturbance to the river on sampling. The sampler is sealed by using a weight (messenger) dropped down the attachment line to activate the valve mechanism. If you are monitoring the effect of a discharge into a river, samples should be taken far enough downstream for the discharge to be completely mixed (Figure 3.4). Samples taken further upstream would be unrepresentative as the analysis would depend on how much the discharge had mixed with the river. (v) Decide on the sample volume to be taken to the laboratory and the samplestorage containers. The latter are usually made of glass or polyethylene. However, these materials (and those in the container top) are not as inert as you might think. Polyethylene containers may leach organic compounds into the sample, while glass bottles can leach inorganic species (sodium, silica and other components of the glass). How much you ll the container is also important. If you are analysing volatile material or dissolved gases, the container must always be full. For other components, it is benecial
44
String keeps sampler in open position until released Rubber band under tension in open position Release mechanism activated by messenger
45
not to ll the container completely as the contents can then be more easily mixed before analysis. Try attempting to mix the contents of a completely full container! At this stage, it would also be worthwhile to check the equipment used at all stages of the sampling procedure to ensure that nothing will introduce contamination the sampler itself, funnels and any tubing used. If you are sampling from a motorized boat without care, the boat itself could introduce contamination into the water and may disturb the sediment. (vi) Decide on the method of storage of samples. Standard methods are available for most components to minimize analyte loss. The method varies according to the physical and chemical properties of the species. For example: Nitrate store at 4 C to lower biological degradation. Pesticides store in the dark to avoid photochemical decomposition.
46
Introduction to Environmental Analysis Metal ions acidify the sample to prevent adsorption of metal ions on to the sides of the container. Phenols add sodium hydroxide to lower the volatility. For some analyses (e.g. biochemical oxygen demand see below), no preservation is possible and the analysis should be performed as soon as possible after sampling, keeping the sample cool during transportation to the laboratory. You should note that this may mean different sample storage conditions and storage containers for each analysis.
47
looks distinctly dirty. Even if the particles are chemically inert, their physical properties could cause problems. DQ 3.6 Which physical problems do you think may be caused by suspended solids? Answer 1. They cut down light transmission through the water and so lower the rate of photosynthesis in plants. 2. In less turbulent parts of the river some of the solids may sediment out, thus smothering life on the river bed. You may have guessed that the analysis of suspended solids is by ltration and weighing but you may not realize the laboratory skill which is required until you discover that a typical suspended solid loading for a clean looking stream would be only a few mg l1 . Even sewage discharges in the UK have to conform to conditions with a maximum of 30 mg l1 (after 10-fold dilution of the discharge). Typically, a glass bre lter disc with a 1.6 m pore size would be used with a Hartley lter funnel (Figure 3.5). The paper is clamped inside the funnel to prevent any part of the sample escaping around the side of the lter.
Clamp
Supporting disc
48
for the whole ecosystem. We have already seen how the presence of organic matter can remove oxygen from water by oxidation. Although the process can be written down as a simple chemical reaction, it is, in fact, a microbiological process, known as aerobic decay. This converts the major elements present in plant matter (C, H, N, S) into CO2 , H2 O, NO3 and SO4 2 , respectively. It will perhaps come as a surprise that even if no oxygen is present in the water, organic material will still be broken down. Instead of the material being oxidized, it is reduced. The process is once again microbiological and is known as anaerobic decay. In this case, the nal products are CH4 , NH3 and H2 S. Consideration of the products of anaerobic decay (in particular, their toxicity, smell and ammability) show that this condition should be avoided at all costs in environmental waters. The solubility of oxygen in water is low. Saturated water at 25 C and 1 atm pressure contains 8.54 mg l1 oxygen. The sensitivity of sh to low oxygen is very species-dependent. Salmon can only survive under almost saturated conditions, trout to about 1.5 mg l1 , while carp and tench are more resistant, surviving down to about 0.3 mg l1 oxygen. It is easy to deplete the oxygen content if any material is present which would react rapidly with the oxygen. Such material could be organic, as already discussed, but could also be inorganic. Iron in the form of Fe2+ can deplete oxygen by oxidation to Fe3+ . Natural replenishment by oxygen from the atmosphere can be very slow. DQ 3.7 Which of the following rivers do you think would take up oxygen most quickly? Which would be likely to have the highest oxygen demand? 1. A fast-owing mountain stream. 2. A slowly owing river in a heavily industrialized area. 3. A slowly owing river in unspoilt countryside. Answer The turbulence caused by the fast ow cascading over rocks in the mountains would ensure that oxygen was taken up rapidly and the water saturated with oxygen. It would be unlikely that the river would contain large quantities of organic matter either from vegetation or from industrial efuent. The oxygen demand would be low. The slowly owing river would take up oxygen more slowly as there would be much less turbulence. The heavy industry in the area would be very likely to discharge oxygen-consuming efuent which would increase the oxygen demand of the receiving water. The river in the countryside would be less likely to contain oxygenconsuming efuent but may still possess a signicant oxygen demand from
Water Analysis Major Constituents decaying vegetation and also from any material carried downstream into the area.
49
You should be able to recognize two distinct analyses which could be useful if monitoring environment waters for oxygen: 1. A direct measurement of the oxygen concentration in the sample. This would give an indication of the health of the river at a particular location and at the time of sampling. It would be of less use for assessing the overall health of a river as the oxygen level can vary dramatically with location and with time. 2. A measurement of the amount of material which, given time, could deplete the oxygen level in the river. This is known as the oxygen demand, and gives an indication of the possibility of oxygen depletion which will occur if the oxygen is not replenished. Such a measurement would be much more suitable for determining the overall health of the river since the oxygen demand is unlikely to change suddenly. The analytical techniques used for dissolved oxygen measurement can also be used to measure oxygen demand and so these will be discussed rst. 3.3.2.1 Dissolved Oxygen The determination of oxygen can be either by titration (Winkler method) or by use of an electrode sensitive to dissolved oxygen. The results are either expressed as a simple concentration (mg l1 ) or as a percentage of full saturation. The concentration of oxygen in saturated water is dependent on the temperature, pressure and salinity of the water and would need either to be established from published tables or determined experimentally. The rst problem to overcome is transport of the sample to the laboratory. Without modication to the sample, this would cause sufcient agitation to the water to saturate the sample with oxygen from the air, regardless of its original content. In the Winkler method, the oxygen is xed immediately after sampling by reaction with Mn2+ , added as manganese (II) sulfate, together with an alkaline iodide/azide mixture: Mn2+ + 2OH + 1/2O2 MnO2 (s) + H2 O (3.3)
The iodide is necessary for the analytical procedure in the laboratory and the azide is present to prevent interference from any nitrite ions which can oxidize the manganese (II) ion. The sample completely lls the bottle to ensure no further oxygen is introduced. After transport to the laboratory, the sample is acidied with sulfuric or phosphoric acid. This produces the following reaction: MnO2 + 2I + 4H+ Mn2+ + I2 + 2H2 O (3.4)
50
The released iodine can then be titrated with sodium thiosulfate using a starch indicator: I2 + 2S2 O3 2 S4 O6 2 + 2I (3.5) DQ 3.8 What is the equivalence between the original oxygen and the thiosulfate? Answer The overall reaction is as follows: 2 S2 O3 2 + 2 H + + 1/2 O2 S4 O6 2 + H2 O (3.6 )
i.e. four moles of thiosulfate in the nal titration is equivalent to one mole of oxygen in the sample. The electrode method is used for eld measurements of dissolved oxygen and can also be employed in the laboratory for determination of the Biochemical Oxygen Demand (see below). Several types of systems are available for this purpose, including the Mackereth cell shown in Figure 3.6. In the latter, the current generated by the cell is proportional to the rate of diffusion of oxygen
Lead anode
Silver cathode
Oxygen-permeable membrane Potassium hydroxide solution saturated with potassium hydrogencarbonate O-ring
51
through the membrane, which is in turn proportional to the concentration of the oxygen in the sample. The reactions involved are as follows: at the cathode at the anode 1/2O2 + H2 O + 2e 2OH Pb + 2OH PbO + H2 O + 2e (3.7) (3.8)
Instruments usually read oxygen directly with a scale from 0100% saturation and are calibrated by setting 100% with fully aerated water and 0% with water with no oxygen content (sodium sulte is added to the water). This calibration must be made each time that the electrode is used. 3.3.2.2 Oxygen Demand This can be measured by a number of methods. We will compare these after each of them has been described. Biochemical Oxygen Demand. The method used to measure the biochemical oxygen demand (BOD) attempts to replicate the oxidation conditions found in the environment. In this, the dissolved oxygen level of a fully aerated water sample is rst determined by either of the methods previously described. The measurement is repeated on a sample after it has been left for ve days in the dark in a completely lled container and under standard conditions designed to be ideal to promote microbiological activity (20 C, after adjustment of the pH to between 6.5 and 8.5, with the possible addition of salts containing magnesium, calcium, iron (III) and phosphate as nutrients). Care has to be taken with contaminated or treated waters that no compounds are present which would lower the microbial activity, e.g. chlorine. The latter can be removed by the addition of sodium bisulte. If the sample is expected to have a high oxygen demand, a dilution should be made with well-aerated water (whose oxygen content is known). Ideally, 30% or more of the oxygen should remain at the end of the analysis. The diluent should include nutrient salts, with distilled water alone not being satisfactory. If, for any reason, the sample is thought to be sterile, a seed sample of sewage may be added. If there is no dilution of the sample, then we can write the following: BOD = (initial oxygen concentrationnal oxygen concentration)mg l1 (3.9) Typical BOD values for unpolluted water are of the order of a few mg l1 . Many seemingly innocuous efuents have a very high oxygen demand, as shown in Figure 3.7. If you remember that the saturated oxygen level in water is of the order of 8 mg l1 , then you will be able to see how the introduction of a small quantity of high-strength efuent can deplete the oxygen in many times its own volume of water.
52
Domestic waste Brewing Dairying Farmyard waste
Paper pulping Pharmaceutical production Potato crisp manufacture Smokeless fuel production Wool scouring 0 10 000 20 000 30 000
Chemical Oxygen Demand. The term Chemical Oxygen Demand (COD) relates to a family of techniques which involve reacting the sample with excess oxidizing agent. After a xed period, the concentration of unreacted oxidizing agent is determined either by spectrometry or titration. The quantity of oxidizing agent used can be calculated and the oxygen equivalent then determined. Such methods include the following. Measurement of the two-hour dichromate value. Here, the sample is reuxed with excess potassium dichromate in concentrated sulfuric acid for 2 h: Cr2 O7 2 + 14H+ + 6e 2Cr3+ + 7H2 O (3.10)
Silver sulfate may be included to catalyse the oxidation processes of alcohols and low-molecular-weight acids. Chloride ions give a positive interference by the reaction shown in the following equation. The interference is reduced by the addition of mercury (II) sulfate, with a chloro complex being formed: Cr2 O7 2 + 6Cl + 14H+ 2Cr3+ + 3Cl2 + 7H2 O (3.11)
If the excess dichromate is determined by titration, then iron (II) ammonium sulfate can be used: 6Fe2+ + Cr2 O7 2 + 14H+ 6Fe3+ + 2Cr3+ + 7H2 O (3.12)
Water Analysis Major Constituents DQ 3.9 Given that oxidation by oxygen can be represented by the following: O2 + 4H+ + 4e 2H2 O what is the equivalence between dichromate and oxygen? Answer One mole of Cr2 O7 2 consumes six moles of electrons to produce two moles of Cr3 + . Since each mole of O2 can consume four moles of electrons to make H2 O, then one mole of Cr2 O7 2 is equivalent to 1.5 moles O2 . (3.13)
53
In high-throughput laboratories, commercially available kits may be used which determine the unused dichromate by measuring the absorbance at 620 nm. Semimicro systems are available which allow the test to be performed by using 2 ml aliquots of sample, heating in a sealed tube with premixed reagents. With such systems, 25 analyses can be performed simultaneously. Permanganate tests. In these methods, excess potassium permanganate is added under specied conditions, which can range from three minutes on a steam bath to four hours at room temperature. The unreacted permanganate can be determined by any of a number of techniques, including the liberation of iodine, followed by titration of the latter with thiosulfate, as follows: 2MnO4 + 16H+ + 10I 2Mn2+ + 8H2 O + 5I2 I2 + 2S2 O3
2
(3.14) (3.15)
S4 O6
+ 2I
The confusing number of variations of this method leads to limitation in its use since it is very difcult to obtain comparative inter-laboratory data. The threeminute variant of the test does, however, provide a rapid method of testing a specic water for its oxidizing ability. A comparison of the BOD and COD tests is given in Table 3.2 DQ 3.10 On the basis of the comparisons given in Table 3.2, suggest appropriate applications of the two techniques. Answer BOD Long-term monitoring of natural water. COD Rapid analysis of heavily polluted samples, e.g. industrial efuents. Relationship of Oxygen Demand to Specic Concentrations. If a single organic compound was present in the water and the oxidation reactions proceeded
54
All of these tests will be affected by the presence of inorganic reducing or oxidizing agents, with the former giving positive results, and the latter (possibly) leading to negative results.
to completion, the above methods would give an accurate measurement of its concentration. The determination of known amounts of a single compound can be used in the laboratory to test experimental procedures. Potassium hydrogenphthalate is often used, which is oxidized according to the following equation: C8 H5 O4 K + 15/2O2 8CO2 + 2H2 O + K+ + OH DQ 3.11 What is the COD of a solution containing 0.340 g l1 potassium hydrogenphthalate? Answer The relative molecular mass of potassium hydrogenphthalate = 204 . In 1 l of solution, there are 0.340/204 mol. 1 mol potassium hydrogenphthalate = 7.5 mol oxygen. Therefore, 0.340/204 mol potassium hydrogenphthalate = 7.5 0.340/204 mol oxygen = 7.5 0.340/204 32 1000 mg oxygen = 400 mg Hence, the COD = 400 mg l1 (3.16)
55
can achieve this. All involve the oxidation of the organic matter to carbon dioxide, after prior acidication to remove interference from carbonates. The methods used include the following: (i) Injection of a small quantity of water into a gas stream passing through a heated tube to carry out the oxidation. Measurement using this technique is possible to the mg l1 level. (ii) Wet oxidation by using potassium peroxydisulfate at room or elevated temperatures. This method is about 100 times more sensitive than the heatedtube oxidation approach. The carbon dioxide can then be measured either by absorption in solution and measurement of its conductivity, by reduction to methane and analysis of this gas by ame ionization detection (see Section 4.2 below) or by direct measurement by infrared spectrometry (see Section 6.3 below). Attempts are often made to replace BOD and other oxygen demand measurements with TOC. To understand this, you should note the following advantages: (i) it is a rapid technique; (ii) it would be expected to give highly reproducible results; (iii) it can be easily automated, either for laboratory analysis or for on-line monitoring of efuents.
Hardness in water is due to the presence of polyvalent metal ions, e.g. calcium and magnesium, arising from dissolution of minerals. For instance, the dissolution
56
Acid conditions
Basic conditions
pH [H+]
1 101
3 103
5 105
7 107
9 109
10 11
12
13
1011
Carbonate hard water Water affected by acidic pollutants Soft water Sea water
of limestone involves the equilibria shown in equations (3.19) and (3.20) below. From these equilibria, you should be able to see that the water will then be slightly alkaline: CaCO3 Ca2+ + CO3 2 CO3
2
(3.19) (3.20)
+ H2 O HCO3 + OH
The biological effect of a change in pH can most easily be seen by the sensitivity of freshwater species to acid conditions. Populations of salmon start to decrease below pH 6.5, perch below pH 6.0, and eels below pH 5.5, with little life possible below pH 5.0. The eradication of life can result from a change of little more than 1 pH unit. Chemical effects are also observed. In Section 2.4 above, we discussed how a decrease in pH increases the solubility of metals. The use of lead piping for domestic water supplies becomes of greater concern as the water becomes more acidic. The weathering of minerals, such as limestone or dolomite, by water becomes more rapid with a decrease in pH. A typical procedure for the measurement of pH involves calibration with two buffer solutions spanning the expected pH of the sample, followed by measurement of the sample. The procedures for Alkalinity and Acidity measure, by titration, the quantity of acid or base needed, respectively, to change the pH of a sample to 4.5,
57
corresponding to the methyl orange end-point. From a chemical point of view, this gives a measurement of the buffer capacity (resistance to change in pH) of the water. This resistance to change could be caused, for instance, by the presence of carbonate or hydrogencarbonate ions, as shown by equations (3.21) and (3.22) below. Indeed, the units of alkalinity and acidity are expressed as mg l1 CaCO3 , regardless of the true species producing the effect: CO3 2 + H+ HCO3 HCO3 + H H2 O.CO2 H2 O + CO2
+
(3.21) (3.22)
A high buffer capacity is a useful feature if an acidic or basic pollutant is being added to water, as this will lessen the pH change of the receiving water.
58
HO2C CH2 N HO2C CH2 CH2
Analysis is normally performed by complexometric titration using the disodium salt of ethylenediaminetetraacetic acid (Figure 3.9). This forms a 1:1 complex with divalent metal ions, according to the following: M2+ + H2 EDTA2 M(EDTA)2 + 2H+ (3.23)
where H2 EDTA2 is the di-anion derived from the acid To determine both calcium and magnesium by titration, the pH has to be buffered at pH 10. The end-point is detected by using an indicator such as Erichrome Black T. A calcium-only value can be found by titrating at a higher pH. Under these conditions, the magnesium would precipitate as Mg(OH)2 . The titration estimates the total divalent metal as a molar concentration. Many non-chemists are unfamiliar with molar concentrations and so the quantity is often re-expressed in more familiar terms. However, it would be impossible to convert the value into the more familiar weight concentrations (mg l1 ) without knowing the precise individual concentrations of calcium, magnesium and the other ions. Even then, you would not be able to quote a single gure for the total hardness just a table of individual concentrations. In order to overcome this, the total hardness is expressed in mg l1 units as if it were all calcium carbonate, even if it is due to calcium sulfate, magnesium carbonate or any other polyvalent metal salt. DQ 3.12 Which of the following solutions give 50 mg l1 total hardness? (a) (b) (c) (d) 50 mg l1 MgCO3 21.1 mg l1 MgCO3 + 25 mg l1 CaCO3 50 mg l1 CaSO4 55 mg l1 CaCl2
Answer The concentrations of the above, expressed as molarities (M), are (a) 0.78, (b) 0.5 (0.25 + 0.25), (c) 0.37, and (d) 0.5 mM.
Water Analysis Major Constituents The hardness can be determined by multiplying by the relative molecular mass of calcium carbonate (= 100 ). This gives the total hardness of the solutions as (a) 78, (b) 50, (c) 37, and (d) 50 mg l1 .
59
What values should we expect from environmental samples? Although the terms hard and soft sound very subjective, they have come to be dened within very specic concentration ranges. The denitions used within the United Kingdom are shown in Table 3.3. DQ 3.13 Two unpolluted waters, which have the same pH value of 7.8, are contaminated by approximately the same quantity of acidic pollutant. The pH of one drops sharply, while there is only a small drop with the second. Suggest a reason for the difference and the analyses which could be used to conrm your suggestion. Answer The pH values would suggest hardness, perhaps from the presence of limestone (see Section 3.3.4). The hardness of the solutions could be determined by EDTA titration (see Section 3.3.5). The solution having the smallest pH change indicates a greater buffer capacity and so would be expected to have the greatest hardness.
60
make the measurement. The closest method to this ideal situation is the use of a conductivity cell for dissolved ions, as illustrated in Figure 3.10. Using this method, a low-voltage alternating current is applied across the electrodes. The resistance of the liquid between the electrodes is measured, and is converted to conductivity according to the following formula: L (3.24) AR where K is the conductivity, L the distance between the electrodes (cm), A the surface area of the electrodes (cm2 ), and R the resistance (ohm = siemens (S)1 ) (note that the siemen is the SI unit of electric conductance). The units of conductivity applicable to environmental samples are S cm1 , with a typical value of 200 S cm1 being found for a soft water with a signicant ionic salt content. The cell is calibrated by using solutions of known conductivity. Conductivity is highly temperature-dependent and so care has to be taken that calibration solutions and the unknown sample are at the same temperature. A standard temperature of 25 C is often used. The relationship between conductivity and total salt content is not simple. All ions having the same charge have approximately the same conductivity, but unfortunately most environmental waters contain ions with different charges in varying concentrations. If a series of waters of roughly similar composition is known, an approximate conversion can be made. For many waters in the United Kingdom, the following equation is valid: K= total salt concentration = A conductivity (mg l1 ) where A is a constant in the range 0.55 to 0.80. (3.25)
61
The UK General Quality Assessment (GQA) for rivers has the following limiting parameters: GQA grade A B C D E F Description Very good Good Fairly good Fair Poor Bad Dissolved oxygen (%) 80 70 60 50 20 < 20 BOD (mg l1 ) 2.5 4.0 6 8 15 > 15 Ammonia (mg l1 (N)) 0.25 0.6 1.3 2.5 9 < 9
Why do you consider that these parameters and limiting concentrations are used?
where A is the absorbance of radiation at a particular wavelength (= log(I0 /I)), I0 the intensity of the incident radiation, I the intensity of the
62
Introduction to Environmental Analysis transmitted radiation, the proportionality constant (molar absorptivity (1 mol1 cm1 )), c the concentration of the absorbing species (mol l1 ), and l the pathlength of the light-beam (cm).
If you had difculty in remembering this law, then it would be useful to carry out some revision before proceeding any further. The BeerLambert law is fundamental to many of the techniques that we will be discussing in the following sections. The instruments used to measure the absorption of light can range from sophisticated laboratory instruments which can operate over the whole ultraviolet/visible range to portable colorimeters employing natural visible light, which are used as eld instruments. This makes absorption spectrometry one of the most useful and versatile techniques for an environmental analyst. You might at rst hesitate to believe this last statement. After all, none of the common ions in water absorb light in the visible region of the spectrum. You know this because natural water is usually almost colourless. In addition, the only ions commonly found in water which absorb in the ultraviolet range above 200 nm are nitrate and nitrite. The main use of the technique involves the analysis of light-absorbing derivatives of these ions. This can be carried out for almost all of the common anions (except sulfate), as well as ammonia. We can summarize as follows: Analysis by direct absorption nitrate Analysis after formation of derivative chloride uoride nitrate nitrite phosphate As an example of such an approach, the procedure for phosphate involves the addition of a mixed reagent (sulfuric acid and ammonium molybdate, ascorbic acid and antimony potassium tartrate) to a known volume of sample, making up to the working volume, shaking and leaving for 10 min. A blue-coloured phospho-molybdenum complex is produced, and its absorbance is measured at 725 nm. The chemistry behind the colour-forming reactions has been long established and is well understood. 3.4.1.1 Quantication Ultraviolet/visible spectrometry is the rst technique we have discussed where, at low concentrations, there is a simple linear correlation between the instrument response and the concentration of the unknown. DQ 3.15 How would you set about using this technique for a quantitative analysis?
Water Analysis Major Constituents Answer You would make up a series of standard solutions of known concentration of the unknown and from this construct a calibration curve. The concentration should be within the range over which the BeerLambert law applies and thus a straight-line graph will be produced. Above this range, the calibration will no longer be linear and the solutions should be diluted. The best-t calibration line can readily be calculated by using the method of least-squares found on standard PC spreadsheets or even the most basic scientic calculators. The absorbance of the unknown can then be measured and from this the concentration calculated.
63
This procedure is known as calibration by external standards. We will nd instances in the following sections where the sample matrix can affect the response of the instrument and so external standards may not be the best method to employ. DQ 3.16 Plot a calibration graph from the following data and determine the concentration of phosphorus in the sample: Concentration (g l1 (P)) Absorbance 25 0.058 50 0.149 125 0.370 250 0.683 375 1.060 Unknown 0.426
Answer The least squares line is: Absorbance = 0.002 81 (concentration) + 0.001 04 which gives the unknown concentration as 151 g l1 (P). 3.4.1.2 High-throughput Laboratories You will nd a great diversity of instrumentation based on these chemistries for high-throughput laboratory analysis. A number of instruments are based on continuous ow, with a schematic of a typical system being shown in Figure 3.11. Instead of prior mixing of the reagents for each analysis, streams of each reagent (segmented by air bubbles to diminish premature mixing effects) in narrow-bore tubes are mixed by combining the ows at a T-junction or within a (mixing) cell. A sample is introduced from an automatic sampler as a continuous ow into the reaction stream. The combined ow is then led into a spectrophotometer and the absorption measured. The ows of all of the reagents and samples are controlled from a multi-channel peristaltic pump (Figure 3.12.).
64
Waste
Reaction coil
Spectrometer = 480 nm
Figure 3.11 Schematic of a typical continuous-ow system used for the analysis of chloride ions.
Flexible tubing Fixed surface
Flow produced
65
Other instruments are based on ow-injection techniques where individual aliquots of sample are injected into a continuous ow of water. Colour-forming reagents are then added, also via a continuous-ow system. The mixing of the reagents and samples is dependent on the length and diameter of the tubing. After time being allowed for the formation of the colour, the absorbance of the solution at a specic wavelength is then measured. The response of the instrument is in the form of a peak, with the peak height being proportional to the sample concentration (Figure 3.13). If there is a requirement to analyse more than one of the ions, then discrete analysers may be used. In such systems, the samples are introduced into vials on a rotating carousel. As the carousel rotates, reagents are added and mixed, time is allowed for colour development, and the light absorbance at a specic wavelength is then determined. If the instrument is suitably congured, several different analyses can be performed simultaneously on samples by one instrument. 3.4.1.3 Field Techniques Field techniques are becoming increasingly important for giving immediate measurement of ion concentrations. Un-manned eld stations can be set up by using the automatic procedures described above. Alternatively, portable (often hand-held) instruments may be used.
(a) Continuous-flow (b) Flow-injection
Absorbance
Standards Standards
Sample Sample
Figure 3.13 Typical outputs obtained from (a) continuous-ow and (b) ow-injection analysers.
66
Introduction to Environmental Analysis DQ 3.17 What modications need to be made to the standard apparatus and methods already described for use in portable eld instruments? Answer The procedure for the colour-forming reaction has to be made simple. No one wishes to perform complicated analytical routines on a muddy riverbank! Calibration of the instrument should avoid the use of standard solutions, which, once again, are inconvenient in the eld. The optical components of the instrument should be minimized or, at the very least, be made robust.
Each manufacturer has a different approach to such modications. Colourforming reagents may be pre-measured in the form of tablets, or in solution. As a further simplication, one manufacturer seals the reagents under vacuum in an ampoule. Breakage of the top under water automatically draws the correct sample volume into the ampoule. Coloured glass or moulded plastic standards are often used rather than solutions. These can be in the form of a disc. One manufacturers design contains glasses of different optical density (Figure 3.14). The disc is rotated through the light beam until the colour of the standard glass matches that of the unknown. Alternatively, a moulded plastic cube may be used which has a stepped side to provide a number of possible pathlengths (and hence
(a) Colour disc (b) Colour cube
1 2
9 8 c
e d
3 4 5 6
Figure 3.14 Typical designs of colour standards: (a) colour disc; (b) colour cube.
67
absorbances). The most simple procedure for quantication is by visual comparison of the colour of the standards and the unknown using available sunlight. Alternatively, portable spectrometers are available, often housed in briefcases, along with titration equipment and pH and conductivity electrodes these are known as water quality test kits. 3.4.1.4 A Note on Units The most obvious way of expressing the concentration of ions is as the mass of the ion per unit volume (mg l1 ), but sometimes you will nd other units, most notably as the concentration of the major element within the ion. This alternative method is most common for the nitrogen-containing ions. Nitrate, nitrite, and ammonium are often expressed as mg l1 of NO3 , NO2 and NH4 + , respectively, but can all be expressed as mg l1 of nitrogen (mg l1 N). It then becomes easy to compare the relative concentrations of species without having to use molarities. If all of the ammonia in a water sample which contains a concentration of 2 mg l1 (expressed as nitrogen) is totally converted into nitrate, then the water will contain a nitrate concentration of 2 mg l1 (also expressed as nitrogen). This is easier for a non-specialist to understand than by saying that 3.09 mg l1 NH4 + will produce 8.86 mg l1 NO3 . Difculties can arise because the two systems are sometimes used in parallel. For instance, the UK uses nitrogen (N) concentrations (look back at SAQ 3.4), whereas the European Union (EU) legislation is based on expressing the concentrations as the ions (look back at Table 1.2). A similar difculty arises for phosphorus ions, where in the UK they are expressed as mg l1 P rather than as individual ion concentrations. In this case, the EU system expresses the concentrations as P2 O5 , with these somewhat unexpected units having been long used in agriculture! DQ 3.18 What would be the concentration of the following? (i) 50 mg l1 (NO3 ) expressed as mg l1 (N). (ii) 100 mg l1 (P) expressed as mg l1 (P2 O5 ) and as mg l1 (PO4 3 ). Answer (i) 50 mg l1 NO3 is equivalent to 50/62 mol l1 nitrate = (50 14 )/62 mg l 1 nitrogen = 11.3 mg l 1 N (ii) 100 mg l1 P is equivalent to 100/31 mol l 1 phosphorus = 100/ (31 2 ) mol l 1 P2 The relative molecular mass of P2O5 = (2 31 ) + (5 16 ) = 142 and the relative molecular mass of PO4 3 = 31 + (4 16 ) = 95
68
Introduction to Environmental Analysis Hence, 100 mg l 1 P = (100 142 )/ (31 2 ) mg l 1 P2O5 = 229 mg l 1 P2O5 Similarly 100 mg l 1 P = (100 95 )/31 mg l 1 PO4 3 = 306 mg l 1 PO4 3
69
The suppressor has to provide, uninterruptedly, precisely the correct number of protons for the neutralization. There are a number of methods used to achieve this. All of these are based on the ion-exchange process. One manufacturer uses a continuous suppression system, as shown in Figure 3.16. The eluent passes between cation-exchange membranes, through the
Injection system Eluent reservoir Pump Analytical column Ion suppressor Conducitivity detector
Waste
70
Na+
H2 + OH
Cathode H2O
Cationexchange membrane
Cationexchange membrane
Conductivity detector
detector cell, and is nally recycled on the outside of the membranes. The H+ ions necessary to replace the Na+ ions in the fresh eluent are generated by electrolysis of the recycled eluent, with the H+ ions being generated at the cathode. Other manufacturers use cation-exchange columns which need periodic regeneration. This can be achieved without interruption of the analytical operation of the chromatograph. In one system, there is a carousel of regeneration columns with one column being regenerated while another one is in use. Another system regenerates the column while the following sample is being loaded. Disposable regeneration columns may also be used. The response plotted in the chromatogram is conductivity. As the latter is directly proportional to the concentration of the ion, quantication can be simply
71
carried out by comparison of the peak area of the unknown with that of a standard of similar concentration, i.e. by external standards. For ions of interest in environmental water found at mg l1 concentrations and with a suppressed system the sample would need to be diluted before injection. This, along with ltration, is often the only sample preparation necessary and common ions in water can be determined within the space of a few minutes (Figure 3.17). Non-suppressed ion chromatographs monitor the conductivity of the eluent directly, i.e. without the suppressor. Although the sensitivity is lower than that of suppressed systems, it is still sufcient to determine ions at mg l1 concentrations. Non-suppressed systems have the advantage of being less complex instruments than suppressed chromatographs. Separation columns can be used with a wider range of eluents. The instruments resemble conventional liquid chromatographs (the components being simply pump, analytical column and detector) but often they contain no metal components in contact with the eluent, and with the pumps
Cl SO42
NO3 Conductivity
NO2
HPO42
4 Time (min)
72
designed to operate at lower pressures than is necessary for conventional HPLC. This reects the lower back pressures found with ion chromatography when compared with reversed-phase liquid chromatography. DQ 3.20 What disadvantage can you see in using ion chromatography for a single ion such as chloride or nitrate? Answer The time taken for the analysis will be determined by the elution time of the slowest component (often sulfate or phosphate), rather than the component of interest. A second analysis cannot proceed until all of the ions have eluted. This makes the technique slow in comparison to the methods dedicated to single ions, e.g. continuous-ow or ow-injection analysis. Although most analysis nowadays would use specialized ion chromatographs, conventional high performance liquid chromatography may still nd some application. Methods developed for conventional HPLC can use either a reversedphase column and ion-pair techniques, or an ion-exchange column. Ultraviolet absorbance and conductivity detectors are used. When a conductivity detector is employed, the system becomes similar to the specialized chromatographic set-up without ion suppression which has already been described. The sensitivity is lower in comparison with the specialized system, although it is still sufciently high to analyse common anions at mg l1 concentrations. DQ 3.21 What common anions can be detected by using UV absorbance? Answer Nitrate and nitrite ions absorb in the UV range of the spectrum (see Section 3.4.1 above). HPLC with UV detection is a useful method for these two ions when analyses of other ions are not required. Although the most common use of chromatography is for anions, similar methods have been developed for specialized ion chromatographs for the separation of the common cations (Na+ , K+ , NH4 + , Ca2+ , Mg2+ , etc.) in a single isocratic run. A typical eluent would be methanesulfonic acid. This would allow ion suppression similar to that used for anions, although this may not be necessary at typical natural water concentrations.
73
Sample
Heating mantle
74
proportional to the log of the activity of one particular ion). Although this may appear to be a new technique for you to learn, you are already familiar with one particular ion-selective electrode. A combination pH electrode is simply an ionselective electrode responsive to hydrogen ions and a reference electrode housed in a single body. Ion-selective electrodes are available for most common ions and gases which dissolve as ionic species, although they do have some limitations. Many are prone to interference from other species and thus have poor precision. Even the pH electrode has taken many years of development to produce reliable responses. All of them respond to ionic activity rather than concentration, and so it is essential to add a large excess of an ionic salt to both the standard solutions and the unknown in order that the ionic strength of each solution is identical. Ammonia electrodes are of the gas-sensing type. The ammonia diffuses through a permeable membrane and causes a pH change in a small volume of internal solution, which is sensed by a glass electrode. Prior to measurement, concentrated sodium hydroxide solution is added to the samples and standards. This serves to increase the pH to above 11 to ensure that the ammonia is in the unprotonated form, and also to provide a constant ionic strength. The ammonia electrodes respond only to gaseous alkaline gases. For most environmental applications (except in the analysis of heavily polluted water), there will then be little possibility of interference. Calibration is by external standards. You may wish to compare and contrast these methods with the spectrometric method (see Section 3.4.1 above) which can also be used for ammonia. 3.4.4.2 Fluoride A second electrode which has found widespread use for water analysis is that which detects uoride ions. This is a solid-state electrode where the electrical potential is generated by migration of the ion through a doped lanthanum uoride crystal. This once again gives extremely high specicity to the analyte ion, with the only pretreatment necessary being the addition of buffer solution to maintain constant pH and ionic strength. Alternative techniques for uoride determination are spectrometry (see Section 3.4.1.) and ion chromatography (see Section 3.4.3.). 3.4.4.3 Sulfate There is no direct colorimetric method available for sulfate and ion-selective electrodes for the ion are not very reliable; in fact, the only direct instrumental method is by using ion chromatography. Virtually every other method is based on precipitation of an insoluble sulfate. Barium or 2-aminoperimidinium (Figure 3.19) salts are used for the precipitation. The precipitate formed may then be weighed for a direct determination of the sulfate. This represents one of the few remaining important applications of gravimetric analysis.
75
NH
Other methods using insoluble salt precipitation are indirect, estimating the excess cation after precipitation of the sulfate. Excess barium may be determined by titration (which titration have you already come across which will analyse a divalent metal ion?) or by atomic absorption spectrometry (see Section 4.3.3 below) Excess 2-aminoperimidinium ions may be estimated by visible spectrometry. None of these methods would appear ideal for a high-throughput laboratory. For most samples, sulfate would be the only major sulfur-containing species. Total sulfur in solution, as determined by an elemental sulfur analyser, will then give a good estimate of the sulfate concentration.
SAQ 3.5 Many of the species we have discussed can be analysed by more than one method. Tabulate the common procedures available for each of the major ions found in water.
SAQ 3.6 Consider the techniques you have listed in SAQ 3.5. What criteria would inuence your choice of method?
Summary
The composition of water continuously changes as it travels in the environment. Sampling at a large number of locations is therefore necessary to monitor these changes. Careful choices of locations, sampling time, and sample storage procedures are necessary for reliable monitoring. The quality of water can be assessed by using measurements relating to the overall effects of groups of compounds or ions (water quality parameters), as well as by analysis of the major individual components. Methods for both types of determination have been described. These include both volumetric and instrumental methods.
Introduction to Environmental Analysis Roger Reeve Copyright 2002 John Wiley & Sons Ltd ISBNs: 0-471-49294-9 (Hardback); 0-470-84578-3 (Electronic)
Chapter 4
Learning Objectives To understand the need for extraction and pretreatment in the analysis of trace water components. To chose and apply suitable analytical methods for organic trace pollutants in water. To chose and apply appropriate methods for trace metal analysis in water samples. To understand what is meant by the termspeciation and describe how it may be investigated for metals in water.
4.1 Introduction
Before you started this book, you may have thought that compounds with a concentration in water in the g l1 range would have been of little environmental consequence. The introductory chapters showed how some ions and compounds could have effects signicantly greater than what may have initially been expected from their low environmental concentrations. The two major groups are neutral organic compounds and some metal ions. These materials readily bioaccumulate and thus are found in organisms at concentrations exceeding the background levels by many factors of ten. Another major cause of concern is the presence in water of a number of non-bioaccumulative organic compounds with adverse toxicological properties. For many years, there has been much concern over compounds suspected of being carcinogens. A typical example would be chloroform which can be produced in trace quantities during the disinfection of water by chlorination and which is thought to be harmful at g l1 concentrations. Of more recent
78
concern is the large number of compound types considered to be endocrine disruptors (see Sections 1.4 and 2.3 earlier). These compounds can range from pesticides, through components of common plastics, to active ingredients in the contraceptive pill. In the early days of instrumental analysis the concentrations would have been beyond the capabilities of the available instrumentation and techniques but developments since then have made such analyses routine. This is partly due to the development of more sensitive instrumentation, but also through the development of suitable pretreatment processes. This is required to remove potential interferences and, for many techniques, to increase the analyte concentration to within the instrument sensitivity.
Water Analysis Trace Pollutants Polychlorinated biphenyls Dioxins Endocrine disruptors For more localized pollution problems, we could extend our list of concern to include virtually every organic compound currently in use or production, together with their reaction and degradation products.
79
For the purpose of grouping into suitable analytical techniques, organic pollutants are often classied as being either volatile (e.g. chloroform) and semi-volatile (e.g. most pesticides). The two groups may have different extraction and clean-up methods. DQ 4.2 Analysis of complex mixtures of organics would normally involve the chromatographic separation of the components. Which form of chromatography would you consider most appropriate? Answer As most organic compounds have signicant volatilities even at room temperature, gas chromatography would be expected to be a useful technique. The alternative of high performance liquid chromatography is used only where there are advantages over established gas chromatographic methods, although the number of applications of this technique is increasing. A major area where non-chromatographic methods are used is in the determination of groups of compounds such as phenols, and also of classes of detergents, where the total concentration of the group of substances is required rather than the concentration of individual compounds. DQ 4.3 What technique have you met which could analyse groups of organic compounds? Answer Ultraviolet/visible absorption spectrometry appears ideal. Absorptions are broad and the molar absorptivities often vary little between compounds within groups. A single absorption measurement could be used to determine the total concentration of the group. Although there may be suitable volumetric techniques for individual groups of compounds, they would not be sufciently sensitive for concentrations in the g l1 range.
80
The current desire for eld screening has lead to novel approaches which may not have widespread use in other areas of chemical analysis. These include the use of immunoassays. After dealing with sample storage and extraction, this section will then look at gas chromatographic methods and later discuss the other techniques.
81
of just a few microlitres of solution, and spectrophotometric analysis a few millilitres, the solutions may rst have been extracted from several litres of sample. The precautions necessary to avoid either contamination or loss of material at these low concentrations, during the subsequent analysis, are often not appreciated. A few typical precautions should indicate the caution that is necessary: (i) The analysis should be performed in a laboratory as free as possible from the analyte. Remember that many of these trace contaminants are solvents frequently found in analytical laboratories. (ii) Any stock solvents should be safeguarded, minimizing exposure to the atmosphere and avoiding sample withdrawal with potentially contaminated pipettes or syringes. (iii) Samples and working standards should be placed well away from more concentrated solutions or stock solvents. (iv) As traces of pesticides are commonly found in laboratory solvents, pesticidefree grade solvents should be used for these analyses. (v) Glassware should be scrupulously cleaned or new, if at all possible. Such is the problem of contamination that the practical lower limits of detection can often be limited by the background concentrations of the analyte (or of interfering components) in the reagents or laboratory atmosphere.
82
(ii) The choice of gas or liquid chromatography as the separative technique. (iii) Whether solvent-free methods are preferred. Such methods remove the concern of possible contamination of the laboratory and its atmosphere (health effects and cross-contamination of other samples), contamination of aqueous waste and the cost of disposal of the waste solvent. (iv) The number of samples to be analysed. If you have a large number of samples and are working in a well-equipped laboratory, the techniques which are fully integrated with the chromatograph may be preferable. In a smaller laboratory, dedicated instruments may not be justiable and simpler methods may be preferred. (v) Whether you would wish to perform the eld extractions. The extraction methods are common in many areas of chemical analysis. Try thinking of methods you have already come across before studying the following sections. These methods are summarized in Figure 4.1.
(a) (b) (c) (d)
(e)
(f)
(g)
Figure 4.1 Summary of extraction methods: (a) solvent extraction; (b) solid-phase extraction cartridge; (c) solid-phase extraction disc; (d) head-space analysis; (e) purge and trap; (f) solid-phase microextraction direct; (g) solid-phase microextraction headspace.
83
4.2.2.1 Solvent Extraction In this method, the water sample is shaken with an immiscible organic solvent in which the components are soluble. Hexane and petroleum ether are the most common extraction solvents, although oxygenated and chlorinated solvents are sometimes used. The organic layer is separated and, after drying, is injected into the chromatograph. The extractions can be made selective towards acidic and basic components by altering the pH of the aqueous layer. If the sample is acidied, the basic components are less likely to be extracted, for example: RNH2 + HCl amine, soluble in non-polar solvents RNH3 + Cl amine hydrochloride, less soluble in non-polar solvents
(4.1) Similarly, if the sample is made basic, acidic components are less likely to be extracted, for example: RCO2 H + NaOH carboxylic acid, soluble in non-polar solvents RCO2 Na+ carboxylate salt, less soluble in non-polar solvents
(4.2) When making the choice of extraction solvent, the response of the chromatographic detector should always be considered. Hexane or petroleum ether will appear as the predominant peak in the subsequent chromatogram if a gas chromatograph with ame ionization detection is used. The least interference will be caused if the solvent peak appears before the analyte peaks but there is still a potential problem with peaks resulting from trace impurities in the solvent. Because of this, even analytical-grade solvents may have to be redistilled prior to use. If a selective chromatographic detector is being used, it is possible to use an extraction solvent for which the detector has low sensitivity, e.g. hexane or petroleum ether for electron capture detection with gas chromatography. Aromatic solvents should be avoided if liquid chromatography with ultraviolet detection is to be used. If an unsuitable solvent cannot be avoided (e.g. if a chlorinated or oxygenated solvent is required with subsequent electron capture detection) and the analyte has low volatility, it is possible to evaporate the extract to dryness and redissolve the residue in a compatible solvent. It is, however, better to avoid this if at all possible. Liquidliquid extraction has long been seen as the standard extraction method but in more recently developed procedures it is being replaced by newer techniques such as solid-phase extraction (SPE). These are more rapid and can more easily be automated. 4.2.2.2 Solid-phase Extraction The use of this technique has rapidly increased over the past few years and when developing new procedures may often be the rst-choice method. A short
84
disposable column containing 100500 mg of adsorbent material is used here. The column packing is usually a reversed-phase material similar to that used in high performance liquid chromatography columns. The use of an ODS packing material (which contains octadecylsilane groups chemically bonded on to a silica support) is common. Other materials are available, including ion exchangers and adsorbents such as Florisil. Before use, conditioning of the column is usually necessary this is carried out by passing a small volume of methanol through the column. Preconditioned columns are, however, commercially available. The water sample is then passed through the column by applying mild suction or pressure. The organic components of the sample are retained on the packing material. The column can then be washed with water or another suitable solvent to remove potentially interfering compounds, and air dried if the wash solvent is immiscible with the following solvent. The compounds of interest are then eluted with a few millilitres of a suitable organic solvent. As sample volumes could be several hundred millilitres, a concentration factor of about 100 is routine (Figure 4.2). A wide range of solvents can be used. The best extractants are often those where the polarity of the solvent matches that of the extractant, e.g. hexane could be used for non-polar organochlorine pesticides. The subsequent stage of the analytical procedure could also inuence the choice of solvent. Methanol or acetonitrile are often used if liquid chromatography is to be used as the separation method. The procedure for solid-phase extraction is summarized in Table 4.1.
Adsorbent Sample
Vacuum
85
Manifolds are available which allow processing of a number of samples simultaneously. In addition, SPE set-ups can be directly coupled to HPLC systems. DQ 4.5 What do you consider the advantages of solid-phase extraction over liquidliquid extraction which has now made this the rst-choice method? Answer It is a very rapid process and can easily be automated High concentration factors can easily be achieved Solvent consumption can be much lower There are, however, instances where liquidliquid extraction may still be the method of choice. These are usually when there are solids present or there is a high loading of organic material in the sample (e.g. humic acid) which could block or overload the column. A further development is the use of extraction discs where the adsorbent material is held within the bre structure of a polytetrauoroethylene (PTFE) lter disc. After pre-washing the disc with a portion of the nal eluting solvent and conditioning with methanol, the extraction procedure is simply to pass the sample, by suction, through the lter. The extracted components are then eluted by using a suitable solvent. The advantages of discs over columns include a higher sample throughput (several hundred millilitres of sample may need to be passed through the lter if a high concentration factor is needed) and the lower likelihood of the lter clogging with particles. Some standard methods now include liquidliquid extraction and solid-phase extraction as alternative procedures. 4.2.2.3 Head-space Analysis In this technique, the water sample is placed in a container with a septum seal in the lid and an air space above the sample. The most simple procedure is then, after allowing for the air to equilibrate with the water, to inject an air sample (containing volatile organic components) into the gas chromatograph. This technique overcomes problems found in liquidliquid extraction resulting
86
from solvent interference. The sensitivity towards a particular component will, however, be dependent on its volatility, favouring low-molecular-mass, neutral components. The overall sensitivity of the technique may be increased by heating the sample. Be aware, however, that you are also increasing the vapour pressure of the water and care should be taken to check the water compatibility of the chromatographic column. 4.2.2.4 Purge and Trap Techniques These techniques extract the volatile organic content from the sample by using a purge gas stream. In many instruments, the organics are collected in a short tube of adsorbent material such as activated charcoal or a porous polymer (e.g. Tenax). After the collection period, the tube is ash-heated to release the organics into the gas chromatograph. Other instruments collect the volatile components into a secondary liquid nitrogen cold trap. Rapid heating of this trap then releases the organics into the chromatograph. 4.2.2.5 Solid-phase Microextraction This technique could be seen as using both the principles of solid-phase extraction and head-space sampling. A bre which is originally contained within a syringe needle (Figure 4.3) is exposed either to the stirred sample or to the head-space above the sample. The bre typically consists of fused silica with a coating of polydimethylsiloxane, or alternatively polyacrylate, with the phase being chosen according to the compound being determined. The dissolved components partition between the sample and bre. After equilibration is complete (215 min for liquid samples), the bre is withdrawn into the syringe needle for storage prior to analysis. The method cannot only be used for volatile organics but also for semi-volatile pollutants, such as chlorinated pesticides. Different bres are used. A smallerdepth coating (7 m) is suitable for the semi-volatile compounds, and a thicker (100 m) coating for volatiles. Fibres are also available for the extraction of polar organic compounds (e.g. phenols) which are often very difcult to extract by other techniques. In the case of phenols, sample modication (e.g. lowering the pH and adding sodium chloride) increases the extraction efciency. Subsequent analysis can be carried out by either gas or liquid chromatography. With gas chromatography (GC), the bre is directly introduced into the GC injector inside the syringe and re-exposed once the needle has pierced the injection septum. Most GC systems can be used without modication. Desorption of the organics takes place into the carrier gas, although this can take 2030 s. In order to overcome this problem, a technique known as cryo-focusing is used. The sample is condensed on to the top of the column held at a low temperature, typically 40 C. Rapid heating of the column then releases the sample. At least one manufacturer offers a solid-phase microextraction desorption apparatus integrated with a GC system.
87
88
If the subsequent chromatographic method is high performance liquid chromatography (HPLC), then the compounds can be desorbed by immersion of the bre into a suitable solvent. The solution is then injected into the chromatograph. Injection systems are also available which permit the introduction of the bre directly into the mobile phase, where the latter ows along the length of the bre on to the head of the analytical column. The bres can be re-used as many as 50100 times. The advantages of the technique include its simplicity and low cost of apparatus. As the complete extract is introduced into the chromatograph, this can lead to 100700 lower detection limits than liquidliquid extraction. No solvent is injected and short narrowbore columns can be used with gas chromatography (see Section 4.2.3 above). These columns would become ooded with solvent if used after liquidliquid extraction. The bres can cope with high levels of contamination and so they can be used for dirty samples such as waste water. One disadvantage of the method is that it is an equilibration technique. Extraction of each compound will be different and so calibration is necessary for each of these. In addition, changes in composition of the water samples could alter the extraction equilibria and hence the extraction efciency. DQ 4.6 What are the advantages and disadvantages of immersing the bre into the sample and sampling the head-space? Answer Head-space sampling would give a cleaner extract for volatile and semivolatile samples. Direct immersion is a simpler method but it could suffer from blockages if there are suspended solids in the sample.
89
Detector
Amplifier
Gas chromatography has the advantage over other chromatographic techniques of combining high separation efciencies with the availability of highly specic and sensitive detectors. A high proportion of the separations required can be performed by using just a few stationary phases. The wide range of phases which are available does, however, permit the development of columns for specic problem separations. We will discuss the columns and detectors used for water analysis rst of all, and then present some examples of complete analytical procedures (including sample pretreatment). 4.2.3.1 Detectors The most common detectors used for environmental trace analysis are listed in Table 4.2. The electron capture detector has held a special place within environmental analysis since many of the compounds of concern contain chlorine atoms. Had it not been for the development of this highly sensitive and specic detector (for some compounds, 10100 times more sensitive than ame ionization detection) much of the trace analysis required for these compounds would not have been possible. More recently, mass spectrometry has found use as a sensitive and highly selective detection method. The detector can produce a chromatogram which is selective to a particular mass (or more accurately mass/charge ratio),
90
Typical Application Sensitive universal detector for organic compounds Highly sensitive, specic detector responding to atoms with a high electron afnity e.g. chlorine. Typical analytes are chlorinated pesticides and chlorinated solvents Highly sensitive, specic detector for halogens, nitrogen and sulfur. Typical analytes are pesticides and trihalomethanes Element-specic detector for compounds containing nitrogen and phosphorus. Typical analytes include pesticides Element-specic detector for compounds containing sulfur and phosphorus. Typical analytes include pesticides Specic to compounds with aromatic rings or double bonds. Typical analytes include industrial solvents Highly specic, sensitive detector for all organic compounds. Can also be used for peak identication
thus simplifying the chromatogram greatly and to some extent lessening the requirements for pretreatment. Although the potential of this technique was apparent for many years, its widespread application had to await the development of low-cost bench-top gas chromatograph/mass spectrometer (GCMS) systems (using quadrupole or ion-trap spectrometers) rather than the more expensive and cumbersome combination of separate instruments. Advances had also to be made in the availability of cheap computer data processing and storage facilities to handle the massive amount of information produced from even a single chromatographic separation. This method is becoming increasingly routine and, in many laboratories, GCMS is now the standard technique. Simple applications are described here, particularly in how GCMS can aid quantication, although a more detailed discussion of the technique is left to Chapter 8 (Ultra-Trace Analysis), where its advantages in such applications are of the greatest importance. 4.2.3.2 Columns and Stationary Phases The range of columns available is extensive. In the choice of column for a particular application, not only does the chromatographer have to consider the most appropriate stationary phase but also the column dimensions. The latter not only affects the separation efciency, but must also be considered for compatibility with the detector being used, the method of sample introduction, and the sample type.
91
The column types available can be divided into the following, listed in order of decreasing separation efciency: Narrow-bore Capillary Columns. Typical dimensions: length, 3060 m; i.d., 0.2 mm; ow, 0.4 ml min1 He Wide-bore Capillary Columns. Typical dimensions: length, 1530 m; i.d., 0.53 mm; ow, 2.5 ml min1 He Packed Columns. Typical dimensions: length, 2 m; i.d., 2 mm; ow, 20 ml min1 He Most recent analytical methods for water analysis use the rst two types of column, but you may occasionally nd packed columns in long-established methods or for less-demanding applications. Narrow-bore columns offer the greatest detection sensitivity and are used for analyses close to the limits of detection. The low carrier gas-ow rate is well suited for applications where mass spectrometric detection is used. However, direct sample injection on to the column by using a syringe is not possible as the column would become overloaded. A splitting device is necessary for the introduction of the sample. Wide-bore columns have a larger sample capacity and direct syringe injection is possible. The sample may also be introduced from a sample concentration system such as a purge-and-trap device. The greater sample capacity may be required if a low-sensitivity detector is being used. Wide-bore columns are also less affected by contamination from non-volatile components in the sample and so nd a use with highly contaminated samples, such as waste water. Many of the organic compounds of environmental interest are of high relative molecular mass and have low volatilities. High oven temperatures are necessary for these and consequently silicone polymers are often the favoured stationary phases. Poly(ethylene glycol) columns are also popular. As with other uses of gas chromatography, the best separation efciencies are achieved when the stationary phase has a similar polarity to the components of the analyte. Fuel oils are separated on non-polar columns (e.g. dimethylsilicone), pesticides and chlorinated solvents are often separated on medium-polarity columns (e.g. diphenyl/dimethyl silicone), whereas 2,3,7,8-tetrachlorodibenzo-p-dioxin can be separated from its isomers by using highly polar columns (e.g. cyanopropyl silicone). The stationary phase may be adsorbed or chemically bonded on to the column walls of capillary and wide-bore columns, or on to a support material in packed columns. For analyses close to the limit of detection and at high oven temperatures, column bleeding may become a signicant factor. The use of low-loaded columns (0.10.25 m lm thickness), or chemically bonded phases may reduce this effect. A higher loading of columns (15 m lm thickness) is possible at lower temperatures for the analysis of volatile compounds. Thicker lms have higher sample capacities for highly concentrated components, but there is a corresponding decrease in column efciency when compared to thinner lms.
92 DQ 4.8
How would you conrm that a peak is due to a single component rather than two components with identical retention times?
Answer A chromatogram should be produced on two columns of different polarities. It would be unlikely that the peaks would remain unresolved on both columns. Many standard procedures specify the use of two columns, with the second column being known as the conrmational column. It is for this type of problem that capillary columns show their greatest advantage over packed columns. Their greater separation efciency reduces the probability of unresolved peaks. 4.2.3.3 Injection Methods If you are using a narrow-bore capillary, then a device is needed to reduce the microlitre volumes injected by syringe to the nanolitre volumes which the column can accept without overloading. A number of techniques are available, including those summarized below. The rst two methods use a split/spilt-less injector (an injection system which can be used in either of the two modes), whereas the third requires a modied form which has simple temperature programming. With split injection, the sample from the syringe is introduced into a vaporizing chamber which is maintained at a high temperature and has a lateral throughow of gas. Only a small fraction of the sample enters the column, with the rest escaping to the atmosphere through an outlet valve. With split-less injection, the full sample is vaporized before introduction into the column, which is held at a temperature below the boiling point of the solvent. This concentrates (focuses) the sample in a small section of the capillary so that when the temperature programme is begun the solvent elutes as a narrow band without interfering with the analyte peaks. Apart from venting the gases at the end of the transfer on to the column, the whole sample is transferred. This makes the technique more sensitive than the split method. The nal technique, i.e. large-volume injection, is useful for trace analysis, as a concentration stage is included. Up to 250 l of sample is slowly injected on to a cold short column which may be packed by capillaries or packing material. Most or all of the solvent is slowly vaporized (2030 s) before a more rapid heating to transfer the concentrated sample on to the column. The latter is held at a low enough temperature to focus the sample in the capillary. The chromatographic separation starts on commencement of the temperature programme.
93
4.2.3.4 Examples of Analytical Procedures Most analytical methods involve the extraction of the compounds from water before chemical analysis. We have already noted two reasons for this separation of potential interferences and use as a concentration stage. DQ 4.9 Can you think of two further reasons which are specic to gas chromatography? Answer Many, but by no means all, gas chromatographic columns and detectors are incompatible with water. Direct injection of the sample would deposit non-volatile solids on the column, which could cause blockage and would shorten column life. With a suitable choice of analytical column, simple extraction may be a sufcient pretreatment for the direct injection of the extract into the chromatograph. For instance, the UK HMSO method for halomethanes simply uses the extraction of the compounds into petroleum ether and injection of the extract directly into the chromatograph. The chromatograms of such extractions may be complex (particularly if ame ionization detection is being used), with a single extraction stage usually having insufcient specicity to simplify the chromatograms greatly. Indeed, a simple extraction with injection of the extract into the chromatogram is often used as a survey method to identify organic compounds in water. DQ 4.10 What alternative extraction methods would be suitable for halomethanes? Answer Halomethanes are examples of volatile organics. Head-space analysis, purge and trap or solid-phase microextraction would be suitable. For the analysis of individual components (often semi-volatiles) expected to be found at low concentrations (e.g. pesticides), further pretreatment may be necessary. DQ 4.11 What are the major stages in any pretreatment scheme? Answer 1. Extraction 2. Clean-up to remove interfering components 3. Concentration of extract (see Section 2.7 above)
94
Until the successful development of solid-phase extraction, solvent extraction had been the most often used technique for stage one. The low volatility of many of the compounds of interest in this category renders the alternative vapour-phase extraction methods difcult. The clean-up stages will invariably be chromatographic, often using column chromatography. This may involve more than one separation stage. To illustrate the method, it is easiest to study one analysis in detail. For this, I have chosen an analytical scheme for the commercial pesticide, DDT. This is taken from the European Standard Method, EN ISO 6468 (1996). Analysis of DDT. This was the rst synthetic insecticide to come into widespread use. It was introduced after the Second World War, and although now controlled or banned in many areas of the world (particularly in the West), it is now a universal contaminant. In common with most commercial products, the insecticide is not a single chemical compound the major active component (p,p -DDT) only consisting of 7080% of the total content. One of the minor components, p,p -DDD (similar in structure to p,p -DDT, but with a CHC12 side-chain rather than CC13 ) is, in fact, more toxic to insects than p,p -DDT. When considering environmental samples, a number of decomposition and metabolic products will also be present. Some of the reactions producing these materials have been considered above in Section 2.3. In fact, for many samples, the highest-concentration component is not p,p -DDT but its primary metabolic product, DDE. The following chromatographic peaks are expected in DDT analysis: (i) Components of technical DDT p, p -DDT (7080%) o, p -DDT (1520%) p, p -DDD (14%) (ii) Decomposition products p, p -DDE (aerobic decomposition) p, p -DDD (anaerobic decomposition) Thus, we have a multi-component mixture even without the presence of any other compounds expected in the water sample! Interfering components in a typical sample could include other pesticides and polychlorinated biphenyls (PCBs). These often have similar extraction properties to the DDT components. A typical pretreatment would be as follows: 1. Extraction of the organic components into hexane, with a 1 l sample being extracted into three aliquots (30 + 20 + 20 ml) of solvent.
95
2. Drying the combined extracts by using a column containing 5 g sodium sulfate. The chromatographic columns in the subsequent stages of the procedure are deactivated by the presence of water and so drying the extract at the earliest possible stage is essential. 3. Further concentration of the extract to a 1 ml volume. This could be by a number of methods, including using a KudernaDanish evaporator or a rotary evaporator. The sample is then placed on to the top of the rst chromatographic column described below. 4. Clean-up of the extract by column chromatography. (a) Aluminaalumina/silver nitrate column. This column contains a bottom layer of alumina/silver nitrate, a layer of alumina and a top layer of sodium sulfate. Alumina is a polar column material and will retain polar components in the extract. The silver nitrate helps retain compounds containing unsaturated carboncarbon bonds. Non-polar material, including the DDT components, is eluted by using 30 ml of hexane. The extract is next reduced in volume to 1 ml and then a 100 l portion is added to the top of the second column. (b) Silica gel column. This is a less polar column than the rst and can be used to separate potential non-polar interferences from the sample. First, 10 ml of hexane are passed through the column, eluting the PCBs, with the DDT components being retained on the column, followed by 8 ml of a 90% hexane/10% toluene solvent mixture. DDT is then eluted with a more polar solvent mixture (12 ml of 10% diethyl ether in hexane). The eluates are then re-concentrated to 1 ml or less before injection into the chromatograph. Try calculating the overall concentration factor of the pretreatment process. You should come up with the factor of 100 if the nal solution volume is 1 ml. A typical chromatogram is shown in Figure 4.5. The detection limit for each component is approximately 10 ng l1 . The above procedure is just one method of pretreatment. Other chromatographic methods may be used, such as preparative-scale thin layer chromatography (TLC) or solid-phase extraction (SPE). Each of these methods will still, however, be made up of the same individual stages of extraction, concentration and removal of selected interfering components. Later chapters will extend the use of this method to the analysis of solids (Chapter 5) and to ultra-trace components (Chapter 8). DQ 4.12 Clean-up of the extract simplies the subsequent chromatogram. Can you think of a second advantage?
96
Detector response
p,p -DDD
30
40 Time (min)
o,p -DDD
50
Figure 4.5 Chromatographic separation of DDT components using a 25 m 0.32 mm i.d. methylsilicone capillary column with a temperature gradient to 220 C.
Answer This is simply protection of the column and detector from contamination. Without clean-up, the column lifetime will be shortened and the detector sensitivity lowered. Cleaning detectors to restore the sensitivity can be very time-consuming! Fingerprinting Oil Spills. If a lm of oil is discovered on water, the rst question likely to be asked is: What is it? Petrol? Fuel oil? Parafn? The next question might be: Where did it come from?
97
The commercial products mentioned above are complex mixtures of organic compounds. The precise composition of the mixture can vary from sample to sample, and so even if a complete quantitative analysis of every component in the mixture were undertaken, there would still be much difculty in interpretation of the data. A simpler procedure is to produce a chromatogram under standard conditions (column packing, ow rate, column temperature, etc.) and to compare the trace either with a library of reference materials, or preferably a sample of the material suspected to have been discharged. Capillary columns are necessary for resolution of individual components. Often, the correspondence of retention times and the overall envelope shape of the chromatogram will be sufcient to characterize the efuent. Hydrocarbon fuels give chromatograms with regularly spaced peaks (consecutive members of homologous series of compounds within the fuel). Lubricating oils have fewer resolved peaks. Natural product (vegetable) oils have simpler chromatograms with few individual peaks. Further information can be obtained if individual components in the material can be identied. Thus, the presence of simple polyaromatic species, such as anthracene, will identify coke-oven fractions. Sample preparation from water containing low concentrations of hydrocarbons is simply to extract the material with a suitable volatile solvent (e.g. diethyl ether). After washing and drying, the extract is concentrated by using a dry nitrogen stream. With heavily polluted water, the organic material is separated by extractive distillation with toluene. The oil can then be recovered by fractional distillation from the toluene. Complications can occur in interpretation of the chromatogram with material which has not been sampled immediately after discharge. The compositions of oil spills change with time (see Figure 4.6). Volatile components of the oil evaporate, with, in general, lower-molecular-mass components disappearing rst. The oil will also slowly be biodegraded, with the rate of degradation of a particular component being dependent on its chemical structure. A straight-chain hydrocarbon, for example, will be degraded more quickly than its branched-chain isomer. The determination of trace components and their relative concentrations has been found useful for assisting identication. Polynuclear aromatic hydrocarbons and their alkylated derivatives have been used as reference compounds in the nger-printing of oil spills. Although GC apparently seems a very simple method of identication of spillages, it is, in fact, a skilled task needing a great deal of experience. 4.2.3.5 Quantication When you look at a number of gas chromatography standard methods it almost seems that each has a different procedure to determine concentrations. Most are variations of one or more of the methods described below. We will start with the most simple method, discuss the problems with this approach, and then consider some ways of overcoming the problems.
98
Detector response
Fresh spill
Figure 4.6 Typical envelope shape in a chromatogram of an oil spill and its change with age of spill.
External standards. The simplest and most obvious method is to compare the peak area of the compound in the unknown solution with the areas of a series of solutions which have been used to form a calibration curve (or, if the calibration has been shown to be linear, with a single solution of known concentration close in value to the unknown), i.e. calibration is by external standards as discussed earlier in Section 3.4.1.1. DQ 4.13 After consideration of the ways a sample can be introduced into a gas chromatograph, why do you think the method of external standards may not be ideal?
Water Analysis Trace Pollutants Answer The external standard method assumes that the same volume of solution is being introduced during each injection. It is extremely difcult to introduce reproducible sample volumes into the chromatograph.
99
Internal standards. The above problem can be overcome by adding an internal standard. This is a compound which will produce a chromatographic peak close to, but resolved from, the unknown species. An accurately known amount of the standard is added to a xed volume of the unknown solution and to each of the external calibration solutions. Any variation in injection volume would show up in a change in peak area of the internal standard. There are a number of methods by which a correction may be applied. The normalization procedure plots the following: peak area versus concentration internal standard peak area DQ 4.14 Plot a calibration graph from the following data and determine the concentration of the unknown. Concentration(g l1 ) 10 20 30 40 50 Unknown Peak areaa 2315 3800 5900 8680 11600 5570 Internal standard 6150 5900 5740 6150 6730 6050 peak areaa
a
In arbitrary units.
Answer The normalized peak areas are as follows: Concentration 10 20 30 40 50 Unknown (g l1 ) Area 0.3764 0.6441 1.028 1.411 1.724 0.9207 The least-squares line is given by: Peak area ratio = 0.034 62 (concentration) 0.001 93 This gives the concentration of the unknown as 26.5 g l1 . Quantication if there is sample pretreatment. There is the potential for loss of analyte during the pretreatment. The procedures described so far will not take this into account and any loss of the unknown will result in a low analytical value. One method to overcome this problem would be to use external standards and
100
to submit them to the same clean-up procedure as the unknown. Losses during clean-up would be assumed to be the same for the standards and the unknown. Internal standards would again be added prior to chromatography to overcome injection problems. During method development and as a quality control step, the percentage recovery would need to be determined. The procedure for this is described below. Such a value should be as close to 100% as possible, although for some complex extractions, values of more than 60% may be acceptable. You could have little condence in the result if you discovered that 90% of the unknown was being lost during the clean-up! Percentage recovery. A known amount of the compound being determined is added to a blank. The latter could be a synthetic solution made up as close as possible to the expected sample composition (not including the unknown), or it could be a eld sample from which the analyte has been extracted (a preextracted sample). After extraction and clean-up, the sample is injected into the chromatograph and the peak area (or more precisely, the normalized peak area, as internal standards are necessary) produced is compared to that expected from a directly injected compound. You should remember to take into account any sample concentration during pretreatment. The recovery is determined from the following: peak area found 100 peak area expected Isotope dilution analysis. Unless the standard solutions were exactly matched in composition to the unknown, there would still be the possibility of errors due to the sample matrix changing the recovery efciency. In order to overcome this, you would need to have the standards and the unknown in the same matrix, i.e. you need to have the standard solutions added to the sample. This is possible if mass spectrometric detection is used. The standard is an identical compound to the unknown except that one or more atoms have been isotopically substituted this is often a deuterated compound. The peaks corresponding to the unknown and the standard will have the same retention times, but can be distinguished by detection at the two mass/charge ratios corresponding to the unsubstituted compound and the isotopically substituted standard. This is illustrated in Figure 4.7. In practice, allowances have to be made in the calculation for the compound and the substituted compound not being isotopically pure, i.e. detection at any one mass would include contributions from both the sample and the spike (see Figure 4.8). The isotopic abundances of the unspiked sample and the spike need to be precisely known from the mass spectra of the individual components (scans (a) and (b) in Figure 4.8.). The concentration in the original sample can then be calculated from equations derived from the ratios given in the following
101
Contribution from unknown mass m 1
GC response from a non-selective detector, showing a single peak from an unknown (mass m 1) and an isotopically substituted standard (mass m 2)
t Time t
Time These two contributions can be separated by mass spectrometric detection
equation: Intensity ratio (mass m1 /mass m2 ) of spiked sample number of unknown molecules at mass m1 + number of spiked molecules at mass m1 = number of unknown molecules at mass m2 + number of spiked molecules at mass m2 (4.3)
where the number of unknown (or spiked) molecules at mass mx (x = 1 or 2) is given by: total mass of unknown (or spike) fractional molecular abundance at mass mx (4.4) molar mass of compound (or spike) You should note that although isotope dilution analysis overcomes many of the problems found in other methods there should ideally be one isotopic standard for each compound being determined. However, this may increase the cost of the analysis quite considerably.
102
t Time
Response for mass m 1 at time t
t Time
Response for mass m 2 at time t
103
LCMS systems and the increasing use of solid-phase extraction which is particularly suited to interfacing with LC equipment. The lower separation efciency of LC in comparison to that of GC is largely offset by the high selectivity of mass spectrometric detection. Longer established methods which use LC concern groups of compounds which can be determined using specic detectors or by derivatization. DQ 4.15 The most common form of high performance liquid chromatography uses ultraviolet absorption as its method of detection. From your knowledge of liquid chromatography, what alternative detection techniques may nd use in environmental analysis? Answer Conductivity detection can be used for ionic species (see Section 3.4.3 above). Fluorescence detection has an extremely high sensitivity and selectivity to specic groups of compounds and may nd use for such species. Conductivity detection has found widespread use for inorganic ions. Lowmolecular-mass carboxylic acids (e.g. formic and acetic acids) have very similar physical properties to the inorganic acids and ion chromatography provides a convenient alternative to gas chromatography for these acids. One group for which uorescence detection has high sensitivity are polynuclear aromatic hydrocarbons (PAHs). Some examples of these are shown in Figure 4.9. They are highly carcinogenic compounds which are produced in trace quantities whenever fossil fuels are burnt. Typical water extracts could include up to 70 PAHs with a total concentration of around 1 g l1 . In order to monitor these low concentrations, sample preconcentration is needed. Solid-phase extraction, using an octadecylsilane (ODS) column, or a combination of ODS and amino-type columns, has been used. Sensitivity can be maximized if the detector is capable of changing the excitation and detection wavelengths throughout the chromatographic run, since each component has different optimum settings. The range of wavelengths used is 270300 nm for excitation and 330500 nm for detection. Fluorescent derivatives can be made from non-uorescent or weakly uorescent compounds. Phenols and N -methylcarbamate pesticides (Figure 4.10) are often analysed in this way. The procedure for N -methylcarbamates uses postcolumn derivatization. The HPLC eluent is hydrolysed with sodium hydroxide at 95 C, thus producing methylamine. The latter is then reacted with ophthalaldehyde and 2-mercaptoethanol to produce the uorescent derivative. The uorescent excitation wavelength is 230 nm and detection is > 418 nm, giving a limit of detection of approximately 1 l g1 per component for a 400 l sample, injected without preconcentration.
104
Benzo[a]pyrene
Benz[a]anthracene
O OCONHCH3
Cl Urea Diuron Cl Cl
NHCON(CH3)2
N H N C2H5
Figure 4.10 Some examples of pesticides that can be analysed by using liquid chromatography.
HPLC with ultraviolet detection is sometimes used for these and similar species, e.g. N -methylcarbamate, urea and triazine pesticides can be analysed by this method. These are second-generation pesticides which have been developed to replace organic halogen compounds. The sensitivity with UV detection is lower than that achieved by uorescence measurements and preconcentration (solvent extraction or solid-phase extraction) has to be used prior to injection. This form
105
of detection is also less specic than uorescence and there is a greater possibility of chromatographic interference from other components in the sample. As with the case of phenols, the development of liquid chromatographic methods often stems from the difculties encountered with analyses using gas chromatographic techniques. In many cases, this may be attributed to the polarities of the molecules (e.g. phenols and N -methylcarbamates), or their thermal labilities (e.g. N -methylcarbamates and phenylureas).
4.2.5 Immunoassay
The techniques described so far involve the use of complex laboratory equipment and often long pretreatment stages. Ideally, an analyst would like to achieve the required sensitivity and specicity with simpler equipment and without any pretreatment being required. Field analysis would also be desirable. Part of the solution to this problem could be the use of immunoassay but as a separate test has to be designed for each analyte, it will never be the complete answer. Field kits (necessary apparatus, reagents and calibration standards for a specic number of analyses) are available in the g/l range with an analysis time of 1015 min. Laboratory kits are available for individual compounds in the ng l1 range and are typically capable of handling 40 samples in a period of two hours. The methods commercially available include the analysis of individual pesticides (e.g. atrazine, carbofuran and paraquat), BTEX compounds (benzenetolueneethylbenzenexylene(s)), total petroleum hydrocarbon (TPH), PCBs and PAHs, with the list continually expanding. Several of these methods are now approved by the US Environmental Protection Agency (EPA). The use of these kits can be very simple, requiring little background knowledge. More thorough knowledge is necessary to understand the potential applications and limitations of the immunoassay process and the almost bewildering number of variations of the basic technique. Chemical and biological principles will both need to be understood and the techniques used sometimes seem to be more at home in a life sciences rather than a pure chemical laboratory. First of all, let us look at a simple method. Later, we will look at the background principles behind the method in an attempt to understand its particular merits. 4.2.5.1 Methodology Most eld and laboratory kits use a technique known as competitive ELISA (enzyme-linked immunosorbent assay). For laboratory analyses, reactions take place in the wells of a microtitreplate (Figure 4.11). These are plastic plates which contain typically 40, 48 or 96 wells for the simultaneous analysis of the samples and standards. An automatic scanner (microtitreplate reader) measures their light absorbance at specic wavelengths. This apparatus is commonplace in biomedical laboratories.
106
The wells of the plate are lled with 100 l sample or standards in duplicate. The reagents are then added. After a short period of time, the plate is then washed with water, further reagents are added and the plate is placed in an incubator at room temperature for a period of up to one hour. The absorption of light in each plate is then measured. One design of eld analysis kit includes individual pre-coated tubes, while another manufacturer has reagents attached to magnetic particles. The latter can be separated from the reagent and wash solutions by using a magnet, thus immobilizing the particles on the walls of the tube. Light absorbance is measured by a portable spectrometer. The response curve is unlike any others you are likely to have come across, with a typical example being shown in Figure 4.12. DQ 4.16 Comment on this response curve and suggest possible applications of this analytical technique.
107
Percentage extinction
range
log concentration
Answer You should notice that the range over which the response can be used quantitatively is quite limited, although it can be more easily used as an indication of whether the pollutant is present or absent. Application is often as a screen for potential pollutants. This will lower the number of samples requiring more expensive GCMS or LCMS analysis. So, how does the technique work? The new terms which you will need to know are summarized in Table 4.3, while Figure 4.13 shows the steps involved in the immunoassay process. The surface of the wells of the microtitreplate have been coated with an antibody. The samples and standards are introduced into the wells of the plate, each with a xed amount of a labelled derivative of the pollutant. The derivative molecules compete with the pollutant molecules for binding to the antibody xed on the plate. The amount of labelled derivative binding to the surface will be determined by the relative concentrations of the pollutant and derivative, and is inversely proportional to the concentration of pollutant originally in the sample. For an ELISA analysis, the labelled derivative contains an enzyme moiety covalently bonded to the pollutant molecule. Other forms of immunoassay have different labels such as radioactive isotopes (radioimmunoassay) or uorophores (uoroimmunoassay). The washing stage removes the unbound pollutant and labelled derivative. The enzyme is often used to catalyse a colour-change reaction. This results in the high sensitivity of the technique. One commercial kit for atrazine uses
108
Antibody A high-molecular-mass soluble protein produced within an organism which binds with the antigen by physical forces as part of the organisms natural defence mechanism. This will have a high specicity towards the antigen. The antibodies for the ELISA kits have been originally generated by innoculation of laboratory animals with the antigen. Antibodies are often drawn as molecule.
Antigen Foreign material which can cause antibody production within an organism. Clone A group of genetically identical cells derived from a common parent by asexual reproduction. Conjugate A high-molecular-mass compound capable of producing an immune response. It is formed by covalently coupling a hapten with a soluble protein such as bovine serum albumin. Hapten A low-molecular-mass compound which will bind to an antibody even though the molecular mass is too low to induce the initial antibody formation. For environmental samples, this is generally the compound being determined in the immunoassay. Immunoassay An analytical technique involving the binding of antigens and antibodies. Immunogen A synthetic substance capable of inducing antibody formation in an immunized animal. For the immunoassays being discussed here, this is the conjugate. Monoclonal antibody An antibody formed by a single clone. This is effectively made up of identical molecular species and will be more specic to the antigen than the corresponding polyclonal antibody. These are produced by cell culturing techniques after selection from the polyclonal antibody. Polyclonal antibody An antibody formed in response to an antigen produced by several different clones. It is comprised of many molecular species, each with differing afnities and specicities to the antigen. Early assay kits used polyclonal antibodies, while recently developed kits may use monoclonal species.
the reaction of urea peroxide with tetramethylbenzidine, where a blue-to-yellow colour change occurs. After the reaction is stopped by a nal addition of dilute acid, the absorbance is then monitored at 450 nm. The change in absorbance is inversely related to the concentration of the pollutant. The reaction is stopped after approximately one hour in most laboratory analyses. Field kits, however,
109
(b) P P P P P P* P*
Pollutant P and labelled pollutant P* compete for antibody sites
(c)
P P P* P*
110
stop the reaction after ve to ten minutes to decrease the overall analytical time, but this will, of course, decrease the sensitivity of the technique. 4.2.5.2 Development of Tests and Implications for Analyses An essential stage in the development of the kits is the production and isolation of the antibodies. The initial immune response can only be produced by molecules with an Mr greater than about 10 000, much larger than most pollutant molecules. Derivatives (conjugates) of the initial molecule (hapten) must rst be produced by covalently bonding the latter to a carrier protein. Antibodies are generated by injection of the conjugate into a laboratory animal. After a few weeks, the antibody can be harvested from samples of the blood serum of the animal. Sufcient antibodies will be produced for several thousand kits. Monoclonal antibodies and genetically engineered antibodies are now becoming more common. These are single chemical reagents of a dened composition with constant specicity characteristics and can be mass produced. As no two animals will produce identical antibodies, even identical tests from different manufacturers will have to be considered as different analytical techniques and will need to be assessed separately. The antibodies recognize molecules according to their molecular shape and bind at specic sites in the molecule. During the development process, tests have to be conducted to ensure the recognition sites ensure specicity for the compound being analysed. There is the possibility of cross-reactivity with other compounds with a similar shape and functional groups. Cross-reactivity can, in fact, be used to advantage in some kits, e.g. the triazine pesticide test kit, which are designed to respond to groups of chemicals rather than to individual groups of compounds. DQ 4.17 Identify features of an ELISA which means little pretreatment is necessary? Answer The use of antibodies makes the technique highly selective without pretreatment. Enzyme catalysis gives the technique high sensitivity.
111
Visible spectrometry is often used for phenols and surfactant analysis after the formation of derivatives. Chromatographic methods have in the past not been used as they give too much information! The simplicity of the method can be seen by the analysis of anionic surfactants using a Methylene-Blue method. Under basic conditions, a salt is formed between the Methylene Blue and the surfactant and this salt can be extracted into chloroform. The absorbance of the extract is measured in the visible region (at 652 nm) and the concentration determined by comparison with a standard calibration curve. Infrared spectrometry is used for the total hydrocarbon content. The hydrocarbons are extracted from the acidied water by using a non-hydrocarbon solvent (e.g. carbon tetrachloride) and the absorption measured at 2920 cm1 , corresponding to the CH stretching frequency.
SAQ 4.1 The Environmental Protection Agency (USA) lists 114 organic priority pollutants and suggests a purge and trap technique for volatile components and solvent extraction techniques for non-volatiles. Solvent extraction is used either under acid or base/neutral conditions. Which technique could be used for the following compounds? 1. 2. 3. 4. 5. 6. 7. 8. 9. 10. Toluene Anthracene 2,4,6-Trichlorophenol Methylene chloride Chloroform 1,2-Dichlorobenzene Phenol Naphthalene Hexachlorobenzene Benzene
SAQ 4.2 The main use of the extraction methods discussed earlier in Section 4.2.2 is in the laboratory, often with the apparatus coupled as an integrated system to a chromatograph. At least two of the methods can be used for eld sampling. You would take an extract back to the laboratory rather than an aqueous sample. Which techniques do you consider to be suitable in this case? SAQ 4.3 Which GC column would be your initial choice for the analysis of the following: (a) chlorinated pesticides in a natural water sample; (b) volatile solvents in waste water; (c) oil contamination in water?
112
SAQ 4.4
Which analytical methods could be used for the following compounds? Give your reasons for using the particular techniques. N-methylcarbamates Atrazine Phenols PAHs Malathion
These will be discussed, along with some other methods, in the following sections, showing the relative merits of each technique and their potential applications.
Water Analysis Trace Pollutants Answer (i) Polyethylene bottles are less likely to contaminate the sample with metal ions than glass bottles. The only exception to the use of polyethylene bottles is for mercury analysis when glass bottles should be used. Mercury ions readily react with many organic materials. (ii) The sample should be acidied to minimize precipitation of metal ions. A typical procedure is the addition of 2 ml of 5 mol 11 hydrochloric acid per litre of sample. (iii) Scrupulous cleaning of bottles is important. This usually includes an acid washing stage to ensure complete removal of trace metals. In the case of aluminium, the concern over contamination extends to glassware used in the subsequent analysis. You are often advised to pre-leach glassware with dilute nitric acid and to reserve glassware solely for aluminium determinations. Such a procedure would, in fact, be good practice for all metal analyses.
113
4.3.2 Pretreatment
Most routine analyses require the total metal content of the sample, regardless of its chemical nature. Pretreatment can include evaporation to dryness and redissolution in acid, partial evaporation with acid, or digestion with acid at an elevated temperature for several hours. This is to dissolve suspended material and ensure that the metal is present as the free ion. The more modern techniques we will be discussing (GFAAS, ICP-OES and ICP-MS) are sufciently sensitive and interference-free for the majority of samples to require no further pretreatment. Most of the other analytical techniques require an extraction/concentration step for trace analyses. This may be a separate solvent extraction stage, as with ame AAS and some visible spectrometric methods, or may be a concentration stage in the analytical technique itself (Ion Chromatography and Anodic Stripping Voltammetry). Such a step can also serve to remove potentially interfering ions which may be present in far greater concentrations than the analyte. The most common method proceeds with the formation of a neutral complex with an organic ion and extraction of this into an organic solvent (simple metal salts or ionic complexes would not extract). Up to a twenty times increase in concentration is possible in a single stage. The complexing agent used depends on the subsequent analytical procedure, and this will be discussed in the relevant sections. Other extraction/concentration methods include the use of chelating or ion-exchange columns. The metal ions are rst held on the column, either by complex formation with the column packing material (chelating column) or by ion exchange. The ions are then eluted as a concentrated extract with an appropriate solvent, often an aqueous buffer.
114
Flame
Monochromator
Detector
Water Analysis Trace Pollutants Answer This is the BeerLambert law. Check with the equations given above in Section 3.4.1 for the mathematical form.
115
The concentration range over which the law applies for ame atomic absorption spectrometry is usually 05 mg l1 . Over the last three decades, atomic absorption spectrometry has dominated routine analysis of metal ions in aqueous samples at mg l1 and higher concentrations. DQ 4.21 From your previous knowledge of atomic absorption spectrometry, can you think of some of the advantages of this technique? Answer It is a rapid technique and can easily be automated. It is a simple method for routine use. Standard procedures are available for all metals. The analyses are generally free from interferences, while known interferences can easily be overcome. Apart from the pretreatment stages already mentioned, little or no sample preparation is needed for aqueous environmental samples. You may have included high sensitivity within your list. Ive left this out as I would like to discuss this further. Atomic absorption is indeed a sensitive technique and, if it is used for the more common ions discussed in Section 3.4 above, the water samples would have to be diluted before analysis. Magnesium is analysed by ame atomic absorption, often after sample dilution. If the technique is used for sodium or potassium analysis, lower-sensitivity absorption lines, rather than the highest-sensitivity lines, would be used in addition to diluting the sample. Atomic emission (ame photometry) is, however, the preferred technique for these ions. In high-throughput laboratories, low-concentration samples (<1 mg l1 ) would normally be determined by the techniques described later in this section, particularly ICP-OES and ICP-MS. If these are not available, ame AAS can be used with sample preconcentration. This may simply involve partial evaporation of the acidied sample for zinc, iron and manganese analyses. Solvent extraction has been routinely used for other metals. Since atomic absorption analysis is relatively free from interference from other trace metal ions (i.e. the presence of other materials usually has little effect on the accuracy of the analysis), the extraction need not be highly specic to any one particular metal. In fact, it may be benecial to be able to use a single complexing agent for several metals
116
N C S
NH4+
since the extraction stage is the most time-consuming part of the analytical procedure. Ammonium pyrrolidinedithiocarbamate (APDC) (Figure 4.15) is often used as it forms stable complexes with most transition metals, if the pH is correctly adjusted. As an example, the optimum pH for lead extraction is 2.3. After extraction of the analyte in an organic phase, the organic phase is aspirated directly into the ame. The increase in the sensitivity is above that which is expected from the simple concentration factor. This is due to the increased aspiration rate resulting from the lower viscosity of the organic solvent in comparison to water. You should be able to see a number of disadvantages of solvent extraction/ame atomic absorption, namely: It is very time-consuming. The sensitivity may still be insufcient for low-concentration metal ions. The risk of sample contamination is considerably increased. To overcome these problems, other atomic spectrometric techniques have been applied to trace metal analysis. 4.3.3.2 Flameless Atomic Absorption By replacement of the ame by other methods of atomizing the sample, the sensitivity can be increased sufciently to remove the need for sample preconcentration. For most metals, this would mean the use of graphite furnace atomization (also known by the more general term electrothermal atomization), as shown in Figure 4.16, but, as we will see later, this is not the only method possible.
Sample
Electrode Light from hollow-cathode lamp Graphite tube x Monochromator and detector
Argon gas
117
Graphite furnace AAS involves injecting a sample (up to 25 l) into a small graphite tube (23 cm 510 mm) which is heated in pre-programmed stages, as follows: Drying Decomposition Atomization The absorbance of a light beam shone through the cell is measured during the atomization stage. The optimum temperatures and duration of each stage are metal-dependent, with a complete programme taking 23 min. A comparison of ame and graphite furnace atomic absorption spectroscopies is presented in Table 4.4. As you can see from this table, the chief advantage of ameless AAS arises from removing the necessity of preconcentration of the sample. An extraction stage may still sometimes be necessary for complex samples in order to reduce potential interferences, as in the case of sea water analysis. One major source of error is background interference, which results from light scattering by solid particles within the beam. The scattering is highly dependent on wavelength, as follows: Scattering 1 4 (4.5)
where is the wavelength of radiation. The analytical wavelengths used for lead and cadmium are towards the far end of the available ultraviolet range and so analyses for these elements are highly susceptible to interference. Automatic background corrections should always be used for these elements. An analytical wavelength of 283.3 nm is also often preferred for lead, rather than the more sensitive 217 nm wavelength, as this lessens the effect of light scattering. Background effects can also occur from other sources according to the analyte being considered, including the presence of thermally stable molecular ions. The
Table 4.4 A comparison of the advantages of ame and ameless (graphite furnace) atomic absorption spectroscopies Advantages of solvent extraction/ame AAS Simple technique The solvent extraction stage can be used to remove potential interferences More readily available equipment Shorter instrument time Lower instrument cost Advantages of graphite furnace AAS Increased sensitivity (g l1 concentrations) Decreased overall analytical time as the solvent-extraction stage is not usually necessary Smaller samples required Unattended operation is possible Reduced risk of sample contamination
118
Feature A second absorbance measurement over a slightly larger wavelength range than the atomic absorption which gives the background reading An intense magnetic eld splits the absorption into magnetic components at slightly different wavelengths. Absorbance measurements with and without the magnetic eld can be processed to correct for the background A pulse increase in the lamp current removes the atomic absorption, leaving only the background
SmithHieftje
absorbance can be highly structured (e.g. narrow absorption bands within a much broader absorption). There are a number of methods available for background correction, as shown in Table 4.5. Due to the different principles on which the corrections are based, there may be advantages or disadvantages for each type according to the application. Revalidation may be necessary if a different technique is used to that specied in a standard method. Other ameless atomization techniques can be used for specic elements. Inorganic mercury salts can be chemically reduced by using tin (II) chloride or sodium borohydride. The elemental mercury produced is then swept by a stream of nitrogen or air into a gas cuvette for absorption measurement in a modied spectrometer. Tin, lead and a number of metalloids (As, Se, etc.) can be reduced by sodium borohydride to volatile hydrides which are swept from the sample by a gas stream. Mild heating breaks down the hydrides to produce the elements in their ground states suitable for absorbance measurements. 4.3.3.3 Quantication The major advantage of atomic absorption over other techniques is often stated as its lack of interference, particularly between metals. All that would appear necessary for quantication would be to use external standards to produce a calibration graph (see Section 3.4.1 above). There are, however, a number of factors which will affect the accuracy of the analysis. One of these is chemical, typically where refractory salts are formed between the metal and an anion. These interferences are well known and usually described in instruction manuals accompanying the spectrometer. A typical concern for environmental samples is shown by the effect of phosphate on calcium, which decreases the absorption due to the formation of insoluble and refractory calcium phosphate. Similar problems can occur in the presence of sulfate and silicate ions. These problems can be overcome by adding a small quantity of release agent to each solution. A 10% lanthanum solution is often used. The lanthanum preferentially reacts with the phosphate. Alternatively, an
119
EDTA solution can be used. In this case, the EDTA complexes with the calcium, as shown in equation (3.23) above. For more complex analytes, other factors may affect the accuracy. These include physical effects where the viscosity or surface tension of the solution is altered. Such properties will affect the aspiration of the solution into the ame and hence the measured absorbance. The method of standard addition is often used to overcome this problem. A calibration curve is produced from a series of sample solutions which have been increased in concentration by adding known amounts of the metals ion being determined. This, of course, will increase the measured absorbance. The easiest way to achieve this for trace work where you do not wish to dilute the sample, is to add small volumes of higher-concentration standards so that the change in overall volume is negligible. The amount of metal added needs to be chosen so that the increase in absorbance is of the same order as that of the original sample. It is easy to see the principle. If you add, by chance, an amount of metal ion which will double its concentration, then the absorbance will double. It is perhaps a little less obvious to see how you calculate the unknown concentration from a series of additions. You do this by plotting a graph of the concentration increase against the absorbance. A linear plot should be produced, but, of course, the line does not pass through the origin. There will still be absorption from the metal ions in the untreated sample (i.e. the y-axis intercept). The concentration of the sample is found from the x-axis intercept, with the latter being the negative value of the sample concentration. DQ 4.22 A series of solutions is made up by adding 0.1, 0.2, 0.3, 0.4 and 0.5 ml of a 10 mg l1 lead standard to 100 ml aliquots of the unknown solution. The following results were obtained: Volume of standard added (ml) 0 0.1 0.2 Absorbance 0.27 0.37 0.53 0.3 0.4 0.5 0.65 0.75 0.88
Plot a calibration graph from the above data and determine the concentration of the unknown. Answer Assuming that the volume remains constant at 100 ml, the concentration increases in the ve solutions will be 10, 20, 30, 40 and 50 g l1 , respectively. The graph produced is shown in Figure 4.17 below. The least-squares line is as follows: Absorbance = (0.012 35 concentration) + 0.2694 which gives a concentration in the unknown of 21.8 g l1 lead.
120
1.0 0.9 0.8
0.7 0.6 Absorbance 30 20 10 0.5 0.4 0.3 0.2 0.1 0.0 0 10 20 30 40 50 60 Concentration (g l1)
Figure 4.17 Typical calibration graph obtained in the quantication by standard addition approach (cf. DQ 4.22).
Standard addition overcomes the problem of matrix effects as all the readings are taken from sample solutions with similar composition. The method does, however, produce particular problems of its own. DQ 4.23 What problems can you see in this method? Answer (i) The concentration is determined by extrapolation. The latter will magnify any inaccuracies in the calibration line and is only possible if the calibration is linear. (ii) Any error in zeroing the instrument for the analysis will be included as a systematic error in the analytical value produced. (iii) You may be concerned about the volume of sample necessary to make up the standard solutions. Many modern graphite furnace spectrometers can, however, be programmed to perform the addition
Water Analysis Trace Pollutants automatically within the graphite tube by using microlitre quantities of sample and standard.
121
4.3.3.4 Inductively Coupled Plasma Techniques Atomic absorption spectrometry has a number of disadvantages for use in analysing large numbers of samples of varying elemental composition and concentration. DQ 4.24 What are the two major problems in the use of AAS for such samples? Answer AAS can only determine one element at any one time. The technique becomes slow and tedious for multi-element analysis. The variations in concentrations of the samples can be problematic as the linear range of AAS is very limited. The development of the inductively coupled plasma (ICP) techniques for water analysis can be seen as an attempt to overcome these problems. At the same time, they maintain the advantages of graphite furnace AAS of being sufciently sensitive not to require a preconcentration stage and also in not using ammable or explosive gases. This permits unattended, 24 hour, operation. In both methods, the sample is atomized in a plasma ame at 600010 000 K (Figure 4.18). This is generated by a owing stream of argon which is ionized by an applied radiofrequency (RF) eld. Inductively Coupled Plasma-Optical Emission Spectrometry (ICP-OES). With this technique, the emission spectrum is monitored. Simultaneous ICPOES can determine 60 or more elements at once by monitoring at pre-set wavelengths. This includes halogens and some other non-metals and metalloids, as well as metals. Sequential spectrometers, which are more common for water analysis, restrict themselves to a smaller number of elements, determined by the requirements of the analysis, measured in succession by rapid changes in the detection wavelength. The total analysis time is still fast, typically 5 s per element. A further advantage of ICP-OES is its wide dynamic range (approximately 105 ), which means that trace metals can be measured simultaneously with higher-concentration species. In common with other emission techniques, there is the problem of spectral overlap from different elements, as an element will produce many more lines in its emission spectrum than in its corresponding absorption spectrum. The choice of the analytical wavelength is based on freedom from interference as well as sensitivity. For routine water analysis this problem has largely been overcome, with sensitive and interference-free lines being well documented. Quantitative
122
Lines of force
Induction coil
Figure 4.18 Schematic of a plasma ame unit used in ICP techniques for atomization of samples.
analysis can be performed by using external standards after rst conrming that the chosen wavelength is free from interference. For quality control, monitoring can be at two wavelengths, which of course should produce identical results if there is no interference at either of the wavelengths. For many years, the sensitivity of ICP-OES lay between those of the ame and furnace AAS techniques for most elements, thus making the technique useful
123
for most, but not all, of the major components of water. Considerable effort was made to improve the sensitivity by changes in the spectrometer design. The major improvement lay in the relative position of the detector with respect to the plasma (Figure 4.19). Originally, this was at right angles to the plasma, so giving a short pathlength through the ame. The sensitivity is increased by 810 (i.e. to ca. furnace AAS sensitivity) by moving the detector to an axial position. Problems which needed to be overcome included the effect of the plasma tail on the optics. One method of overcoming this is by diverting the plasma tail away from the optics by a radial ow of gas. Organic solutions cannot be used with axial ow detection (c.f. use of organic extracts with ame AAS). The linear range of the instrument is unchanged, but is moved to lower concentrations. As a consequence, both types of instrument are still in use today. Some instruments are capable of operating in either mode, with the axial conguration being reserved for applications needing higher sensitivities. Inductively Coupled Plasma-Mass Spectrometry (ICP-MS). A more recent development is to use the inductively coupled plasma as an ion source for a mass spectrometer. For routine applications, this is usually a quadrupole spectrometer as is commonly found in a GCMS system. The mass spectra of inorganic mixtures are simple in comparison to the more familiar organic compound spectra
(a) Radial view
(b)
Axial view
Shear gas
Figure 4.19 Relative positions of the detector in ICP-OES: (a) radial; (b) axial.
124
and fewer interferences occur in metal analysis. Although the technique is not strictly simultaneous the ions being determined sequentially determination of some 20 elements is possible within a period of 4 s. The sensitivity is slightly lower than that of graphite furnace AAS but is still sufcient to determine trace metal ions at below 1 g l1 in aqueous samples. The linearity range is 68 orders of magnitude, according to the particular application. Since each metal is determined according to its mass/charge ratio, there would seem to be, at rst sight, little chance of interference in the technique. High concentrations of salts can cause deposition of solids in the instrument. Although there are few instances where there are problems with isotopes with the same mass/charge ratios, molecular ions can be formed, particularly with refractory elements. For example, 44 Ca16 O+ has the same mass/charge ratio as 60 Ni+ , while 40 Ar35 Cl+ could interfere with 75 As+ . Most of these problems can be eliminated by simple pretreatment of the sample to remove the potential interference before introduction into the ICP-MS system. Flow-injection techniques may be used to automate the process and may also be used to alleviate the problem of high salt concentrations if simple dilution is not possible. Avoidance of the use of hydrochloric acid for acidication will lessen problems with chlorine interference. The use of mass spectrometric detection makes possible the use of the isotope dilution techniques discussed earlier in Section 4.2.3. The method would have to be applied to each isotope in turn and is time-consuming if large numbers of samples and elements have to be determined. As a consequence, for routine samples external standards are sometimes used after quality control checks to conrm the lack of any interferences. The standards may be matrix-matched to minimize problems caused, for instance, by viscosity differences. Standard addition (see Section 4.3.3 above) is also used. Each development in atomic spectrometry has brought with it a signicant increase in instrument capital cost. The cost of AA instrumentation is generally according to the following: Flame AAS < Furnace AAS < ICP-OES < ICP-MS In addition, ICP techniques have signicantly higher running costs due to consumption of the argon necessary to generate the plasma. The advantages of ICP techniques are, however, so great that ICP-OES has for several years been the preferred technique for the high-concentration metal analysis in major water analysis laboratories, with ICP-MS being used for lower-concentration metals. Atomic absorption methods nd a role in smaller laboratories where the sample throughput is insufcient to justify the additional capital and running costs of ICP techniques.
125
were developed for all commonly found metal ions. These methods use colourforming complexing agents. Selectivity in the analysis is achieved in two different ways, as follows: 1. Solvent extraction is sometimes used. Chromium is analysed as the diphenylcarbazide complex after extraction into a trioctylamine/chloroform mixture. This gives a limit of detection of 5 g l1 in the original sample. The complexing agent dithizone can be used for 17 metals. The selectivity is achieved by precise control of pH and the use of masking agents. 2. Alternatively, a colour-forming complexing agent can be used which is sufciently sensitive and selective for use in the aqueous sample without extraction being necessary. Some examples are shown above in Table 4.6. A number of these techniques have been adapted for use with portable colorimeters (e.g. iron, manganese, chromium and copper) and it is perhaps in this area that such techniques have the most widespread current usage. It is useful to consider why such a well-established technique as visible spectrometry could become largely superseded by atomic methods: 1. Atomic methods are more rapid. 2. Although visible spectrometric pretreatment is generally simple when analysing relatively unpolluted water samples (rivers and lakes), they may become complex and time-consuming with more complicated samples such as sewage efuents. 3. Visible spectrometry is often affected by interference from other elements. This can be illustrated by the determination of iron using 2,4,6-tripyridyl-1,3,5triazine. The concentration effects observed on a true value of 1.000 mg l1 iron are shown in Table 4.7. Nonetheless, visible spectrometry remains a frequently used technique and would be the method of choice when atomic methods are unavailable.
126
without any separate preconcentration. Anodic stripping voltammetry (ASV) has found particular use in environmental analysis, where at least 19 metals can be analysed in this way. The apparatus used consists of an electrolytic cell containing a working electrode (a mercury drop, or a thin lm of mercury deposited on a glassy carbon electrode), a reference electrode and a counter electrode. A three-electrode system is used so that current and applied potential can be measured independently. This attempts to compensate for the change in potential drop due to the resistance of the test solution during the analysis. The latter would affect the measurement in a two-electrode system. The sample is placed in the cell along with a supporting electrolyte (e.g. 0.1 mol l1 acetate buffer at pH 4.5). Nitrogen or argon is bubbled through the solution to remove dissolved oxygen, which would otherwise interfere in the analysis. The working electrode is held at a small negative potential with respect to the reference while the solution is stirred. Reduction of the metal ions to the free metal occurs at the working electrode. Under controlled conditions of deposition time and stirring rate, the quantity of metal deposited on the electrode is proportional to its original concentration: M2+ + 2e M (4.6)
After a predetermined time, the potential of the electrode is slowly changed in the positive direction. At specic potentials, depending on the metal and supporting electrolyte, each metal is oxidized and returned back into solution, as follows: M M2+ + 2e (4.7) This process is monitored by plotting the current change between the working and counter electrodes against the potential (Figure 4.20). The height of the peak in the curve is proportional to the concentration of the metal. DQ 4.25 Can you see why this method does not require a separate concentration stage?
127
Pd
1.0
0.75
0.25
Answer If you consider the experimental method, you will see that the rst step, where the metal is being plated on the electrode, is itself a concentration stage hence the high sensitivity of the technique with little pretreatment. The supporting electrolytes necessary for individual metals are tabulated in standard texts. Electrolytes are often acidic, as their potentials become little affected by minor changes in the sample composition. Complexing agents (e.g. acetate) are sometimes included to stabilize particular oxidation states or to move the stripping potential of the metal away from potential interferences. Four metals of major environmental concern, i.e. copper, lead, cadmium and zinc, can, however, be analysed in a single scan by using the acetate buffer mentioned earlier. Quantication is by standard addition. As an electrochemical method, the technique determines only free metal ions in solution, plus, to some extent, loosely associated complexes. However, anodic stripping voltammetry does have at least one disadvantage. The laboratory method is slow, with stripping times varying between 30 s and 30 min, and during such periods the apparatus is devoted to a single sample. Compare this with atomic spectrometry, where the instrumental time is only a few seconds per sample. The time taken for analysis has, however, been overcome with commercially available eld instruments. These utilize disposable electrodes and microprocessor control which automatically takes the solution through the scanning cycle. Sample pretreatment is by addition of salts in tablet form. The conditioning breaks down any complexed forms of the metal and so the concentration output is of the total dissolved metal. A complete lead and copper analysis at the g l1 level can be performed in ca. 3 min. If the total metal content is required with laboratory apparatus, sample pretreatment is also necessary. This may range from simple acidication to UV irradiation
128
in order to destroy any potential complexing agents. By performing the analysis with and without pretreatment, a measure of the free and complexed metal ions can be made, which would not be possible by using atomic spectrometry. This makes anodic stripping voltammetry a useful research tool, but because of its relative slowness in the laboratory, limited in its application for routine analysis.
129
If we extend our comparison to ICP techniques, then many of the perceived advantages may still hold. Interferences in complex samples may still be found. Sequential plasma emission spectrometers detect a limited number of elements and unsuspected elements may still be missed. Different chemical forms are not distinguished. ICP techniques are, however, more rapid for multi-element analyses. Chromatographic methods using both dedicated ion chromatographs and conventional HPLC have been developed. The most sensitive method for transition metals in complex mixtures using a dedicated chromatograph is known as Chelation Ion Chromatography. This method involves the use of two preconcentration columns (Figure 4.21), and spectrometric detection after mixing with a derivatization agent, i.e. 4-(2-pyridylazo)resorcinol. The detection limits are 0.21 g l1 with a 20 ml sample volume.
Water sample
Concentrator column I
Alkali metals unretained Alkaline-earth metals selectively eluted with ammonium acetate solution
Concentrator column II
The cation-exchange column is converted to the ammonium form before elution of the metals
Analytical column
Gradient elution is necessary for lanthanides by using oxalic/diglycollic acids Spectrometric detection at 520530 nm
130
After acid digestion to ensure that the metal is present as the free ion, the sample is added on to the rst column, eluted on to the second, and then on to the analytical column. Although we can say that ion chromatography removes the need for a separate preconcentration stage, you can see that preconcentration still occurs within the instrument as an identiable analytical step. Separation of all common transition metals takes less than 14 min, with a typical chromatogram being shown in Figure 4.22. Furthermore, separation of the lanthanide elements requires less than 12 min to carry out. A common application of chromatography for separate different chemical forms of the same element is for Cr3+ and Cr2 O7 2 . Once again, the species are determined by visible spectrometry after derivatization. Pyridine dicarboxylic acid is reacted with the sample prior to the analytical separation to form a stable anionic complex with the Cr3+ (i.e. pre-column derivatization). Separation of the species employs an anion-exchange column. Diphenyl carbazide is added after elution from the column (post-column derivatization) to react with the Cr2 O7 2 . Both species may be then detected at 520 nm. A common method for trace metals when using conventional HPLC involves separation of the thiocarbamate complexes. Excess thiocarbamate (diethylthiocarbamate and pyrrolidine dithiocarbamate salts have both been used) is added to the sample and the transition metal complexes formed are concentrated by liquidliquid or solid-phase extraction. The concentrated extract is injected into the HPLC system and separated by using a reversed-phase technique. Underivatized metal ions can be separated by reversed-phase ion-pair
4 Peak 1 = Fe3+ 2 = Cu2+ 3 = Ni2+ 4 = Zn2+ 5 = Mn2+ Detection: 2 3 5
c (ng ml1)
2.2 0.73 0.47 2.4 0.25 0.2 AUFS
8 Time (Min)
16
Figure 4.22 A typical chelation ion chromatogram, obtained for a sample of 32 g of sea water (Monterey Bay, CA). From Dionex Technical Note TN25, Dionex (UK) Ltd. Reproduced by permission of Dionex Corporation.
131
techniques or by using a cation-exchange column. Several detection methods have been used, including conductivity and post-column derivatization with 4(2-pyridylazo)resorcinol.
Table 4.8 Possible forms of lead found in a typical river Species Free metal Ion-pair Complexes with organic pollutants Complexes with natural acids Ion absorbed on to colloids Metal within decomposing organic material Ionic solids Example Pb2+ PbHCO3 + Pb2+ /EDTA Pb2+ /fulvic acid Pb2+ /Fe(OH)3 Pb in organic solids Pb2+ held within clays PbCO3 Physical form Solution Solution Solution Suspension Colloidal Solid Solid Solid
Although I dont expect that you will have thought of all of these forms, I hope that you will now appreciate the great diversity of species which may be found. These include not only well dened ions and compounds, but also loosely bonded complexes and adsorbed species. The free metal ion often only comprises a small percentage of the total content. The interconversion between species is slow and for many purposes they can be considered as being distinct chemical forms. For a number of metals, there may also be concern over the different organic derivatives in the environment. An example would be tributyl tin which has been used in anti-fouling paint formulations for ships hulls and its dibutyl and monobutyl degradation products. Other metals with important organic derivatives include lead and mercury.
132
The transport of each species in the environment will be different and they will also have different toxicological properties. As an example, let us consider the behaviour of metals within a stream and in the associated sediment. Any decaying vegetation will increase the metal loading in the stream water, since the organic acids produced as part of the decay process will form soluble coordination complexes with the metals. The toxicity of the stream water, however, may not be increased as much as you might expect. As a very general rule, metal complexes have lower toxicities than their corresponding free metal ions. If the metal has more than one stable oxidation state in water, there may also even be differences in behaviour between different oxidation states. For example, chromium in the form of Cr2 O7 2 has a greater toxicity than Cr3+ . It would appear that the Cr2 O7 2 ion can enter cells via routes which permit entry of the similarly sized SO4 2 ion. Such a route would not be possible for the positively charged Cr3+ ion. Each of the analytical techniques described in this current chapter will respond in a different manner to the species in solution this is summarized in Table 4.9. If one of these techniques is included as part of a more lengthy analytical procedure, the pretreatment stages may also alter the species being analysed. Any ltration, for instance, will remove particulate matter. Speciation may be investigated by taking advantage of the different responses of the analytical techniques, and the effect of pretreatment. The most common method is to perform several ASV analyses with different pretreatment stages. A simple two-step procedure would be to perform the analysis on samples with and without ultraviolet irradiation, thus giving a value for the free metal (or more precisely, the total ASV-labile content) and total metal content, respectively. The complete chemical characterization of a sample would be exceedingly complex and time-consuming. When you remember that the total metal concentration may not be greater than a few g l1 , you will realize that you may also be reaching the detection limits of the available techniques. This aspect of
Table 4.9 Response of various analytical techniques to different metal species Technique Atomic spectrometry Visible absorption spectrometry Anodic stripping voltammetry Response All the metal species in the sample, i.e. the total metal is determined Free metal ions, plus ions released from complexes by the colour-forming reagent Free metal ions analysed, plus any ions released from complexes during analysis. The total is often referred to as the total ASV-labile content Non-labile species can sometimes be determined separately Organic derivatives can be determined separately
133
environmental trace metal analysis is currently of great interest and improved techniques are continually being reported in the literature. DQ 4.28 A complete characterization of all species in a sample is a difcult and time-consuming procedure. Can you think of an alternative, and simpler, approach to species analysis to support investigations on metal transport and toxicology? Answer Rather than to attempt to determine each species individually, those with similar environmental transport or toxicological properties could be analysed as groups. A simple classication of metal species would be into organic-solvent-soluble (neutral complexes and organometallic species) and organic-solvent-insoluble (charged complexes and free ions) species. The rst type would be transported in the environment and would accumulate in fatty tissues in a similar manner to neutral organic molecules (see Section 2.3 above), and the second type in a similar fashion to other ions (see Section 2.4 earlier) within the environment.
SAQ 4.5 Lengthy pretreatment techniques are often necessary with the analytical techniques described for both organic compounds and metals. Filtration, solvent extraction and chromatographic pretreatment are common methods. What could affect the precision of measurements for low concentrations of common pollutants ?
SAQ 4.6 An analytical technique for copper, lead, cadmium and zinc in water, as described in the chemical literature, involved dividing the ltered sample into ve aliquots. The treatment of the aliquots (prior to ASV analysis) was as follows: (i) (ii) (iii) (iv) (v) Strong chemical oxidation and UV irradiation. No pretreatment. Weak chemical oxidation. Passage through a chelating resin then UV irradiation. Extraction using an organic solvent, and UV irradiation of the aqueous phase.
134
Summary
Components present at trace (g l1 ) levels can have a major affect on water quality if they can bioaccumulate in organisms or have a high degree of toxicity. These components usually fall into the two categories of organic pollutants and metal ions. Instrumental methods for the determination of the components have been discussed, along with the necessary extraction and pretreatment steps. The predominant instrumental technique for organic components is gas chromatography, whereas atomic spectrometric techniques are the most frequently used methods for metal ion analysis.
Introduction to Environmental Analysis Roger Reeve Copyright 2002 John Wiley & Sons Ltd ISBNs: 0-471-49294-9 (Hardback); 0-470-84578-3 (Electronic)
Chapter 5
Learning Objectives To understand the problems of sampling and pretreatment of solid samples prior to the analytical determination of organic compounds and metal ions. To apply your knowledge of these problems to the analysis of: plants and animals soil contaminated land waste and landll disposal sites sediment sewage sludge To appreciate newer extraction techniques for solids and to be able to assess their role in relation to the longer-established techniques.
5.1 Introduction
This chapter introduces you to methods for the sampling and extraction of solids. These are necessary stages prior to completion of analysis by the instrumental techniques which have already been discussed for water samples. They may, in fact, be the most difcult part of the analysis. Modications which are needed for the nal analytical stage are described where these are appropriate. Be sure that you can remember the principles of the transportation of pollutants discussed in Chapter 2 as these are necessary to understand the relevance of the analysis.
136 DQ 5.1
Which solids do you consider to be of importance for the study of the environment? What specic analyses would be relevant? Answer 1. 2. 3. 4. 5. Animal and plant specimens Soils and contaminated land Waste and landll waste disposal sites Sediments and sewage sludge Atmospheric particulates
We shall consider all of these in detail in the following discussion. 1. Animal and plant specimens These are directly of interest since the toxic effect of a compound is proportional to its concentration within the organism. The investigations would also be relevant to species further along the food chain when determining the environmental pathway of the pollutant (see Section 2.3 earlier). Plants and animals may also be used as indicator organisms to monitor pollutants found in lower concentrations in the wider environment. As an example, heavy metal pollution in sea water is often monitored by analysis of seaweed rather than by direct analysis of the water. Remember, however, that you have to balance the advantage of the higher concentration in the living organism with the disadvantage of the more complex analytical matrix. The effect of pollution on living organisms can sometimes also be investigated by monitoring levels of naturally occurring constituents of the organism. The effects of acid rain on trees, for instance, include a decrease in the concentration of the alkaline-earth ions in the leaves. 2. Soils and contaminated land Soils are complex materials comprising the following: Weathered rock Humus Water Air
Soils provide nutrients for plants, as well as providing physical anchorage and support for growth. Nutrients include nitrogen (in the form of nitrate and ammonia), phosphorus (in the form of orthophosphate) and trace metals such as copper, iron, manganese and zinc. However, not all of the ionic material within soil can be extracted by plants. Some is too strongly bound within the soil structure. Although a total analysis of soil is sometimes performed, the more
137
frequent need is the determination of the available ionic material. The transport of material in the soil is inuenced by the acidity or alkalinity of water in the soil structure, and so soil pH is frequently monitored. A further common analysis is for metal ion or organic contamination of the soil, resulting, for instance, from the misuse of pesticides, dumping of waste material or deposition of pollutants from the atmosphere. The UK denition of contaminated land is land which represents an actual or potential hazard to health or the environment as a result of current or previous use. The contamination may come from a time when there was little environmental legislation. Problems from more modern sites can occur when there have been spillages. There is current emphasis on reuse of land from former industrial brown-eld sites for new applications rather than using unspoilt green-eld sites; hence the necessity for assessing the potential problems. 3. Waste and landll waste disposal sites One of the major ways of disposing of waste is through landll. The waste may contain a large amount of biodegradable material with low concentrations of toxic components (e.g. municipal waste) or it may contain high concentrations of more hazardous material (hazardous or special waste). The United Kingdom disposes of 27 million tonnes of municipal waste by landll each year. When a disposal site is full, the site is then capped, usually by a layer of clay. Although physically stable, the site is not chemically stable and its composition can continue to change over many years. Emissions are in the form of liquid leachate which can affect groundwater and also gases and vapours. The sites will need monitoring for these emissions during construction and for many years afterwards as the composition slowly stabilizes. 4. Sediments and sewage sludge We have already discussed how both organic compounds with low water solubility, and metal ions, tend to accumulate by adsorption on to fresh water or marine sediments (see Sections 2.3 and 2.4 above). Analysis of the higher concentrations found in sediments may be an easier task than analysis of the surrounding water. Such analysis may be of the adsorbed species only, or it may be of the total sediment. The latter is often fractionated according to particle size prior to the analysis. This is important as the adsorption of pollutants can often be related to the available surface area, which in turn is related to the particle size. The latter also affects the mobility of the sediment and the possibility of ingestion by marine organisms. Sewage sludge is the inert material produced as the end-product of the sewage treatment process. The material is sometimes spread on land as a soil conditioner or may be disposed of by incineration, or dumped as a waste product. The greatest concern over this material is the metal content, which may be as high as 1000 mg kg1 total metal in some sludges.
138
5. Atmospheric particulates An important route for the transport of inorganic salts and neutral organic compounds is via atmospheric particulate deposition (see Section 2.2 above). Typical determinations include the elemental analysis of particulate material and the analysis of the organics adsorbed on to the particulate surface. Once again, particle size may have to be determined.
5.2.1 Sampling
The concentrations of the analytes may vary widely from sample to sample, both on a local scale (e.g. adjacent soil samples taken from a eld) and on a larger scale (adjacent elds). Identical plants can possess different levels of contamination. For example, leaves on the windward side of trees are exposed to atmospheric pollution to a greater extent than those on the leeward side. The variation, or inhomogeneity, has to be reected in the number of samples to be taken. The subsequent analysis could be of each individual sample, or after combining a large number of samples and sub-sampling to obtain an average concentration. Sampling positions have to be chosen with care. For monitoring exercises involving large areas, a careful and planned choice of sampling sites should be made. Some of the common methods used for this are presented in Table 5.1. Invariably, other considerations (e.g. geographic features or the availability of suitable plant specimens) prevent a regular sampling pattern. Areas where there is the possibility of specic contamination from other sources should be avoided. It would be easy, for example, to sample soil for general pollution by monitoring close to roads, because of ease of access and proximity to the ideal grid location, while at the same time forgetting the localized pollution from the road trafc. Whenever possible, duplicate samples should be taken at each location to assess local inhomogeneity. If monitoring is related to a point source into the atmosphere (e.g. factory emissions), then consideration should be given to the prevailing wind direction, with an increase in the number of sampling positions in the area of highest likely contamination. In addition, prevailing water currents should be taken into account for marine discharges.
139
Unequal sampling
The area is subdivided by using grids, and samples are taken at xed locations on the pattern. Often a square grid is used, although sometimes the pattern may be more complex, e.g. the herringbone pattern discussed later in Section 5.5.1 The site is divided into small areas of equal size and a given number of sampling points are chosen at random within each area This is used if a preliminary investigation shows areas of high concentration. The size of the sampling areas and number of samples is decided so as to dene the contaminated areas more accurately
Control samples should also be taken at points remote from the area under investigation and an effort should be made to match the control site as closely as possible to the sample site. If, for instance, a factory discharge located in an urban environment is being monitored, then the control site should be an urban site where there is no possibility of similar contamination. The sampling of contaminated areas may involve drilling or digging. There is potential of contamination of the sample from the equipment used and also from the difculty of its cleaning between sampling. The components of the sampler which are in direct contact with the sample would need to be inert and would be typically constructed of stainless steel or high-density polyethylene. Care is also necessary to prevent more indirect contamination from, say, pumps or motors being used for the sampling or from elsewhere on the site.
5.2.2 Pretreatment
This can include the following: Washing of sample Drying Grinding/homogenization These procedures are often deceptively simple. It is easy to forget that most samples are biologically or chemically active and even washing, prolonged warming, or storage at room temperature may change their composition. In addition, some analytes may be thermally unstable, volatile, or even photolytically unstable. Contamination or analyte loss is also possible at each stage of the analytical procedure.
140
Many of the analytes are very common contaminants (some, such as DDT, are classed as universal contaminants) and may be present in the extraction agents or adsorbed on to the apparatus. High-purity reagents, specic to the analysis, should be used. For instance, pesticide-free grade solvents are available from some manufacturers. A blank sample should be included in the analytical scheme to monitor contamination during the analytical process, but the preparation of a blank sample may in itself be difcult for universal or near-universal contaminants. Methods which have been in use for many years are rst described in the following sections, followed by some newer techniques. The latter are instrumental methods which attempt to improve on the classical methods by being more easily automated, with decreased extraction/digestion times and often decreased solvent consumption. All allow a higher throughput of samples. The methods and instrumentation described are now commercially available and are rapidly becoming accepted within the standard methods.
141
many pollutants (e.g. organophosphorus pesticides), but can be used for some organochlorine pollutants.
142
There is no easy way around this problem, although allowing the standard to equilibrate with the sample for several hours would be a good practice to adopt. There is always the possibility that extraction may not be complete for the analyte even if the standard does indicate complete extraction. During the validation of new analytical techniques for solids, there is often a conrmatory analysis of certied reference materials. Such reference materials are chosen to correspond as closely as possible to the samples being determined. Many of the applications of solid analysis involve sampling in areas of heavily contaminated land. In these circumstances, constant quality checks are needed to conrm that no sample contamination has taken place. This is carried out by including in the analysis scheme blank samples introduced at each stage of the sampling procedure (see SAQ 2.5 above). Any positive result from a blank would indicate contamination at that stage.
SAQ 5.1 A monitoring exercise is planned for lead deposited on soil close to a busy roadway. What sampling positions would you select?
5.3.2 Pretreatment
5.3.2.1 Washing Even a simple procedure such as washing may extract the analyte. Patting the sample dry by using a paper tissue can result in contamination of the sample
143
with trace metals. It is consequently often preferable to avoid washing altogether if suitable clean samples can be found. Soft brushing may be an alternative. The cleanliness of samples is particularly important for trace metal analysis where the concentration may be higher in the surrounding soil than in the plant specimen. Some pollutants may have been deposited from the atmosphere on to the leaf surface. If you are studying uptake of the pollutant by the plant, then this would have to be removed by washing. If, however, you were studying transfer of the pollutant along the food chain, then this should be included or determined separately. Dioxins, for instance, are not taken up by plants, but can enter the food chain by deposition on leaves which are then eaten by herbivores. 5.3.2.2 Drying and Homogenization DQ 5.4 Which two factors do you consider will determine the temperature and drying time of a biological sample? Answer The temperature and duration of drying must be a balance between too low a temperature over a protracted period promoting biological activity and too high a temperature over a shorter time period leading to loss of volatile components. A typical drying procedure would be to blow a current of dry air over the sample for a period of up to 12 h. The temperature should not be in excess of 50 C. Alternatively, the sample may be freeze-dried, i.e. deep-freezing the sample, reducing the pressure and removing the water by sublimation. DQ 5.5 Due to the risk of potential losses caused by drying, why do you think such treatment is necessary at all? Answer I suspect your answer will be so that the analytical result can be referred to a dry weight. There is, however, no reason why you could not calculate the dry weight on a second sample. Drying the samples lessens the possibility of change due to biological activity. A second advantage is that homogenization of the bulk sample, necessary if sub-samples are to be taken, is made easier if the sample is dry. Homogenization of the dried sample is often by the use of a high-speed grinding mill. Care should be taken, once again, to ensure that you are not introducing contaminants during the grinding process.
144
Analysis of Land, Solids and Waste DQ 5.6 The use of hexane or petroleum ether as extraction solvents assumes a dried sample. What problems could you foresee if for any reason the sample was not dried? Answer The two solvents suggested are immiscible with water and would easily form an emulsion. In some cases, it may be difcult for the solvent to penetrate the sample.
145
A desiccant is often mixed with the sample during the extraction sodium sulfate is commonly used for this purpose. The solvent can be modied by the addition of a polar solvent such as acetone. Alternatively, the extraction solvent can be changed completely to a solvent which is miscible with water. Acetonitrile is often used in this case. You must, of course, be certain that the solvent is still appropriate for the extraction of the analyte. If the sample will not allow the solvent to penetrate the structure, conditioning the sample with a polar solvent which is miscible with both water and the extraction solvent may overcome the problem. Isopropanol has been used for this purpose.
146
147
may be greater than the depth of any ploughing). For landll sites, samples should be taken over the complete depth of the landll. DQ 5.7 Suggest reasons why there will be changes in the composition of soils throughout the year.
Answer You may have included the following: Biological activity, which will consume nutrients, will be greatest in spring and summer. Rainfall, which may leach out components, will vary throughout the year. Pesticides and fertilizers will only be applied at specic times in the year.
148
5.4.2 Pretreatment
5.4.2.1 Drying Until you remember the great amount of microbial activity in a typical soil sample, it may not seen obvious why as much care has to be taken with drying soil samples as with biological samples. Soil is often dried by equilibrating with the atmosphere at room temperature (under certain circumstances this may be raised to 30 C) for not less than 24 h. Under harsher conditions, the levels of available nutrients may change (this is particularly the case for phosphorus, potassium, sulfur and manganese), while nitrogen-containing compounds interconvert. The last problem is so great that analyses for nitrogen compounds should always use eld-moist samples. 5.4.2.2 Grinding The drying process leaves the soil in large aggregates which need to be broken down into the constituent particles whose sizes range from 2000 m for the coarse sand component, to less than 2 m for clay. This is carried out by using a mortar and pestle, after sieving to 2 mm to remove pebbles and other large particles. 5.4.2.3 Sub-sampling This is always a problem with solids, as any agitation tends to fractionate mixtures according to particle size. The smaller particles tend to fall below the larger particles. Standard methods are well established to overcome this problem, with the simplest being the cone and quartering technique. In this, the total sample is formed into a symmetric cone. The latter is then divided vertically into segments and alternate quarters are combined, with the remaining half being rejected. The process can be repeated successively until the required sub-sample size is produced.
149
Only the last three constitute the readily available nitrogen. Organic material is subject to microbial decay which will release nutrients over a period of time and so a measurement of organic nitrogen should also be included in the scheme. The ionic forms of nitrogen can be extracted with potassium chloride solution. A subsequent reduction with, for example, titanium (III) sulfate, quantitatively converts all the ions into ammonia which can then be determined by standard methods. DQ 5.8 What is the standard method for ammonia analysis? Answer This is by increasing the pH of the solution with sodium hydroxide, distilling the ammonia into boric acid, and titrating with standard acid (see Section 3.4.4 earlier).
150
Heating mantle
Organic nitrogen is measured after a preliminary conversion to ammonia. This is achieved by boiling with concentrated sulfuric acid for several hours (Kjeldahl method). Potassium sulfate is added to raise the boiling point of the sulfuric acid, along with a catalyst. Selenium or mercury are often used for this purpose. A schematic of the typical apparatus employed is shown in Figure 5.3.
5.4.5 Dissolution Techniques for the Determination of Total Metal Concentrations in Soil
The available metal concentration as determined in the last section is only part of the total metal concentration in the soil. The total concentration analysis is occasionally required for environmental investigations. Extreme conditions have to be used to dissolve the soil, such as dissolution in hydrogen uoride/perchloric acid mixtures, or fusion with an alkaline ux (e.g. sodium carbonate) and subsequent dissolution in dilute acid. Once in solution, the metal concentration can be determined by the standard techniques described previously in Chapters 3 and 4.
5.4.6 Determination of pH
Although soil contains water as an essential constituent, it is, of course, predominantly a solid. Since pH can only be dened as the hydrogen ion concentration
151
in solution, then the pH of a soil sample is the pH of water in equilibrium with that particular soil. DQ 5.9 This denition of soil pH gives a hint to a potential difculty in this seemingly simple analysis. What is this problem? Answer The water is in equilibrium with the soil. Any change of the conditions (even adding more water) can alter the equilibrium, and hence the pH. At the very least, a thick paste of soil and water is necessary to measure the pH. The added water should be such that there is minimum disturbance to the solution equilibrium. A salt solution (potassium or calcium chloride) is often used to form the paste, and this is then left for one hour for the equilibrium to be re-established.
SAQ 5.3 Which instrumental methods would be used for the analysis of the following species in soil extracts: Potassium Calcium Magnesium and trace metals Available phosphorus (present as orthophosphate)?
152
possible that the soil had been contaminated with chlorinated solvents from the previous industrial activities. DQ 5.10 Look at the UK denition of contaminated land given above in Section 5.1. What effect does this denition have on likely analytical schemes and subsequent data interpretation?
Answer The denition includes the phrase actual and potential hazard. Compounds or ions may be present in such low concentrations that they do not present a hazard unless they are known to bioconcentrate (see Section 2.3.1 earlier). Some estimation of the total quantity of the contaminant on the site is also necessary. The physical and chemical forms of the materials (i.e. speciation) will need to be determined as they will affect whether a material will be released under given environmental conditions. Consider the difference in the toxicities of chromium (III) and chromium (VI) discussed earlier in Section 4.3.7. The denition is based on hazard to health. Consideration has to be taken of the potential migration of the compounds and the location of target organisms or vulnerable sections of the environment. Sampling and analyses should then be concentrated on this route (see Section 2.6 above). The interpretation of the data with respect to whether there is a actual or potential hazard to health depends to a large extent on the end use of the land. The same analytical data can be interpreted in different ways according to its future use!
Analysis of Land, Solids and Waste Answer It may not be obvious how to dene the area in which contamination has occurred. A small number of sampling sites may, in fact, miss areas of pollution. Sampling can also often be complicated by the variety of solids which may make up the land on an old industrial site. This could be soil, sand, shale, brick, remnants of concrete buildings and other industrial waste.
153
Particular care should be taken where there is likely to be small areas of relatively high concentrations of contamination (hot spots) that the sampling scheme will be the most suitable. It is quite possible that contamination from a single source on to sloping land is in the form of a ribbon from the source. If a regular grid sampling strategy is used (see Table 5.1 above), a herringbone-type grid is sometimes suggested as this would be less likely to miss ribbon contamination than the common square-grid pattern (Figure 5.4). At this stage, simple surface tests could be performed, sampling with trowels or with one of the soil samplers shown earlier in Figure 5.2. You should remember the potentially corrosive nature of many industrial contaminants and all tools should be either PTFE-coated or made of stainless steel. A number of eld monitors have been developed for rapid site assessment to lessen the need for expensive laboratory analysis. These include the following: (i) Immunoassay test kits. Did you notice when we were looking at water immunoassay kits (see Section 4.2.5 above) that many were for industrial contaminants? Much of the development for these kits has been for contaminated land analysis. The kits include simple apparatus to extract the contaminant from the soil into solution. Immunoassay of the extract then follows. (ii) Portable X-ray uorescence (XRF) spectrometers. XRF is a method for elemental analysis which has the great advantage that it can directly analyse
Figure 5.4 Some examples of sampling strategies employed for localized contamination.
154
solids as well as liquids. Within chemical analytical laboratories, it has been used much less than atomic techniques (see Section 4.3.3 above) due to lower accuracy, often attributable to strong matrix effects. Simplied instruments can be made portable and give readings in the mg kg1 concentration range. Lead analysis is a typical application. The theory and instrumentation of XRF will be described later in Section 7.4.1. (iii) Monitors for specic groups of compounds. These are based on spectroscopic properties which can identify the groups without separation. UV uorescence monitors can be used for PAHs (c.f. Section 4.2.4) and infrared absorption for hydrocarbons (cf. Section 4.2.6). Some other uses of IR for environmental analysis will be discussed later in Chapter 6. (iv) Gas monitors. These include portable gas chromatographs, methane gas analysers and direct-reading instruments for the analysis of individual gases. These will all be described below in Chapter 6.
155
Valve-retaining pin
Sample chamber
This allows sampling to take place at specic depths. Bailers are relatively cheap and so a different one can be used for each new borehole. This would remove the possibility of cross-contamination. However, only small sample volumes (a few hundred millilitres) can be extracted at any one time. If pumps are used for water sampling, they need to be of low enough ow to minimize mixing of the water. Such mixing would increase the suspended solid content. Suction pumps are only useful to a depth of 2025 ft and may strip out dissolved gases or volatile organics. A conventional borehole takes 68 h to drill. A number of techniques (directpush probes, such as KVA samplers, and also geo-probes) are now available which can reduce the time for drilling samples by a factor of at least 10. This leads to a reduction in the overall cost of the analysis. Their more rapid use can mean that a larger number of samples may be taken. In comparison with established techniques, there can be a lower reproducibility of the results and their main use is in the rapid screening of sites.
156
Solid samples are stored either cooled or frozen and should be kept in the dark. Water samples should be preserved according to the principles already discussed (see Sections 3.2, 4.2 and 4.3 earlier). If gas sampling is by adsorption on to a solid (see Section 6.2 below), the loaded adsorption tubes should be stored cooled. Pretreatment is similar to that used for uncontaminated soils (see Section 5.4 above) with the possible inclusion of a preliminary separation of the samples into solid types. Porous materials such as brick are efcient absorbents of contaminants. Extraction and analysis would then follow the procedures described in Chapters 3 and 4, and elsewhere in this present chapter. Gas analysis will be described later in Chapter 6.
SAQ 5.4 Place in order, starting with the most sensitive, the sensitivity of the following sites to past contamination. What effects from any contamination would you consider important to monitor? Note that some of the effects may be applicable to more than one of the sites. (a) (b) (c) (d) Public gardens and parkland Residential area with gardens and allotments Car park with a hard surface Commercial site
5.6 Specic Considerations for the Analyses Involved in Waste and its Disposal by Landll
5.6.1 Types of Waste and their Disposal
Each country has its own denitions but, in general, there are at least two major categories. These represent non-hazardous waste and waste which requires additional care in its disposal. Non-hazardous waste could include municipal waste, commercial waste and some industrial wastes. A typical composition of municipal waste (dened in the EU to include waste from households and other waste of similar nature or composition) in a developed country is shown in Table 5.2. Hazardous waste, according to the United Nations Environmental Programme (UNEP) denition, is waste which is likely to cause danger to health or the environment, either alone or in contact with other waste. Compounds could be, for instance, chemically active, toxic, explosive or corrosive. Special waste in the UK is dened as waste which is or may be so dangerous or difcult to dispose of that special provision is required for its disposal. This waste can come from a large variety of sources, not just from industry. Have a look in your home to nd cleaning agents and garden pesticides which may come under this category.
157
Although these types of waste are often referred to as solid waste, individual components of the waste may also be semi-solid sludges or liquids. This presents a major analytical problem, not only for monitoring of the disposal site itself, but also of materials prior to disposal. Much of the waste is disposed of by landll. There are differences in the landll process, not only according to the type of waste but also from country to country. The disposal method will, of course, affect the nature and rate of emissions into the environment. A containment landll site is constructed with a natural (clay/shale) or synthetic lining. Any release of liquid (leachate) into the wider environment would be expected to be low but would still need to be monitored. A co-disposal site is where several types of waste are mixed in order to promote natural processes of degradation. It is assumed that by the time any water leaves the site it will be environmentally acceptable. Most modern sites would include some form of containment to minimize the release and have collection systems to treat the leachate. Entombment is where the waste is stored in a relatively dry form so there is slow degradation of the waste with time, with the site taking up to 50 years to stabilize. Monitoring of the disposal site is necessary, not only as the site is being lled, but must be continued as the site matures. Regulations may require this monitoring for many decades. Analyses could be on site, using mobile laboratories, or using samples taken to remote laboratories. DQ 5.12 Which analyses would you consider important for the environmental monitoring of landll sites? Answer Environmental concern would be centred on monitoring compounds escaping from the site. This could be either as aqueous leachates or as gaseous emissions. Analyses may be for major components and their inter-reaction products, as well as for trace compounds. Analyses is also necessary for any materials (e.g. solids, sludges or liquids) being added
158
Introduction to Environmental Analysis to the site. You may consider the major environmental concern over waste is for hazardous or special waste but you should realize that problems can also arise from non-hazardous waste. As organic waste breaks down, a leachate can be produced with an extremely high BOD. There could also be hazardous trace components.
The high biodegradable component of municipal waste is of current concern within the EU and strategies are currently being formulated for its minimization. Waste disposal may be the most common form of entry into the environment for some trace pollutants. Polychlorinated biphenyls are in use for electrical insulation and have largely been in sealed units. It is only when they are incorrectly discarded that there is any major escape into the environment.
Ground level
Landfill
4 Liner
Groundwater
Leachate flow
Figure 5.6 Schematic of a typical containment site showing possible sampling methods and locations; 1, water monitoring wells at various depths; 2, suction lysimeters; 3, collection lysimeters; 4, gas monitoring wells; 5, gas sampling probe; 6, surface gas monitoring.
159
Any escape of liquid from the site will percolate downwards until it reaches groundwater. During design of the site, a preliminary survey should have been made to determine the likely direction of ow and monitoring positions are based on this information. Groundwater is monitored by boreholes sunk to a number of depths. Additional monitoring should be made closer to the site (in particular, underneath the landll) where the soil has not become saturated with water. This is known as the unsaturated region or vadose zone. Liquid sampling in this region uses instruments known as lysimeters. The most common type for waste site monitoring is the suction lysimeter. This extracts the liquid from the soil by negative pressure inside a porous sampling vessel (Figure 5.7). A more simple design, i.e. a collection (or pan) lysimeter, can be used underneath the containment site. This has the form of a large horizontal tray lled with stone or gravel and covered with a fabric screen. The soil moisture percolates into the tray and subsequently drains into a sump which is accessible from the surface. The liquid is periodically extracted from the sump for analysis. Gases are sampled both within the ground and on the surface. Ground sampling uses xed boreholes or sampling probes. These probes are galvanized pipes which
Sample withdrawal to bottle
Borehole Backfill Bentonite (clay) seal Plastic pipe Porous cup Sand Bentonite (clay) seal
160
can be very easily driven into the solid material and which contain perforations or slots at the required sampling depths. Once again, samples would need to be taken at several depths to gain the overall picture. If the sample is not analysed directly by portable equipment, collection of the vapour could be by any of the standard techniques (adsorbent tube, sample bag or container, or syringe) which will be discussed later in Chapter 6. Solid samples can be readily putrescible or reactive. They should be stored at 4 C. Water samples should be preserved according to the principles already discussed (see the earlier Sections 3.2, 4.2 and 4.3).
161
acetone/sodium hydroxide leaching solution for 18 h. Volatile material is then extracted by purge-and-trap techniques and determined by gas chromatography. If any of a set of volatile organics are present at levels above a threshold value, then the waste is considered to be toxic. 5.6.3.4 Metals Digestion is typically by reuxing with 1:1 nitric acid with the later addition of hydrogen peroxide and, for some metals (e.g. copper and iron), concentrated hydrochloric acid. After dilution and ltration, or centrifugation, the sample is then ready for atomic spectrometric analysis. X-ray uorescence spectrometry (see Sections 5.5.1 and 7.4.1) may also be used to advantage, particularly when employing portable spectrometers, utilizing its capability of elemental analysis regardless of whether the sample is solid, liquid or mixed. 5.6.3.5 Quality Assurance Quality assurance is of major importance in waste analysis and you may nd in standard procedures that blanks are added at several stages of the analytical process (e.g. eld, trip and equipment blanks) to check for lack of contamination. In addition, quality checks would be made with spiked samples and spiked blanks (see Section 2.9 earlier).
162
Introduction to Environmental Analysis DQ 5.13 By looking back at Chapter 4, devise a simple preliminary separation scheme which separate the organics into groups of similar compounds. Answer You could separate the organics into groups which are extractable under neutral, acidic or basic conditions (see Section 4.2.2). Headspace techniques could be used to separate volatiles. You should have noted from SAQ 4.1 that the USA Environmental Protection Agency uses this type of categorization to classify priority pollutants. Much of the organic material may, however, be non-extractable, partly consisting of high-molecular-mass, and perhaps colloidal, compounds (see Section 3.1 earlier) from the partial decomposition of the organic material in the waste.
Analyses for the extractable components follow the methods discussed previously in Chapters 3 and 4, after taking into account the higher concentrations and more complex analytical matrix involved. The discussion questions given below are to encourage you to examine how these analytical procedures are used. DQ 5.14 What modications would you suggest would be needed for the BOD and COD methods described earlier in Section 3.3? Answer The BOD values shown above in Table 5.3 are extremely high and the samples would need to be diluted by up to a 1000 times. After dilution, the samples may have low nutrient levels, and thus additional nutrients would have to be considered. The microbial activity necessary for the test may also be inhibited by other components in the waste. For the COD analysis, note the high relative concentration of chloride ions (Table 5.3), particularly in the mature leachate. Mercury (II) sulfate may need to be included in the procedure in order to minimize any potential interference. 5.6.4.1 Trace Organics In this case, analysis is most often carried out by GC. HPLC with UV detection can be used for the analysis of trace components in leachates which are liable to contain high concentrations of hydrocarbons (e.g. from dumped fuel). The hydrocarbons themselves exhibit no response. You could compare this to analysis by GC (with ame ionization detection) where the chromatogram would be swamped with hydrocarbon peaks unless there was a substantial clean-up stage. A second use of HPLC would be to investigate high-molecular-mass components
163
which are not sufciently volatile for direct GC analysis. Ion chromatography may be used for non-extractable organic acids. DQ 5.15 Which GC column type would you think best for determining trace organics in leachates? Answer Capillary columns are needed to separate the large number of expected components (see Section 4.2.3 above). Wide-bore, rather than narrowbore, capillaries would be preferred as these are less likely to be affected by high-molecular-mass impurities. They may be necessary if sample introduction is by a purge-and-trap device. 5.6.4.2 Target Compounds Preliminary investigations may be simplied if compounds can be identied which can act as markers for pollution. These are known as target compounds. A typical application would be to identify if groundwater was polluted. Often, volatile non-polar organics are used. DQ 5.16 Why do you think volatile non-polar organics are used? Answer Volatile compounds tend to be relatively small molecules. These are more soluble than their higher-molecular-mass analogues (see Section 2.3 above) and so are more likely to have migrated away from the source. The volatility of the compounds is not a problem in groundwater as there is little chance of vaporization. Highly polar compounds (e.g. acetone, ethanol and acetic acid) can be analysed by GC but they are more problematic than neutral compounds. Such compounds may produce tailing GC peaks or need prior derivitization before analysis. Marker compounds can also be used to identify compound classes within complex mixtures. BTEX compounds (benzenetolueneethylbenzene xylene(s)) may be used to indicate the presence of petroleum products. 5.6.4.3 Trace Metal Analysis We have seen earlier in Section 4.3 that metal analysis in natural waters is now largely carried out by using atomic spectrometric techniques. This is also the case for leachate analysis. If spectrometric techniques were attempted, the additional metal ions present in the complex mixture could lead to interferences in the analyses. Leachate sample preparation may be different from what we
164
found with relatively pure natural waters samples. A decision rst needs to be made as to whether analysis of dissolved or suspended metal is required. The metal content in the suspended solids may, in fact, be greater than in solution and so any dissolution stage would lead to an unrepresentative analytical concentration. It may be considered better to analyse the solid and dissolved components separately. The sample must be analysed as quickly as possible since the standard preservation technique for metals (acidication) could alter the relative proportions of the dissolved and undissolved phases. If atomic absorption spectrometry is being used, a background correction is necessary due to the complex and largely unknown matrix. Quantication should be by using the standard addition procedure.
N2 CO2
Content (%)
CH4
O2
H2
0 Time
Figure 5.8 The main components of landll gas emissions and their changes in relative concentrations with time.
165
supply of oxygen. After a short period of time, the oxygen becomes depleted and degradation continues under anaerobic conditions to produce methane. This continues for many years until all the biodegradable material has been consumed. Some landll sites collect the methane for use as an energy source. Other components include volatile organics. Individual compounds can reach ppm (v/v) concentrations. These are greenhouse gases and contribute to the volatile organic compound (VOC) loading in the atmosphere. Unpleasant smells and local nuisance can also be produced from the volatile organics, particularly those containing sulfur, and also hydrogen sulde. The total concentrations of sulfurcontaining compounds can reach to ca. 1% under reducing conditions. Gas analysis is both of the ambient air and sub-surface atmospheres for major and trace components. Details of gas analysis procedures will be discussed later in Chapter 6.
SAQ 5.5 Why do you think care in quality assurance and control is particularly important when analysing waste samples?
5.7 Specic Considerations for the Analysis of Sediments and Sewage Sludge
5.7.1 Sampling and Storage
The rst problem with sediment analysis is to obtain the sample from the river or sea beds. Core samplers are available for shallow areas. A simple core sampler used for this purpose is shown in Figure 5.9(a). Using this device, a cylindrical tube is rst driven into the sediment. On withdrawal, the valve system closes which allows the sample to be withdrawn from the sediment. Just before breaking the surface of the water, the tube is then sealed to preserve the sediment structure. In this way, sections corresponding to different depths in the sediment can be analysed, which can provide a historical record of the deposition of pollutants. Grab samplers (Figure 5.9(b)) may be used for greater depths, or where the sediment is loose so that there is no vertical structure. Dredging can be used for coarse sediments. Samples are often stored deep-frozen.
5.7.2 Pretreatment
DQ 5.17 What is the main difference between sediment samples and other samples we have looked at, which may modify the pretreatment?
166
(a)
Ratchet
(b)
Figure 5.9 Schematics of sediment samplers: (a) simple core sampler (b) grab sampler.
Answer Quite simply, it is the high water content. On return to the laboratory the sample is thawed and screened to remove large contaminants such as stones and twigs, if necessary by using pressure. Most of the previous methods we have looked at then dry the sample. It would be
167
quite impracticable to remove the water from sediment by air-drying at room temperature and if the analysis is to determine organic material, the analysis proceeds by using wet samples. Samples for metal ion analysis may be oven dried at 110 C before further treatment. Pretreatment may also include the separation of the sample into size fractions by wet sieving. DQ 5.18 A map showing the distribution of trace metals around a marine site for the dumping of solid waste showed a wider geographic distribution of metals in the lower size fractions. What do you think might be happening here? Answer The smaller particles are drifting more in the local currents. Can you remember the other reasons why an analysis of size fractions may be useful? Look again at Section 5.1 above if you are unable to do this.
168
Introduction to Environmental Analysis Answer Environmental analysis is concerned with ions and compounds which are available to living species. Only loosely adsorbed metal ions will always be readily available. The availability of the ions in the bulk of the sediment will depend, among other criteria, on the particle and the chemical composition.
169
Similar conclusions concerning the lack of automation could be made for metalion digestion. Over the past few years, a number of techniques have been developed to overcome these problems and are gradually nding acceptance within the standard methods. All are commercially available. These techniques are described separately in the following sections and then a comparison is made between them.
170
introduction of sample and reagents into the extraction vessels by using ow systems, while others employ manual operation. A typical microwave oven could process six to twelve samples simultaneously. The extraction vessels are glass or Teon and the sample can be blanketed with clean air or nitrogen. The Teon vessels may be pressurized and operate at temperatures up to 250300 C. Accurate temperature control is necessary for thermally labile compounds. One prerequisite of using microwaves is that you need a compound capable of absorbing the radiation in the extraction vessel. If water is present in the sample or in the extraction solvent, there is no problem since this is an excellent microwave absorber. If insufcient water is present, care needs to be taken that the extraction solvent or solvent mixture can absorb the radiation. This is achieved by having at least one highly polar component in the system. The technique can be used for acid digestion of solids for subsequent metal analysis and is accepted for several EPA methods. The water in the acid is the microwave absorber. Typically, the digestion of a 0.5 g sample takes 30 min to carry out. When applied to the extraction of organics, the technique is known as Microwave-Assisted Extraction. Typical analyses would be for PAHs and total petroleum hydrocarbon (TPH). Extraction times are less than 30 min and use around 30 ml of solvent per extraction. If a non-polar extraction solvent is used, then you would have to ensure that there was sufcient residual water in the sample to absorb the microwave radiation. Polar-solvent mixtures can also be used, such as hexaneacetone, dichloromethaneacetone or methanoltoluene.
5.8.4 Sonication
In this method, a vessel containing the sample and extraction solvent is immersed into an ultrasonic bath. Heat may also be applied. The procedure could include a period of continuous sonication, followed by a period of intermittent sonication, perhaps a few minutes every hour for several hours. Alternatively, a succession of batch extracts (say, 10 min sonication for each) could be made, combining the extracts before the following concentration stage. The advantages are seen as the use of less complex laboratory equipment and the possibility of many simultaneous extractions in one apparatus. The extraction time can be less than that of a typical Soxhlet extraction. This simple technique is now part of standard methods for extraction of semi-volatiles from waste with a high solids content (see Section 5.6.3 above).
171
Temperature
Supercritical fluid
Tc
Gas Liquid
Solid
Pc
Pressure
Figure 5.10 A phase diagram for a typical gas, illustrating the formation of a supercritical uid above the critical (temperature/pressure) point: Tc , critical temperature; Pc , critical pressure.
reverts to being a gas or a liquid. This behaviour is illustrated by the phase diagram shown in Figure 5.10. The properties of a supercritical uid can be seen as being midway between a gas and a liquid. It resembles a liquid in that substances have a limited solubility in the uid, while it resembles a gas by having a low viscosity and surface tension. The low viscosity allows the uid to penetrate porous solids easily, and hence the current interest for solid extraction. A number of gases may be used to produce the supercritical uid but most analytical applications now use carbon dioxide. The latter has a low cost and low toxicity. Carbon dioxide has a critical temperature of 31 C, which means extraction can take place at only slightly elevated temperatures. Its critical pressure is 74.8 atm. Typical extraction conditions would be 50 C and 400 atm, with an extraction time of ca. 30 min. You should note that this temperature is lower than those used in other extraction techniques, which may be an advantage for thermally labile compounds. Once the compound of interest has been extracted, the solvent can simply be removed by lowering the pressure. There are a number of possibilities available for the collection of the extract. Volatile compounds can be transferred directly to a gas chromatograph or can be adsorbed on to a solid for subsequent desorption into the GC system. Semi-volatile material can be collected either as a dry solid or in an appropriate liquid solvent.
172
Carbon dioxide is a non-polar molecule and is an ideal solvent for non-polar compounds, although the solubilities of even moderately polar compounds can be low. Solubilities can be improved by the addition of a few percent of modiers such as methanol or acetone which increase the polarity of the solvent. Temperature and pressure also affect the solubilities. A second advantage of supercritical uid extraction is that the extraction process can be made highly selective by changes of modier, temperature and pressure. The extraction efciency can sometimes, however, be highly matrix-dependent. Applications of the technique are now appearing in some standard methods, although development of the more widespread use of the technique may be slowed by the unfamiliarity of analysts to the sometimes unexpected properties of supercritical uids.
Summary
Most chemical analytical techniques rely on the analyte being present in solution. This chapter examines extraction and dissolution techniques from solids to solubilize the components of interest. The analysis can then proceed by the
173
instrumental techniques which have already been discussed in earlier chapters. Solids which are of importance in studying the environment include animal and plant specimens, soils, contaminated land and waste and landll sites, sediments and sewage sludge, and atmospheric particulates. Specic extraction and dissolution procedures have been discussed for each type of solid, except for atmospheric particulates. In some instances (particularly for landll sites), the sampling and analysis of associated liquids and gases is also described. Atmospheric particulates are dealt with later in Chapter 7, after discussion of the gaseous components of the atmosphere in the next chapter.
Introduction to Environmental Analysis Roger Reeve Copyright 2002 John Wiley & Sons Ltd ISBNs: 0-471-49294-9 (Hardback); 0-470-84578-3 (Electronic)
Chapter 6
Learning Objectives To be able to list the major components in external atmospheres and appreciate the need for analytical monitoring. To understand the difference in type and concentration of pollutants in external and internal environments and the difference in approach needed for their analysis. To realize the importance of personal sampling. To be able to describe, compare and contrast the analytical methods available for external and internal atmospheres. To understand simple methods of ue gas analysis. To appreciate the availability of portable instruments for gas analysis and the possibilities of remote sensing.
6.1 Introduction
From your previous knowledge and from the earlier chapters in this present text you should have some idea of the major components of the atmosphere. DQ 6.1 List the components of clean dry air and give an indication of their approximate concentrations. Answer These components and their typical concentrations are shown in Figure 6.1 below.
176
vol % N2 O2 Ar CO2 78.1 20.9 0.934 0.033 CO2 Ne He CH4 Kr H2
ppm (v/v) 330 20 5 2 1 0.5 H2 N2O CO Xe O3 NO2 ppb (v/v) 500 300 100 90 40 20 6 2 0.5 0.2 0.1 0.1
Decreasing concentration
You will probably have included the major components, but many of the minor components might be a surprise to you. You may have considered some of these to be anthropogenic pollutants. There are few of the common gases (chlorouorocarbons being possibly the only example) which are not found in the atmosphere from natural sources. Non-localized atmospheric pollution problems are mainly concerned with increases in concentrations of naturally occurring compounds above the unpolluted clean-air levels. We have previously mentioned in Chapter 1 the problems due to acid rain which contains high concentrations of sulfur and nitrogen oxides. The compounds are oxidized over periods of hours or days to sulfuric and nitric acids by reactions which may include other atmospheric components (e.g. ozone and particulates). Global warming was also discussed with increasing carbon dioxide levels being a major contributing factor. The problem arises from the increased absorption of infrared radiation by carbon dioxide. Introduction of other covalent compounds into the atmosphere can add to the problem, particularly if they absorb at wavelengths which would otherwise not be absorbed by the atmosphere (window regions). This can occur with compounds containing CH, CCl or CBr bonds. Concern over specic compounds includes the rising concentrations of methane (another greenhouse gas) and of ground-level ozone (an oxidant, which produces
177
breathing difculties) which is increasing even in non-industrialized areas. Localized problems in urban or industrial areas can be more complex, not only due to the introduction of a large number of other pollutants but also from atmospheric reactions producing new species. A good example of this is the complex series of reactions which occur each day in large cities in hot climates throughout the world. Under specic meteorological conditions (thermal inversion where layers of hot light air are found above cold dense air, producing a stable atmospheric condition), pollutants build up in the atmosphere without dispersal. Gases given off by vehicles (CO, NO, NO2 , unburnt hydrocarbons, etc.) inter-react to produce a range of oxidants including ozone and peroxyacetyl nitrate (PAN). The chemical changes that occur throughout a typical day are shown in Figure 6.2. These reactions produce a haze over a city, known as photochemical smog, and the compounds produced can cause respiratory problems. There is a more general concern over the emission of all volatile organic compounds (VOCs) into the atmosphere. Many are toxic in their own right, all are greenhouse gases, and they may contribute to the atmospheric chemical reactions discussed above. One of the main reasons behind current environmental concern is the potential effect of pollutants (including airborne pollutants), either directly or indirectly,
0.5 Hydrocarbons 0.4
Aldehydes
NO
0.1
Ozone
6 a.m.
3 p.m.
178
on human health. Most of the population of the industrialized world spend their days inside buildings at work or at home. The monitoring of atmospheres within buildings (internal atmospheres) is then also of major importance. Internal atmospheres are enclosed, thus preventing dispersal of any pollutants. Higher concentrations of pollutant gases than are found in external atmospheres may be expected. Internal atmospheres can also have a much wider range of pollutants than are found in external atmospheres. Large numbers of potentially hazardous chemicals are produced or used inside buildings, for example: Gases from fuel combustion Solvents in paints Gases from cleaning uids There are many unexpected sources. Even some forms of wall insulation can give off a hazardous gas (i.e. formaldehyde). Measurement of ambient concentrations is, however, just one of the many types of gas analysis which you may have to perform. Emission concentrations (concentrations of pollutants in ue gases or vehicle exhausts before they are dispersed into the environment) are just as important, with legislation often being based on these discharge values. Compare this with water monitoring where legislation and necessary analysis concerns both discharges and the receiving water. Emissions from diffuse sources such as waste disposal sites or reclaimed land will need monitoring. Some examples of these are shown in Figure 6.3. Exhausts and ue gases can contain a much wider range of gaseous compounds than are likely to be detectable in the general atmosphere. Concentrations in the wider atmosphere may not build up to detectable levels because of the continuous removal of the gases by physical and chemical processes. Look at the list of gases which may be emitted from a typical coal-red power station, as shown in Figure 6.4, and notice the discharge of hydrogen chloride, hydrogen uoride and even mercury. You may not be personally involved but analysis of the upper atmosphere is important when trying to understand the effect of pollutants discharged on the earths surface upon the ozone layer. Concentrations of pollutants in atmospheres and exhaust streams can vary signicantly over a short time-period and, for many purposes when monitoring atmospheres, the average concentration over a period of time is required as well as an instantaneous measurement. These are known as Time-Weighted Average (TWA) concentrations. In the next two sections, you will nd that some of the analytical methods are very suited to the measurement of time-weighted concentrations, as the analyte is collected over an extended time-period. One reading can then be used to give the average concentration over the whole sampling period. These methods are described below in Section 6.2. Other methods, which are used mainly to give instantaneous concentration readings, are described later in
179
Reclaimed-land emissions
Section 6.3. In order to use these methods for TWA measurements, many readings are necessary, but this can nowadays often be readily achieved by microprocessor control and data storage. What, though, are the most useful time-periods over which to take an average reading? The concentration of many components in an external atmosphere varies over a 24 h cycle. Diurnal inuences include the effect of sunlight and factory emissions. A concentration averaged over the 24 h cycle may be appropriate. The USA National Air Quality Standard (NAQS) for sulfur dioxide (365 g m3 or
180
CO2 12%
CO 100 ppm
NO 500 ppm
HCl 250 ppm HF 20 ppm Hg 0.003 ppm N2O 40 ppm NO2 20 ppm
140 ppb, averaged over a 24 h period) is an example. Shorter-term averages may be required for pollutants which vary rapidly throughout the day. The USA standards (NAQS) for carbon monoxide are based on 8 and 1 h periods. Sampling times of 24 h would not be appropriate for internal atmospheres. The major concern for pollutant levels in internal atmospheres is over human health and, in particular, chronic exposure. The sampling time is then generally specied to be over an 8 h period, thus reecting the length of the average working day. You may come across a number of terms related to time-averaged exposures which are derived from national legislation. For example, the United Kingdom species an Occupational Exposure Standard (OES) for most gases (Table 6.1) which is dened as the concentration of an airborne substance, averaged over the reference period, at which there is no evidence that it is likely to be injurious to persons exposed by inhalation. More toxic substances, such as benzene and hydrogen cyanide, are assigned a Maximum Exposure Limit (MEL), which is dened as the maximum time-averaged concentration to which a person can be lawfully exposed by inhalation.
181
mg m3 18 35 266 5
25 30 200 1
2000.
Although the reference period is normally 8 h, there are also short-term (15 min) standards which apply to any period throughout the working day. This is to accommodate the possibility of acute effects from the gas. The 15 min OES for ammonia is 35 ppm or 25 mg m3 .
182 DQ 6.2
The current EC monthly limit for nitrogen oxide emissions from coalred power stations (measured as NO2 ) is 650 mg m3 . What is this concentration in parts per million (volume/volume)? Answer The relative molecular mass of nitrogen dioxide = 46 Therefore, the number of moles of nitrogen dioxide in 1 m3 air = 650 10 3 46
= 14.1 10 3 mol The volume occupied by 1 mole at 20C and one atmosphere pressure = 24.0 l = 0.0240 m3 Therefore, the volume of nitrogen oxide in 1 m3 air = 14.1 10 3 0.0240 = 338 10 6 m3 Therefore, the concentration of nitrogen oxide = 338 ppm volume/volume. Look back at Table 6.1 for other examples of the two sets of units. By using my approximate molar volume for all gases, the conversion can be expressed as follows: concentration (ppm) = concentration (mg m3 ) 24.0 relative molecular mass (6.1)
The expression is identical if you convert g m3 to ppb. For compounds with molecular masses close to 24 (e.g. ammonia and carbon monoxide), concentrations expressed as g m3 and ppb are numerically roughly the same, whereas for higher-molecular-mass compounds (e.g. nitrogen dioxide and nitrobenzene) the numerical value of the weight/volume concentration is higher than the volume/volume concentration.
SAQ 6.1 What is the difference in meaning in the term parts per million when applied to gas concentrations and aqueous concentrations?
183
Briey summarize the expected concentration ranges of pollutants in external and internal atmospheres, and in exhaust gases. Suggest reasons why we may nd there are sometimes different analytical methods used for external and internal atmospheres.
The above procedure is now a reference method for the USA Environmental Protection Agency (EPA), i.e. it is judged to be the best available technique and can be used to assess other methods. DQ 6.3 What properties must the absorbent possess in order to produce an accurate analysis?
184
Absorbent solution
Pump
Sample flow
Answer 1. The reagents have to be highly specic to the analyte gas. 2. The absorption of the analyte has to be quantitative. Remember that you may be analysing compounds whose concentration may only be parts per billion (v/v) in the atmosphere. 3. The reagent has to be resistant to oxidation and to being stripped from solution. Remember that you are bubbling air through the solution for periods of up to 24 h. Figure 6.6 shows a sampling train monitoring the external atmosphere and conveniently located in a building. This ideal situation may not always be possible
185
Drying agent or Pump other protection for pump the final Drechsel bottle may be empty to act as a splash guard
Gas meter
Figure 6.6 Schematic showing the typical components of a gas absorption train.
to achieve and the train may be located outside, but under shelter. Apparatus is available with the complete train enclosed in a single, portable container. External sampling sites are often determined by security considerations. Rooftops of municipal buildings are often used, even though an environmentally more appropriate position may be street level. 6.2.1.1 Flue Gas Analysis With a few modications from that shown in Figure 6.6, absorption trains can be used for ue gas analysis. The concentration of the gas may vary both across the ue and along its length. Preliminary practical and/or theoretical work is necessary to determine the optimum sampling location(s). The gas may contain highly corrosive components (see Figure 6.4) and so the sampling tube is 316 grade stainless steel or a higher grade of corrosion-resistant alloy. If the train is being used for gas sampling alone (the train may also be used to sample particulates), there should be a glass wool plug in the line to lter the gas. The gas will certainly be at an elevated temperature and will probably be saturated with water. If you are unsure where the water is coming from, try performing a simple calculation to determine the mass of water produced by combustion of 1000 g of a typical alkane such as hexane. Condensation in the sampling tube may occur if the temperature is allowed to fall before reaching the absorbent solution. To prevent this, the sampling tube should be heated. The train is after that point similar to the one shown in Figure 6.6 one or more Drechsel bottles (which may be in icewater to prevent evaporation), and then a drying column, followed by a pump and gas meter. You should note that the gas-phase concentrations of many
186
of these phase components are determined by temperature dependent equilibria, for example: NO + O2 2NO2 SO2 + O2 2SO3 (6.3) (6.4)
In order to obtain the true high temperature concentration, any cooling process in the sample train has to be rapid so as to freeze the equilibria at the ue temperature values. There are many advantages in using absorption trains for gas analysis. We will come across some other applications below in Sections 6.3.1 and 7.2.5. At the end of this main section, you will be asked to compare the methods with alternative procedures.
187
Adsorbent
Adsorbent
Figure 6.7 Examples of passive (diffusion) samplers: (a) badge type; (b) tube type.
Air flow
Glass tube
Sinter
Main adsorbent
Back-up adsorbent
Figure 6.8 Schematic of a typical adsorption tube used for active sampling.
6.2.2.2 Desorption of Sample Transfer of the analyte to the chromatograph is either by thermal desorption or by solvent extraction. The thermal desorption method involves similar equipment to that used in the analysis of aqueous organic compounds employing purge-andtrap techniques (see Section 4.2.2 above). Solvent extraction requires mixing the
188
Adsorption tube
Pump
adsorbent with a xed volume of solvent to extract the analyte, followed by injection of the extract into the gas chromatograph. DQ 6.4 What problems can you foresee in the use of these sampling methods in quantitative analysis? Answer The major problem is in the absorption and desorption efciencies of the sampling. Although, with standard methods, adsorption can be assumed to be 100%, desorption may be less than this and will be different for each compound. Standard analytical methods (e.g. the UK Methods for the Determination of Hazardous Substances (MDHS) series) recommend specic adsorbents to use for each analyte, but even so, the desorption efciency has to be measured for each new batch of tubes and has to be included in the analytical calculations. A second problem is the possibility of overloading the adsorbent. The theoretical capacity of the adsorbent (known as the breakthrough volume) can be found, either from published tables, or by experimental determination, by passing a gas of known composition through the tube and monitoring the efuent air with a ame ionization or similar detector. This volume is, however, inuenced by many factors, including the presence of water vapour, other organic compounds and temperature, and so will be different for each analysis.
189
6.2.2.3 Chromatographic Analysis The chromatographic separation is usually straightforward when using standard columns. There is usually little problem with regards to detector sensitivity for monitoring internal atmospheres and ame ionization detection is often used. The only difculty is in the choice of extraction solvent. Solvents which do not show a response with a ame ionization detector (e.g. carbon disulde, which is toxic and has a low ash point) are often hazardous materials in their own right! For routine analyses, quantication is by comparison of peak areas with standard solutions injected into the chromatograph after correcting for the desorption efciency. The latter is ideally calculated by analysis of a standard gas mixture, although this is not always practicable. A less rigorous approach is to inject a known quantity of pure compound on to the adsorbant and to measure its recovery on extraction. 6.2.2.4 Production of Standard Gas Mixtures There are various methods available, dependent on the particular requirements, for producing standard gas mixtures. These include the following: (i) Small volumes (up to a few litres) of reference gas can be produced by injecting a known volume of the pure compound, as a liquid, through a septum into an enclosed volume of gas and allowing the liquid to vaporize. (ii) If a continuous ow of reference gas is needed, then dynamic methods are necessary. Permeation tubes are often used for this purpose. These contain the volatile organic compound within a small PTFE tube which allows slow permeation of the vapour through its walls into a known ow of gas. The rate of diffusion is adjusted by changing the temperature of the tube over the range from ambient to 40 C. The concentration produced in the gas stream can be calculated from the weight loss of the permeation tube over a given time-period and the gas ow rate. (iii) An alternative dynamic technique for gases or volatile liquids is to inject the compound into a gas stream at a constant rate by using a syringe-pump.
190
Stopper
Acrylic tube
end and has a liquid adsorbed on to stainless steel mesh at the closed end of the tube. The method relies on the natural diffusion of the gas into the liquid. The reagent is typically exposed to the atmosphere for several weeks, after which the absorbed gas can be determined by standard analytical techniques (e.g. spectrometry or ion chromatography). The principle of the technique is that the rate of absorption is determined by the rate of diffusion of the gas along the tube. Ficks law states that the rate of diffusion of a gas is proportional to the concentration gradient. The concentration at the open end of the tube is the ambient concentration. At the closed end of the tube, this is assumed to be zero as it is being continuously absorbed by the liquid. Hence, the rate of diffusion is proportional to the atmospheric concentration. The original validation of the technique was for internal atmospheres where air currents (which could possibly affect the rate of diffusion and hence the accuracy and precision) would be low. The technique, however, has now been successfully applied to external atmospheres and has been used in a number of major atmospheric investigations in the UK. The most common use of the technique so far has been for the determination of nitrogen dioxide. The absorbent liquid is triethanolamine, and the analysis is completed by spectrometric analysis (at 550 nm) of the nitrate released, using sulfanilamide and N -(1-naphthyl)ethylenediamine hydrochloride.
191
For a sampling tube of the stated dimensions operating at 21 C, we can write: Concentration of NO2 (ppb) = QNO2 1000 2.3 exposure time (h) (6.5)
where QNO2 is the quantity of nitrogen dioxide absorbed (nmol). The factor 2.3 is determined from the known value for the diffusion coefcient of the gas and the tube dimensions. The precision of the technique is not large (the variance was found to be 10% under ideal conditions). This can be partially compensated for by the low cost of the apparatus, thus allowing groups of 10 or more tubes to be left at each sampling position. Other applications include the analysis of NH3 , SO2 , O3 and BTEX compounds.
SAQ 6.3 For routine monitoring of sulfur dioxide in external atmospheres by using an absorption train, aqueous hydrogen peroxide is often used as an absorbent, rather than the West and Gaeke reagent (see above): SO2 + H2 O2 H2 SO4 What are the advantages and disadvantages of hydrogen peroxide for large-scale monitoring exercises?
SAQ 6.4 Compare and contrast active and passive sampling for monitoring internal atmospheres.
SAQ 6.5 Alternative methods in the Methods for the Determination of Hazardous Substances series (UK) for toluene in atmospheres use solvent extraction and thermal desorption techniques prior to GC analysis. What do you see as their relative merits?
192
This section nishes with techniques which may be used for monitoring atmospheres directly, without the need for sampling. Instruments for atmospheric ambient monitoring are often based on spectrometric techniques (chemiluminescence, infrared, uorescence, etc.). DQ 6.5 Which of these techniques are potentially the most sensitive and so most suitable for the low concentrations found in ambient air? Answer The techniques involving light emission (chemiluminescence and uorescence) are potentially the most sensitive. 6.3.1.1 Chemiluminescence and Fluorescence The chemiluminescent method used for nitrogen oxides is based on the following reactions: NO + O3 NO2 + O2 NO2 NO2 + h
(6.6) (6.7)
where = 600875 nm. Ozone, generated within the instrument, is mixed with the sample under reduced pressure and the light emission monitored with a photomultiplier, thus giving a measurement of the nitric oxide concentration of the sample (Figure 6.11). Total nitrogen oxides can be analysed by thermal conversion of nitrogen dioxide to nitric oxide before analysis. The nitrogen dioxide concentration is then calculated by difference from the two readings. This is the EPA reference method for NO2 and is also the specied method in EU legislation. The detection limits are approximately 10 ppb (18 g m3 ). The same reaction can also be used to monitor atmospheric ozone. A second chemiluminescent method can also be used, based on the reaction of ozone with ethylene and monitoring the light emission at 430 nm. This method has the advantage of little interference from the presence of NO. The detection limits are approximately 1 ppb (2 g m3 ). Sulfur dioxide can be measured, without chemical pretreatment, by gas-phase uorescence spectrometry, giving a limit of detection of 2 ppb (5 g m3 ). DQ 6.6 What method for the production of calibration gases, which has already been discussed, could be incorporated into these instruments?
[Path for NO analysis] Photomultiplier Reaction cell [Ozone] generator Drier Air for ozone [generation]
Sample [flow]
Converter NOx NO
193
194
Introduction to Environmental Analysis Answer Calibration methods often use standard gas mixtures generated by using permeation tubes (see Section 6.2.2 above).
6.3.1.2 Infrared Spectrometry Infrared absorption spectrometry is commonly used in workplaces for monitoring a wide variety of inorganic gases and organic vapours. DQ 6.7 What molecules are capable of absorbing infrared radiation? Answer All molecules which contain more than one element, i.e. in physical chemistry terms, all molecules except monoatomic and homonuclear diatomic molecules. From an environmental point of view, this includes all molecules except O2 , N2 , He, Ar and the other noble gases. The spectra can be highly complex and each molecule gives a unique absorption pattern (Figure 6.12). As in other areas of the electromagnetic spectrum, the BeerLambert law applies for the absorption of radiation. If you look back at the mathematical formulation of the law (Section 3.4.1) you will nd the absorbance of radiation is proportional to the molar concentration of the absorbing species and cell pathlength. In order to maximize the sensitivity for low-concentration gases, long pathlengths need to be used. This can be achieved by having large sample cells ( 1 m) and also reecting the radiation many times through the cell, thus giving a total pathlength of up to 50 m. Instruments relying on absorption spectrometry for gas analysis tend to be bulky, even though they may still be classed as portable. These instruments may be of similar design to the complex spectrometers which you will be familiar with in the laboratory, which often measure the absorption of radiation after separating the infrared radiation into its spectral components. These are termed dispersive infrared spectrometers. By monitoring the absorption at different wavelengths, a large number of gases can be analysed by a single instrument. One manufacturer pre-programmes the instrument to be able to analyse more than 100 gases and vapours. An alternative design is sometimes used where no spectral separation is necessary. These are known as non-dispersive spectrometers (Figure 6.13). You may wish to attempt to deduce how the instrument operates before reading the next paragraph. When a molecule in a gas absorbs infrared radiation, the net effect is to heat the gas. It can only absorb radiation at the frequencies which are specic to the molecule. The gas present in the detector cell will heat up and expand only if radiation of a suitable wavelength enters the cell. There is no impediment for
195
Absorbance
Sulfur dioxide 4000 3200 2400 2000 1600 1200 800 600
Absorbance
Absorbance
Wavenumber (cm1)
Figure 6.12 Some typical infrared spectra of volatile and gaseous compounds.
196
Light path
Chopper
CO CO
Sample containing CO
CO
Detector cell
CO CO CO CO CO CO CO
CO CO CO
Diaphragm
suitable radiation on the left-hand side of the cell to reach the detector, and the gas will heat up in the detector cell. On the right-hand side, some of the radiation at the carbon-monoxide-specic wavelengths will already have been absorbed by the carbon monoxide in the sample. The heating of the detector cell will be lowered. The net effect is to distort the diaphragm towards the right-hand side. When the beams are turned off, the diaphragm will return to its original shape. By chopping the beams, an oscillation will be produced. The size of this oscillation will measure the concentration of the carbon monoxide in the gas. Non-dispersive instruments are available for a number of gases, including carbon monoxide (EPA reference method), carbon dioxide, sulfur dioxide, acetylene, methane and water vapour. Although each is sold as a separate instrument, remember that the only major difference is the gas within the detector cell. It is this gas which gives the instrument its specicity. DQ 6.8 Infrared spectrometry is a very suitable method for analysis of gases when there are few absorbing species but there may be difculties when
Atmospheric Analysis Gases there are many species. Why do you think this is the case? What alternative method do you think would be more suitable? Answer The complex nature of infrared spectra means that there is the possibility of overlap in absorptions in multi-component mixtures. A chromatographic method (see Sections 6.2.2 and 6.3.3), which separates the components before quantication would be more suitable.
197
6.3.1.3 Application of Spectrometric Methods to Flue Gas Analysis The most obvious method would be to place a spectrometer in a sampling train such as that described in Section 6.2.1 above. The spectrometer would operate at ambient temperature and so the ue gas would have to be cooled before reaching the instrument. However, there are a number of potential problems with this approach. As the gas temperature falls, solids may condense and so a lter is necessary immediately prior to the spectrometer. There may also be condensation of water. The latter problem can be overcome in a number of ways. If the sensitivity of the instrument is sufcient, the sample gas can be diluted with clean dry air to prevent the condensation. Alternatively, a permeation drier can be used in which the gas passes through tubes constructed of Naon, a synthetic polymer which is selectively permeable to water. A chiller can also be used, rapidly cooling the sample to 35 C to remove the water (Figure 6.14). DQ 6.9 What property of a gas would make the cooling and water-condensation approach unsuitable? Give an example of a gas with this property.
Spectrometer
Flow meter Filter Chiller 35C Heated sample line, including filter Water drain Pump
Figure 6.14 Schematic of a typical sampling train for the spectrometric determination of ue gases.
198
Introduction to Environmental Analysis Answer A high solubility in water. The most problematic of the common gases in this respect is hydrogen chloride.
For hydrogen chloride and other water-soluble gases, an alternative method would be to use a spectrometer which can operate at ue-gas temperatures. Hydrogen chloride is analysed by this method using infrared spectrometry. Chemiluminescence and UV spectrometers are also available to measure NOx and sulfur dioxide, respectively. You should, however, bear in mind when using these instruments that the concentration measured is for the gas stream containing moisture. Recalculation of the concentrations to dry values (i.e. removing the moisture contribution) is necessary to provide data comparable with roomtemperature methods. Infrared spectrometry may be used to determine the concentrations in ue gases directly by placing an IR source and the detector on each side of the ue. Instruments are available for CO, CO2 , SO2 , CH4 and N2 O. A narrow-wavelength range is chosen which includes the absorption wavelength of the compound of interest and has minimum interference from other gases. There are many problems with this approach, such as the absorption of radiation by dust in the gas and the need to keep the optical components clean. One solution, as used in a carbon monoxide analyser, is to have a double beam of radiation, i.e. an analytical beam and a reference beam. Both beams will be equally affected by the unwanted absorptions. You will almost certainly have already come across double-beam UV or IR spectrometers which are used in the laboratory because they have better stability to background and radiation source variations than single-beam instruments. After both beams pass through the ue and before the detector, one beam passes through a cell containing pure carbon monoxide. The residual beam after the cell will be unaffected by small variations in carbon monoxide in the ue gas and acts as the reference. Optical components are kept clean by purge streams of clean air, although the instrument still requires recalibration every few minutes by inserting cells containing pure gas into the analytical beam. 6.3.1.4 Electrochemical Sensors As we have already found, there is often a need for personal monitoring within a workplace environment, particularly for industrial gases (e.g. NH3 , CO2 , Cl2 , HCN, HCl, H2 S and SO2 ) which may quickly build up in atmospheres through leakages, or accumulate in unventilated areas. Personal monitors are available for individual gases which are based on electrochemical sensing, with a different sensing head being required for each gas. The reaction of the analyte gas at an electrode produces a current which is proportional to its gas-phase concentration. The monitors normally possess a concentration display and also an audible alarm if the pre-set maximum concentration is exceeded. Instruments need to be
199
periodically recalibrated (perhaps every few weeks) for the zero reading and, by using a standard gas mixture, at a value close to the maximum of the measuring range. The cheapness today of computer storage and data processing is having a major effect on workplace and personal monitoring. The advent of data loggers means that results may be stored for later processing. Some sensors have data loggers as an integral part of the instrument, and thus the exposure of an individual over a working day can be quickly recalled. Such information could have implications for the establishment of safety levels. Current levels are based on either 8 h long-term or 15 min short-term time-weighted averages (see Section 6.1 above). Logging sensors are typically capable of measuring and storing 10 s averages. They can show that, even at a single location, instantaneous measurements vary dramatically and that a simple average may not be a good method of representing the true exposure of an individual. The person may be exposed to far higher levels for short periods of time. This can have severe effects on an individuals long-term health. DQ 6.10 Portable site instruments use infrared absorption techniques, whereas personal instruments use solid-state electrochemical methods. Can you explain why different methods are used for each application? Answer Infrared absorption varies with concentration and pathlength according to the BeerLambert law. For maximum sensitivity for low-concentration gases, long pathlengths are necessary (several metres). This leads to bulky instrumentation, even when multiple reections are achieved in the sample cell. In addition, optical components tend to be heavy, and need careful alignment very undesirable features for personal instruments. On the other hand, solid-state electronics are lightweight and rugged, thus making these ideal for personal monitors. Electrochemical techniques, however, do require more frequent calibration than spectrometric methods, so making them less appropriate for long-term background analysis.
200
several centimetres in length, and are packed with an analyte-specic reagent adsorbed on to an inert solid. A xed volume of gas is drawn through the reaction tube by using a hand pump. This may be a bellows-type or piston pump according to the manufacturer. A typical example is shown in Figure 6.15. The sample time is a few seconds, during which a colour develops from the sampling end of the tube. At the end of the sampling period, the colour should extend along a fraction of the length of the tube. The tubes are pre-calibrated with a concentration scale on the glass surface so that the distance the colour has travelled can be directly related to the gas concentration. The colour may be produced by a number of methods. In some cases, a coloured product is formed from colourless reagents. Hydrogen sulde detection tubes contain a colourless lead salt adsorbed on to silica gel. The product is black lead sulde, according to the following reaction: Pb2+ + H2 S PbS + 2H+ (6.8)
In other cases, the colour is due to an indicator change. Detector tubes for carbon dioxide contain hydrazine as the reactant and crystal violet as the redox indicator. The reaction with carbon dioxide causes the indicator to change colour to purple, as follows: CO2 + N2 H4 H2 NNHCO2 H (6.9) A range of tubes is available for each gas to accommodate different concentration ranges. These ranges are typical of internal atmospheres and emission concentrations (ppm to percentage levels), but can in some cases be extended to lower levels. This is achieved by increasing the gas volume sampled by using a continuous pump rather than a bellows system. Under these circumstances, care has to be taken that the reagent will not be stripped from the support or oxidized (check in Section 6.2.1 above for similar potential problems encountered with
Reading
Developed colour
201
reagents in absorption trains). The tubes are not generally used for sampling periods of longer than a few minutes, and hence are not suitable for very low level contamination. Two further problems need to be considered before the application of these tubes: (i) Precision. The relative standard deviation varies from compound to compound. In the most favourable cases (e.g. hydrogen sulde detection), where the chemical reaction proceeds rapidly, the relative standard deviation is 510%. In less favourable cases (e.g. mercury detection), a relative standard deviation of 2030% may be found. (ii) Interferences. These are well-known for inorganic gas detection and specied in manufacturers literature. Sometimes, a separate zone of reactive solid is included in the detector tube to remove potential common interferences before they reach the calibrated layer. Carbon monoxide tubes contain a zone of chromium (VI) to remove hydrogen sulde, benzene and other organics. Interferences may, however, be more serious in the detection of specic organic compounds. As an example, adjacent members of the homologous series give positive indications on hexane tubes.
202
Sampling bag
Gas-tight syringe
Figure 6.16 Some examples of the equipment used for gas sampling.
Answer Large sample vessels are necessary, typically several hundred millilitres in size. It is difcult to check for any leakage/contamination of the sample. Minor components may be lost by reaction on the walls of the vessel.
Atmospheric Analysis Gases Injection of large volumes of gas into the chromatograph disturbs the carrier gas ow.
203
6.3.3.2 Chromatographic Analysis Gassolid chromatography is used for the separation of inorganic gases and low-molecular-mass organic compounds. Molecular sieves are often used for permanent gases (Figure 6.17). These separate gases in order of their molecular size. Unfortunately, one of the most important components of ue gas, i.e. carbon dioxide, is permanently adsorbed by the molecular sieve. A silica gel column, which separates by adsorption, is needed for this gas. Note that the other common inorganic gases are not well separated on this column and so a complete ue gas analysis would require both columns. Organic porous polymer adsorbents may be used for both low-molecular-mass organic compounds and inorganic gases. Several manufacturers produce a series of stationary phases, e.g. the Porapak series. The chromatographic separation of the gases can be optimized by a suitable choice of stationary phase within the series. DQ 6.12 Which gas chromatography detector have you come across which is suitable for inorganic gases such as oxygen, nitrogen and carbon dioxide? Answer The thermal conductivity detector (Katharometer) is suitable for all gases. Flame ionization detection, which is often said to respond universally, will not easily detect most inorganic gases.
N2 CH4 Detector response CO
O2
4 Time (min)
204
The thermal conductivity detector has relatively low sensitivity and so cannot be used for trace analysis, with the lower limits of detection being in the region of a few hundred parts per million. The greatest sensitivity can be achieved by the use of a low-molecular-weight carrier gas. Hydrogen would give the greatest sensitivity, but its use is often discouraged on safety grounds. A helium carrier gas gives slightly lower sensitivity than hydrogen. However, the cost of helium varies enormously worldwide and in some countries it is a very expensive option. An alternative procedure is possible for carbon monoxide detection where the gas is reduced to methane by using a nickel catalyst. This can then be detected with high sensitivity by using ame ionization detection. Lower concentrations of volatile organic compounds can be determined by using conventional gasliquid chromatography after rst concentrating the gases using either solid-phase adsorbents (see Section 6.2.2 above), by concentrating the analyte in a liquid nitrogen trap, or by solid-phase microextraction (see Section 4.2.2 earlier). 6.3.3.3 Portable Chromatographs and Mass Spectrometers DQ 6.13 In what ways do you think a portable gas chromatograph may be different from a laboratory instrument? Answer Changes would have to include a reduction of size, weight and the number of gases, plus the utilities used in order to make the chromatograph portable. Most manufacturers of portable gas chromatographs use a chromatography column which can separate the components at, or near, ambient temperature. This removes the need for a high-temperature oven. A carrier gas is an essential component of a gas chromatograph. Some instruments use cleaned ambient air rather than cylinder gas. Detectors which do not need additional gas supplies are also favoured, although ame ionization is sometimes used for organic analyses. This form of detection has the disadvantage for portable and site instruments in requiring the maintenance of the detector ame but has the advantage that the detection response for hydrocarbons is similar and so a single calibration can be used for multi-component mixtures. Thermal conductivity detection can be used as an alternative for high-concentration components. At least one manufacturer uses photoionization detection for trace organic analysis. DQ 6.14 Can you think of a method for determining the total organic vapour content of an atmosphere without determining each component separately?
Atmospheric Analysis Gases Answer One method would be to inject a sample directly into a ame ionization detector without passing it through a chromatographic column. The response would then be proportional to the total organic content.
205
This is the basis of commercial volatile organic (hydrocarbon) content (VOC) monitors. Some portable chromatographs with ame ionization detection have an option to bypass the column in order to measure the total organic vapour concentration. Although you may think that GCMS is a specialist laboratory technique, such has been the recent miniaturization and increase in robustness that it can now be found in site installations. We have mentioned above in Chapter 4 that the use of an MS selective detector may mean that prior separation of components can be less rigorous. Perhaps we could have a mass spectrometric gas monitor without the need for a chromatograph at all? Portable quadrupole spectrometers are now available which can determine individual alkanes and also chlorinated and sulfur compounds. Typical applications would be contaminated land, industrial site and ue gas emission monitoring.
206
Table 6.2 Techniques used and compounds detected in the UK automatic monitoring network Compound CO Technique Techniques include non-dispersive IR spectrometry Chemiluminescence UV absorption at 254 nm Fluorescence Gas chromatography after preconcentration on solid adsorbents, followed by thermal desorption into a cold trap Number of sites 73
87 65 67 13
The calibrant is produced from either permeation tubes (NOx and SO2 ) or an internal generator (O3 ), or it can be a calibration gas mixture (CO). Weekly calibration is manual, using traceable standards (see Section 2.9 earlier). The results obtained are fed into a central computer system. Realtime or near-real-time reports are published either on the World Wide Web (http://www.aeat.co.uk/netcen/airqual/bulletins/ ) or in the UK on the CEEFAX and TELETEXT systems (bulletin boards transmitted nationally on otherwise unused lines in television broadcasts). Figure 6.18 shows some typical reported readings.
207
Figure 6.18 Typical Web display obtained from an automatic monitoring network.
part of mobile laboratories or, for the upper atmosphere, from satellites, balloons or aircraft. The instrumentation needed for this seemingly simple technique is often complex, with much use being made of laser techniques and advanced signal processing. First of all, we must choose a wavelength of light which is absorbed by the analyte and not by other components in the atmosphere. A number of atmospheric components show characteristic absorptions in the ultraviolet region of the spectrum. These include the following: Ammonia Nitrogen dioxide Radicals such as OH Unsaturated organic compounds Mercury Ozone Sulfur dioxide
Many of the spectra of such species are highly structured and a small change in wavelength can move from an absorption maximum to a minimum. Figure 6.19 shows a representation of a section of the UV spectrum of sulfur dioxide. Differential Optical Absorption Spectrometry (DOAS) measures the absorption of UV light over a xed pathlength, which is typically several hundred metres to several kilometres. The source and detector can be at the same location with a mirror at the end of the sampling path or alternatively the source and detector
208
Absorbance 297
300
306
can be separately located at each end of the sampling path. The rst method is currently favoured due to its case of setting up but may suffer from interference by adsorbed contaminants on the mirror surface. The source can be an incandescent or arc lamp, or a laser, with a spectrometer as the detector. The results obtained represent the average value over the whole of the pathlength. Ozone typically has a limit of detection of 4 ppb (v/v) with a 5 km pathlength. Several species can be measured together by monitoring at different wavelengths. A major advantage of this direct measuring technique is that highly reactive species can be measured in the atmosphere, e.g. NO3 , OH , ClO . It is the study of these species which has lead to our current understanding of atmospheric chemistry. LIDAR (Light Detection and Ranging) refers to a family of techniques which can produce a concentration prole within a xed section of the atmosphere. In its simplest form, the source is a pulsed laser. The light is scattered by particles in the atmosphere, thus providing different light absorption paths before detection. A typical range would be up to a few kilometres. Figure 6.20 shows a conguration where the light detector is positioned close to the laser.
209
Figure 6.20 A typical conguration of light detection and ranging (LIDAR) used for remote sensing.
The light reaches the detector over a slightly more extended time-period than the original pulse length due to the different pathlengths in the atmosphere. Looking at Figure 6.20, the light travelling on path ABD will reach the detector before the light on path ACD. The intensity of light reaching the detector is measured over the complete return-time period. This information can be processed to give the concentration of the absorbing species over each of the light paths, and this can be built up to give a concentration prole over the complete sampling range. The most commonly used version of LIDAR is known as DIAL (Differential Absorption LIDAR) and uses a pulsed laser at two wavelengths corresponding to the absorption maximum and minimum, i.e. the second wavelength acts as a background absorption measurement. The infrared region can be used for monitoring local pollution of compounds which do not absorb in the ultraviolet region. More widespread use is hindered by strong absorption of the atmosphere (by carbon dioxide and water) over much of the infrared range, with also the width of the absorption bands at atmospheric pressure leading to much band overlap. A two-laser technique can be used (compare DIAL) at slightly different wavelengths corresponding to the absorption maximum and background. Typical pathlengths would be up to 100 m, with detection limits over this distance in the ppm range.
210
In order to reduce the problem of band overlap, the infrared absorption needs to be measured under reduced pressure. The narrower bandwidth of the absorption lines makes the technique virtually interference-free and also allows measurements to be made outside of the normal IR window region. The main technique used is known as Tuneable Diode Laser Absorption Spectroscopy (TDLAS). In this technique, the atmosphere is continuously sampled by the drawing through of a pressure-reducing valve, with absorption measurements being taken at typically 30 mbar pressure. The technique is often used for single pollutant studies as it is not easy to cover large wavelength ranges with diode lasers. This method as described is obviously not remote sensing in as far as samples have to taken for introduction into the spectrometer. It is, however, frequently used in mobile laboratories alongside the other techniques described in this section. DQ 6.15 TDLAS has been used in true remote sampling mode for measurements in the upper atmosphere. The spectrometer components and reection mirror are suspended from a balloon with the absorption path being the atmosphere between the spectrometer and mirror. Why do you think this form of infrared spectrometry can be used for direct atmospheric measurements in the upper atmosphere but not in the lower atmosphere? Answer As you proceed up in the earths atmosphere, the atmospheric pressure decreases. High enough up in the atmosphere, the pressure is low enough to decrease the bandwidth of the absorption lines to remove band overlap, and so potential interferences.
SAQ 6.6 Compare the potential uses of absorption trains, adsorption on to solids and direct-reading instruments as methods of analysis for atmospheric samples.
SAQ 6.7 Which techniques would you use for the following analyses? (a) Nitrogen dioxide in the external atmosphere at several locations. (b) An organic solvent in a laboratory atmosphere. (c) Carbon monoxide, to protect a worker in an area where there may be rapid increases in concentration.
211
Draw a graph which has as the x-axis ease of use in eld (scale, easyhard) and the y-axis precision (scale, lowhigh), and mark the approximate positions you would place the following: Detector tubes Passive sampling Active sampling Electrochemical sensors Portable infrared spectrometers Portable gas chromatographs Remote sensing Analytical spectrometers
Summary
Concern over gaseous pollutants includes not only those found in external (outdoor) atmospheres, but also internal (indoor) atmospheres, since both can have an effect on human health. The types of pollutant found in these two areas can differ in chemical type and in concentration, with higher concentrations often being found with internal atmospheres. The concentrations can often change rapidly with time. Concentrations averaged over a xed time-period (time-weighted averages) are the most appropriate measurements for long-term investigations. A detailed study of a pollution incident would, however, require instantaneous concentration measurements. Methods have been described for both of these types of measurement, and include techniques which determine concentrations directly in the eld (including remote sensing), and techniques requiring the analysis to be completed in the laboratory. Use of such methods for ue gas analysis is also described.
Introduction to Environmental Analysis Roger Reeve Copyright 2002 John Wiley & Sons Ltd ISBNs: 0-471-49294-9 (Hardback); 0-470-84578-3 (Electronic)
Chapter 7
Learning Objectives To understand the importance of particulate material in the atmosphere and the importance of particle size. To determine appropriate methods of sampling particulates in external and internal atmospheres and in ue gases. To assess the relative merits of analyses involving sample dissolution and methods not requiring a dissolution stage. To appreciate the range of solid-state analytical techniques which may be available in specialist laboratories.
7.1 Introduction
Have we now discussed analysis of all of the major components of the atmosphere? Certainly not! We have only looked at gases and vapours so far. An equally important component is the particulate matter. Particulates are a natural component of the atmosphere. They include the following: Condensation products from natural combustion (forest res, volcanoes, etc.). Products of reaction of trace gases (ammonium chloride, sulfate and nitrate salts). Material dispersed from the earths surface (salt spray from oceans and mineral dust from continental land mass).
214
In addition to these is the particulate material introduced by man. This can predominate in urban atmospheres, with the major sources being combustion and incineration processes. Particulates have an important role in the chemistry of the atmosphere. Many atmospheric reactions which, at rst sight, appear to take place in the gas phase, occur either on the surface of the particulate matter or in the liquid phase in water adsorbed on to the surface of the particle. Let us take as an example the smogs which regularly affected London until the mid-1950s. The primary components of the smog were sulfur dioxide and particulate matter, both derived from coal combustion. In one major incident in 1952, approximately 3000 deaths in one week were attributable to the smog. The maximum concentration of sulfur dioxide was found to be 3.8 mg m3 (1.34 ppm). This concentration, which was very much larger than normal, has been shown to cause no adverse effects in man without the presence of particulate matter. A strong synergistic effect was indicated. The particulate matter provided a surface for the liquid phase oxidation of sulfur dioxide to sulfuric acid, which remained adsorbed on the surface of the particle. The size distribution of the particulate matter was such that, on inhalation, a fraction of the particles lodged in the lungs. The irritation caused by the particulate material was increased by the adsorbed layer of sulfuric acid. Atmospheric transport in the form of particulates is one of the major methods for the dispersal of pollutants. We have seen earlier in Chapter 2 that a signicant route for dispersal of lead is via the atmosphere (the lead being transported predominantly as inorganic salts). Similar routes can be constructed for the other metals of environmental concern. Semi-volatile organic material occurs in the atmosphere partly in the vapour state and partly in the solid phase, either as organic particulates or adsorbed on to inorganic particulates. This category would include most pesticides. Any consideration of the transport of these organics needs to take both vaporized and particulate fractions into account. Let us now consider which measurements may be useful for characterization of the particulate content of an atmospheric sample: (i) A preliminary measurement would be the total particulate concentration. This is a measurement of the weight of solid extracted from a xed volume of the atmosphere by ltration or by other methods (see Section 7.2 below). Typical values are as follows: 70 g m3 rural air 300 g m3 urban air 10 mg m3 factory workshop air 100 mg m3 power station ue gases (ii) The second consideration is the analytical composition. For metals, this is often simply elemental analysis. The analytical task can be more difcult than we found for aquatic samples since the inorganic component of the
215
particulate material may be highly insoluble, particularly if present as silicate salts. All of the analytical techniques we have so far come across involve sample dissolution. Two approaches are possible for insoluble particulates. Extreme conditions may be used to dissolve the sample, followed by the analytical methods for metals which we have already discussed. The alternative approach is the use of techniques which do not require sample dissolution. Organic analysis is generally simpler, involving dissolution, followed by the analytical techniques already discussed. (iii) The particle size distribution is often also determined.
DQ 7.1 Why do you think particle size is important? Answer 1. Transport. The residence time of a particle in the atmosphere is dependent on its size. The greater the size, then the more rapidly deposition from the atmosphere occurs (see Table 7.1 below). Particles less than 0.1 m diameter can be considered to be capable of permanent suspension. 2. Differences in Physiological Properties. The smaller the particle size, then the greater is the possibility of the particle entering the gasexchange region of the lungs. It is this material which will have the greatest potential physiological effect. This fraction of the particulate matter is termed respirable dust, and as a guide would refer to material below approximately 5 m. The larger fraction which enters the nose and mouth during breathing is known as total inhalable dust. 3. Distribution of Chemical Species. If you are studying emissions from a particular industrial process, you may nd that the particulate matter is often within a narrow size range. Fractionation of the dust sample may then constitute an essential part of the analytical procedure.
Table 7.1 Classication of particulate material Particulate diameter (m) <0.1 0.110 10100 >100
a
In still air.
216
Introduction to Environmental Analysis Particle size measurements will be important in determining the most suitable method of pollution control. 4. Effect on Atmospheric Reactions. We have seen that many reactions take place on the surface of particles. The surface area per unit mass decreases with an increase in particle size for similarly shaped particles.
Of major current concern for external atmospheres are the particles with an aerodynamic diameter less than 10 m, known, even in the popular press, as PM10 s. These can occur from a number of sources. Road transport can contribute up to 50% in an everyday city atmosphere but can be a much larger percentage when the concentrations exceed statuary levels. Other sources include power stations and coal res. The levels in built-up areas correlate quite strongly with the numbers of respiratory disorders. The PM10 concentrations at the UK National Air Quality Objective of 50 g m3 (running 24 h mean) have been estimated at producing one additional hospital admission per day (for respiratory disorders) per million of population. There appears to be no safe concentration below which health effects are absent. Due consideration has to be taken in all of the following methods of the low particulate concentrations found in the atmosphere. Even with long sampling times in heavily polluted atmospheres, you will only be dealing with milligram quantities of sample, thus making a very exacting analytical task. As in other sections, we will be discussing sampling methods rst, and then the analytical methods. The analytical methods are divided into those requiring sample dissolution prior to analysis and those which can analyse solid material directly without a dissolution stage. The solid-phase analytical techniques are then briey described.
217
Air in
Filter
Fan
Air out
is most easy to understand when you discover that the earliest types were modied from commercial vacuum cleaners, i.e. it is simply a fan behind a lter holder. Nowadays, of course, purpose-built apparatus is readily available. Typical sampling times range from 1 h for contaminated urban atmospheres to 12 h for clean rural atmospheres, with shorter times possible for internal atmospheres. The choice of lter is based on the following: Retention of correct particle size range. Absence of trace impurities in the lter. Compatibility with the subsequent analytical procedure. Some procedures require the total combustion of the lter, and others its dissolution. Cellulose lters should be used for metals and inorganic anions, and glass-bre lters (or under some circumstances, silica lters) for organics.
218
may be used for elemental analyses, the choice depending on the subsequent analytical procedure. This equipment will produce a representative sample of total inhalable dust. If a sample of respirable dust is required, then a pre-selector is necessary to ensure that only particulates of the correct size range reach the lter. A cyclone elutriator (Figure 7.2) may be used for this purpose. In the latter, the gas is spiralled through a conical container in such a way that particulates outside the required size range fall into a container at the base of the elutriator, rather than passing on to the lter.
Air in
Grit pot
219
Air in
Air in
Targets
Air out
on a number of targets coated with petroleum or glycerine jelly. By constriction of the ow before each target, the linear velocity of the air increases. Particles adhere to the targets if they impact above a specic momentum (momentum = mass velocity). Since the air velocity increases through the apparatus, successively smaller particles will adhere to each successive surface. A typical operating range is 0.5200 m. Typical operating ow rates would be 1 m3 h1 , producing only a few micrograms of sample in each fraction per hour of operation when sampling a typical urban atmosphere.
220
221
), particulate ow.
a heated compartment outside the ue and samples the ue gas by using a heated sampling probe. This gives lesser disturbance of the gas ow, although there may still be condensation problems if the temperatures are not correctly matched. Sampling ideally needs to be in several locations in the ue. The lters are usually of quartz or glass bre and, for low particulate concentrations, standard lter discs may be used. The lter may be in the form of thimbles for higher concentrations. These give the highest surface area for collection of the
222
Flue gas flow
Manometer head pressure drop (linear velocity)0.5 Pitot tube with one orifice pointing into the flow, with the other away from the flow
particulates and also minimize particle loss in handling. They are often placed after a cyclone separator (see Section 7.2.2 above) which removes the larger particles.
223
Air in
Vacuum pump
Figure 7.6 Schematic of a tapered element oscillating microbalance with PM10 head.
source are passed through the lter, with the absorption of the radiation being proportional to the mass of particulate matter on the lter. The inclusion of a radioactive source could mean that for some applications the microbalance may be preferred. DQ 7.2 There are currently several investigations proceeding to compare the results of different PM10 analysers. What reasons could contribute to this concern? Answer Any atmospheric particle measurement will be dependent on atmospheric conditions. The critical conditions could include wind direction and velocity with respect to the sampling head, humidity and ambient temperature (which would affect the collection and retention of volatile
224
Introduction to Environmental Analysis components). The inuence of these factors will be instrument-designdependent. The instrument designs involve a wide range of physical techniques from ltration to optical scattering. Each technique will respond differently to individual particle sizes, thus potentially leading to a slightly different response with each instrument. You should remember that particulates in the atmosphere always occur over a wide range of sizes. Even with instruments based on the same principle, the detailed internal construction may give inadvertent selectivity due to kinetic sampling problems (see Section 7.2.5 above). The TEOM instrument collects samples on heated lters. Some components, such as ammonium compounds (see Section 7.1) and particulate VOCs are volatile. There is therefore the potential that these components may be lost at the elevated temperatures.
SAQ 7.2 List components which may be needed to determine both particulate material and gaseous components in a ue gas by using a combined sampling train.
225
Dry
Wet
Figure 7.7 Schematic of a sampler used for wet and dry acid deposition.
226
1. The SCOPE procedure of the International Council of Scientic Unions which involves the following stages: Collection of the particulate matter in a glass-bre lter (twice washed with distilled water). Warming with hydrouoric acid until the liquid is almost evaporated. Repeating with nitric acid. Making up to volume with distilled water. This procedure solubilizes the lter as well as the sample. 2. The UK Methods for the Determination of Hazardous Substances procedure (MDHS 6/3) used for internal atmospheres assumes that the lead is in a more easily soluble form and employs a simpler one-stage procedure of warming with nitric acidhydrogen peroxide. The lter paper remains undissolved. Once the sample is dissolved, the analysis can proceed by a number of methods available for determining metal ions in solution. DQ 7.3 Which two methods have you come across which may be most suitable for routine analysis of metals in particulates? Answer (i) Atomic absorption spectrometry (ii) Ultraviolet/visible absorption spectrometry For less routine analysis, and particularly for analysis of metals at low concentrations, other techniques may sometimes be used. These include inductively coupled plasma-optical emission, inductively coupled plasma-mass spectrometry, ame atomic emission and atomic uorescence techniques. Ion chromatography can also be used for common main group metal ions (Na+ , K+ , Ca2+ and Mg2+ ) as well as for common anions. The sensitivity of each technique is different for each element. Some comparative data are shown in Table 7.2. Take care, though, when using such a table as limits may change between equipment manufacturers and with improvements in instrumentation. If you assume a l m3 air sample with the metal extracted into 5 ml of acid, the table covers a range of detection limits from 4 g m3 (Cd using atomic emission) to 5 106 g m3 (Ca using atomic uorescence and Pb using ICP-MS).
227
Table 7.2 Comparative detection limits (g l1 ) of atomic spectrometric techniques Element Ca Cd Mn Pb Furnace AAS 0.05 0.003 0.01 0.05 ICP-OES (axial viewing) 2 0.2 0.1 0.8 ICP-MS 2 0.003 0.002 0.001 Flame atomic emission 0.1 800 5 100 Atomic uorescence 0.001 0.01 2 10
organic solvent. The components of the extract can then be determined by the chromatographic and spectrometric methods described earlier in Chapter 4.
SAQ 7.3 Atomic absorption and ultraviolet/visible spectrometry are often specied as alternatives in standard methods for the analysis of metals as particulates in workplace atmospheres. This contrasts with the predominance of atomic spectrometric techniques for the analysis of aqueous samples. What are the possible reasons for this difference?
SAQ 7.4 Which feature of the sampling and analysis of atmospheric particulates could account for the large number of different techniques used for the analysis of low concentrations of metals?
228
Elements thus emit radiation at characteristic wavelengths. Absorption and emission occurs predominantly in the rst few surface layers of atoms. With suitable corrections for matrix effects, which may include the preparation of standards with compositions as close as possible to the sample, the intensity is proportional to the concentration of the element. Samples can be in either the liquid or solid state; hence the use of the technique for contaminated land and waste analysis, as discussed above in Sections 5.5 and 5.6. Two types of instrument are available, which differ according to how the uorescent radiation is analysed. Wavelength-dispersive instruments measure the radiation at each wavelength sequentially, using diffraction from a rotating crystal to direct specic wavelengths to the detector (Figure 7.8). Energy-dispersive instruments measure the whole of the uorescence simultaneously at the detector. The contributions from each wavelength are then separated electronically. This type of instrument is more convenient to use and produces more rapid analyses, but has a slightly lower sensitivity. A typical X-ray uorescence spectrum is shown in Figure 7.9. Elements above atomic number 40 can be routinely analysed. By using vacuum techniques, which prevents absorption of X-rays by low-atomic-mass elements in the atmosphere, elements from F to Ca can also be measured. Particulate samples collected on lter paper can be analysed without any pretreatment being required. For routine analysis, concentrations are determined using calibration lters, with quality control procedures including occasional cross-checking with an atomic absorption or ICP analysis. Detection limits for elements vary widely, but for airborne particles they are of the order of 102 g m3 , when expressed as the original atmospheric concentration.
Only radiation at a wavelength determined by incident angle is diffracted
Secondary collimator
Detector Sample
229
S CaK
FeK CuK
104
Mn
FeK
103
16
Figure 7.9 X-ray uorescence spectrum of a dust sample. From Manahan, S. E., Environmental Chemistry, 6th Edn. Copyright Lewis Publishers, an imprint of CRC Press, Boca Rator, Florida.
Instruments are also available for use outside the laboratory. These are energydispersive spectrometers. They can range from transportable instruments for mobile laboratories to hand-held instruments for specic elements. In the smaller instruments, the X-rays are produced from a small radioactive source, e.g. 109 Cd. Larger transportable instruments (and also laboratory spectrometers) generate X-rays by the acceleration of electrons on to a chromium or tungsten target. The hand-held instruments can be used for rapid assessment of elements on particulate lters. As it is assumed that the absorption takes place on the surface layer, there is no need for matrix correction. The same instrument can also be used for contaminated site monitoring (see Section 5.5 earlier), where the instrument is simply placed on the at surface of the suspect ground, and also waste monitoring (see Section 5.6 above).
230
+ 1 n 56 Mn 56 Fe + + (t1/2 = 2.58 h) 25 26 0
(7.2)
The technique is highly sensitive, needing as little as 0.1 g of sample. Detection limits for elements in airborne particulates can be as low as 2 105 g m3 . No chemical pretreatment is necessary and the only physical treatment required is grinding and homogenizing large samples. The one major disadvantage is that you need a source of neutrons, usually a nuclear reactor!
Atmospheric Analysis Particulates DQ 7.4 Solid-state analytical techniques appear to offer many advantages in the laboratory over methods requiring sample dissolution. What are the disadvantages which sometimes restrict their use? Answer 1. The techniques avoid the dissolution stage of other procedures. For particulate analysis, this can be a difcult process. Sample preparation is, however, still required for some solid-state techniques and also in the production of calibration samples. For small numbers of samples, the time saving is then not as great as would rst appear. 2. The direct analysis of solid material also poses problems for the analysis of large samples. The material analysed (a few milligrams at most) has to be representative of the whole. We have seen, however, that this can be put to advantage with electron microprobes which are able to analyse individual particles. 3. Some methods, including X-ray uorescence, only respond to the rst few layers of atoms within a sample. Surface layers may have a different composition to the bulk and, without due care, misleading results may be produced. Another problem with the X-ray method is the possibility of matrix effects. 4. Many of the techniques require highly specialized spectrometers which may not be routinely found in general analytical laboratories.
SAQ 7.5
231
What criteria would you use to choose the analytical technique for several metal ions in a particulate sample?
Summary
Particulate material is an essential and natural component of the atmosphere. Much airborne pollution is, however, also in the form of particulate material. The particulate size is an important consideration as well as its chemical analysis. An analysis of the material starts with sampling from the atmosphere. This is often by ltration. The method used for the chemical analysis depends on the ease of solubility of the material. If the substance is readily dissolved, then the analysis can proceed using techniques already discussed for species in solution. If the substance is more difcult to dissolve, then techniques which do not require sample dissolution (solid-state analytical techniques) may be used. Examples of both types of method have been discussed.
Introduction to Environmental Analysis Roger Reeve Copyright 2002 John Wiley & Sons Ltd ISBNs: 0-471-49294-9 (Hardback); 0-470-84578-3 (Electronic)
Chapter 8
Ultra-Trace Analysis
Learning Objectives To understand the problems presented by analyses of organic compounds (particularly polychlorinated dibenzo-p-dioxins and related compounds) at concentrations of ng kg1 or below. To extend the pretreatment and clean-up methods learnt for mg l1 concentrations to these lower concentrations. To be able to describe the use of GCMS for analysis of these compounds, including the application of isotopes and isotopic standards to quantication and quality control.
8.1 Introduction
So far, our discussions have concerned methods using instruments which are commonly available in analytical laboratories. Although you may not believe it when you rst try to handle concentrations at g l1 or g kg1 levels, these methods can be readily performed by skilled analysts. This nal chapter lowers the concentration range studied by a factor of 103 or more. We will start the discussion of the analytical techniques from the point of view of How do we modify existing methods to gain the required sensitivity?. We soon nd ourselves dealing with instruments which may not be as readily available as those described in the previous chapters. The analyst will need to be highly experienced in order to understand the problems when working at such low concentrations. We have now reached the level at which only a few laboratories in any one country have the necessary skill, expertise and facilities to perform the analysis with accuracy and precision.
234
Introduction to Environmental Analysis DQ 8.1 Why do we need to measure such low concentrations? Answer 1. Concentrations can be greatly increased in an organism compared to the environment in which it is living. 2. Many of the compounds of concern are suspected to have high chronic and/or acute toxicity. 3. Some, but by no means not all, of the compounds of concern are thought to be completely man-made and so any detectable concentration gives an indication of environmental contamination.
I hope you didnt have any problems with the answer. If you did, you should revise Chapters 1 and 2 before proceeding any further.
1 8 2 7 3
3 6 4
Chlorines may be found in any or all of the substitution positions 14 and 69 Number of possible PCDDs and PCDFs Number of tetrachlorodibenzo-p-dioxin isomers Number of PCDDs and PCDFs which have chlorines in the 2,3,7,8-substitution positions = 210 = 22 = 17
Figure 8.1 Structures and substitution patterns of polychlorinated dibenzo-p-dioxins (PCDDs) and polychlorinated dibenzofurans (PCDFs).
Ultra-Trace Analysis
235
The major input of these compounds is from the combustion of organic material containing chlorine. They may also be found as contaminants in some chlorinated chemical products. Combustion sources include chemical and municipal incinerators, coal-red power stations and domestic coal res. Part of the ongoing debate over hazardous waste disposal (landll, incineration or other means) is centred around the toxic products which may be produced by incineration. The compounds also appear capable of being produced naturally by forest and moorland res. Polychlorinated biphenyls (an example was shown earlier in Figure 2.2) are sometimes included under the category of ultra-trace pollutants. Once again, a determination of each individual compound is necessary, with the most toxic compounds being those without chlorines in the 2,2 positions. These are found in higher concentrations than PCDDs and PCDFs and can be separated as part of the extraction schemes to be discussed later. There may be occasions when compounds already discussed as trace pollutants (see Chapter 4) may need to be monitored at ultra-trace levels. Examples could include compounds which are currently being investigated as endocrine disruptors. I will, however, restrict the following discussion to PCDDs and PCDFs as similar techniques can be applied to the other groups of compounds. DQ 8.2 The solubility of 2,3,7,8-tetrachlorodibenzo-p-dioxin in water is 0.019 g l1 at 25 C. This is a solid with a vapour pressure at normal temperatures of 6.2 107 Pa (atmospheric pressure is approximately 105 Pa). Using the considerations in the earlier sections, what can you deduce of its environmental behaviour? What would be the most suitable samples to take for environmental monitoring? Answer Using a relative molecular mass of 322, the solubility is equivalent to 5.9 10 5 mol l1 . If you refer to Figure 2.4 earlier, which correlates solubility in water with bioconcentration factor, you will nd that the factor will be extremely high. It is in fact off the scale in Figure 2.4. The compound is also likely to accumulate in sediments (see Section 2.3). The low vapour pressure indicates that the dioxin in the atmosphere will be predominantly in the solid state, and particulate analysis would be of major importance. Due to the low solubility in water and high bioconcentration factor, many of the early investigations were of dioxin concentrations in sediments and living organisms. Few investigations were of concentrations in natural water samples as these would have been expected to be at or below the lower detection limits. An additional property of PCDDs and PCDFs is their strong binding ability to organic material in soils. Relatively high concentrations may be found in
236
Congener group
Tetrachlorodibenzo-p-dioxins Tetrachlorodibenzofurans
contaminated soils due to the binding preventing dispersion of the material. The soil also prevents photolytic degradation which may occur when the compounds are exposed to sunlight. Typical concentrations of PCDDs and PCDFs are shown in Table 8.1. The term congener group is used to describe compounds with similar structural features, such as having similar numbers of chlorines or having a common substitution pattern regardless of the total number of chlorines present. Compare these concentrations with typical values of other organic pollutants in soil and sludges (Sections 5.4 and 5.7), the atmosphere (Section 7.1), and living organisms (Section 5.3), and you will nd that the PCDD and PCDF levels are lower by a factor of 1000 or more. The separation and subsequent determination of 75 PCDDs and 135 PCDFs is quite a formidable task, even disregarding the low concentrations involved and possible interference by large numbers of other components in the sample. Most investigations restrict the analysis to compounds with four or more chlorines since the highest toxicity is where there are four to six chlorines per molecule with substitution in the 2,3,7,8-positions (i.e. members of the 2,3,7,8-congener group with four to six chlorines). Results can be quoted as individual concentrations or as a total 2,3,7,8-tetrachlorodibenzo-p-dioxin toxic equivalent (TEQ) concentration. This is calculated by weighting the concentration of each individual component according to their relative toxicities, with the scaling factor for 2,3,7,8-tetrachlorodibenzo-p-dioxin being 1.
SAQ 8.1 In light of the low concentrations involved, suggest why we have to measure each individual PCDD or PCDF rather than the total PCDD or PCDF content.
Ultra-Trace Analysis DQ 8.3 What were the main stages of the analytical determination? Answer (i) Extraction of the analyte. (ii) Separation from interfering compounds by chromatography. (iii) Concentration. (iv) Analytical separation and determination by gas chromatography, for chlorinated compounds by using either an electron capture detector or mass spectrometric detector.
237
You should revise Section 4.2 if you have not remembered these steps. We must now consider modications to the method to analyse ng l1 rather than g l1 concentrations. There would appear to be two routes, as follows: 1. Increasing the overall concentration factor in the pretreatment stages. 2. Increasing the detection sensitivity. There may be room for a small improvement in overall sensitivity by method 1 but this will be insufcient on its own. Note, for instance, the nal extract volume (1 ml) given earlier in the DDT analytical method in Section 4.2. There could be at least a 10-fold reduction in this volume, with a corresponding increase in sensitivity. The possibility of increasing the sample size is limited by physical considerations of handling large samples under clean conditions. A disadvantage of this method is that any impurities carried through the extraction scheme will also tend to concentrate. Method 2 could lead to a more substantial increase in overall sensitivity, particularly if selective detection of the desired analyte is included.
238
Introduction to Environmental Analysis 2. Increasing pretreatment to increase the removal of minor components. This will increase analytical time (which can already be of the order of 24 h). Each additional step increases the possibility of sample loss or contamination. 3. Changing to a more selective detector which would not respond to the minor peaks. Most current investigations use some form of mass spectrometric detection. This may allow a simplied pretreatment but can increase, sometimes almost prohibitively, the cost of instrumentation and hence decrease the number of laboratories which can be equipped to perform the analysis.
The effect of the three approaches is shown in Figure 8.2. The wide variety of analytical methods found in the literature result from different emphases being
Detector response
Time
2 and 3
X 1
Apparent baseline noise is seen to be made up of unresolved peaks 1. Increase in column resolution 2/3. Removal of interfering peaks by (i) additional pretreatment or (ii) use of a selective detector The limit of detection is often defined as Peak height = 2.5 baseline noise
Ultra-Trace Analysis
239
placed on the last two methods. In order to understand this, we now need to examine in detail how mass spectrometers may be used as selective GC detectors.
Accelerating plates
Ionization chamber
Detector
240
(a) Quadrupole
Quadrupole rods
Ion detector Only ions of correct m/z have a stable trajectory and pass through the quadrupole
Ionization chamber
GC outlet
Ring electrode
Ring electrode
Ions held in trap in a 3-D trajectory are ejected by a change in radiofrequency Ion detector
Figure 8.4 Examples of bench-top mass spectrometric detectors: (a) quadrupole; (b) ion trap.
molecular structure can be determined from this. However, a simpler method of identication is to compare the spectrum with that from a pure sample, or from a reference library. In order to use the mass spectrometer as a universal GC detector, the totalion current is monitored. A typical chromatogram is shown in Figure 8.6. When dealing with simple mixtures, the chromatographic peaks can then be identied, and their purity conrmed by the production of a complete mass spectrum for each peak or part of a peak. Even with this simple use of a mass spectrometer, you can see how much data can be generated and why the widespread use of GCMS had to await development of cheap computer data storage!
Ultra-Trace Analysis
100 Relative abundance (%) 235/7/9
241
X10
317/9/321/3/5 352/4/6/8/360(M . )
+
40
80
200
240
280
320 350
m/z
Figure 8.5 The mass spectrum of p,p -DDT, displaying a typical fragmentation pattern. From Barker, J., Mass Spectrometry, 2nd Edn, ACOL Series, University of Greenwich, 1999. Reprinted by permission of University of Greenwich.
7 Relative intensity
8 5
20
30 Time (min)
40
Figure 8.6 Total-ion chromatogram of a dioxin mixture; the numbers assigned to the various groups of peaks indicate the number of chlorine atoms in the molecules.
242
One of the problems of the analysis of PCDD/PCDF mixtures is that different species can give identical fragmentation patterns and it is difcult to identify a species on the basis of its mass spectrum alone. The above application of GCMS is useful for preliminary chromatographic surveys but still does not use the capability of the spectrometer as a selective detector. The simplest way to do this is to monitor a single ion, with this usually being the molecular ion of the compound, i.e. the ion with the same molecular mass as the parent molecule. There is an increase in sensitivity in comparison to total ion current detection since the detector spends all of its time monitoring one ion rather than scanning the complete range. The chromatogram produced contains fewer peaks than a total ion current chromatogram, but in a mixture such as a dioxin extract, the chromatogram may still be complex. If the detector is set at m/z 322, for instance, all 22 tetrachlorodibenzo-p-dioxin isomers will be detected as well as ions from other compounds which coincidentally have the same m/z value. Potential interferences in the chromatogram can be detected if fragments are monitored at two or more mass/change ratios. This is known as selected ion monitoring. When applied to dioxin analysis, the technique makes use of naturally occurring chlorine being found as an approximate 3:1 mixture of 35 Cl and 37 Cl isotopes. Any molecular fragment containing one chlorine atom will be able to be detected at two mass/charge ratios separated by 2 atomic mass units, corresponding to the ions containing 35 Cl and 37 Cl. Their intensities should be in the ratio 3:1. If the fragment is not detected at both m/z values, then you have been wrong in your assumption that the fragment contains chlorine. If the relative intensities are not 3:1, and you are certain that there is just one chlorine in the fragment, then this would suggest there is interference from a second ion which coincidentally has an identical m/z to one of the ions. If the fragment contains more than one chlorine, the pattern will become more complex, but still predictable and easily recognizable with experience. The relative intensities of ions containing between one and four chlorines is shown in Figure 8.7. DQ 8.6 Which m/z values could be used to detect the unfragmented 2,3,7,8tetrachlorodibenzo-p-dioxin ion? Answer The highest-intensity ions will be:
12 12 12
Ultra-Trace Analysis
243
1 Cl
2 Cl
Relative intensity
M+2
M+2 M+4
3 Cl
4 Cl
m/z
Figure 8.7 Relative intensities of ions containing more than one chlorine atom; M represents an ion containing entirely 35 Cl.
12
There will also be a number of lower-intensity peaks due to ions containing one or more 13 C atoms, rather than all of the carbon atoms being 12 C (the natural abundance of 13 C is 1.08%).
244
Statistical considerations show that the m/z 320 and 322 ions are the most abundant (relative intensities 77:100) and, in practice, it is just these ions which are normally monitored. You should note that, although the existence of chlorine isotopes is a considerable advantage for the identication of chlorine-containing fragments, it does increase the possibility of other species being detected at any chosen m/z. Consider p,p -DDE (see Figure 2.6 earlier). The most abundant molecular ion has m/z 318 but there are lower-intensity peaks at 316, 320, 322 and 324. Two of these ions will potentially interfere with tetrachlorodibenzo-p-dioxin determinations at m/z 320 and 322. DQ 8.7 As described so far, it would appear that selected ion monitoring possesses a major problem for the analysis of dioxin mixtures. What is this? Answer If the detection is set at, say, m/z 320 and 322, then only the 22 tetrachlorinated isomers will be detected, and not other polychlorinated dioxins. The detector could be set to include additional mass/charge ratios corresponding to the other species, but a compromise would have to be reached as the overall sensitivity decreases with an increase in the number of ions detected. The problem can be overcome by changing the ions monitored during the course of the elution. This, of course, leads to the requirement for the chromatographic column to separate the mixture into isomer groups. Most columns used for dioxin analysis are able to achieve this group separation but this is usually at the cost of incomplete resolution of some individual isomers. You may wish to look back at Figure 8.6 to check this statement for a typical chromatographic separation, and to determine possible ion detection sequences which could be used for selected ion monitoring. We have now discussed both parts of the most common detection method used in dioxin analysis, namely: Selected ion detection at two or more m/z values. Detection of different isomer groups by change of the m/z s monitored throughout the chromatogram. There are, however, a number of other approaches to selective detection. Two of these will be discussed below.
Ultra-Trace Analysis
245
8.2.3.1 Other Mass Spectrometric Methods Although some ions may appear to have identical masses on low-resolution spectrometers, they may often be differentiated by using high-resolution instruments. For example, the following ions (molecular ions or fragments) would be detected at m/z 322 on a low-resolution instrument: Ion Tetrachlorinated dioxins DDE DDT Accurate mass 321.8936 321.9292 321.9219
These may be selectively detected by high-resolution mass spectrometry due to slight differences in their accurate masses. Although this is an obvious advantage as the pretreatment may be reduced, the majority of literature methods still use low-resolution spectrometry due to its lower cost and wider availability. A further development is tandem MS/MS where a single ion (say m/z 322) is subjected to a second fragmentation to conrm the identity of the ion and to permit determination without interference. Many of the original investigations used connected quadrupole spectrometers or a double-focusing and quadrupole combination. The detection limits were generally lower than conventional GCMS. Initial hopes in the development of the method were that such a technique would completely remove the necessity for a pretreatment stage, even for dioxins in complex sample matrices, and hence produce a considerable analytical time-saving. Pretreatment was, however, still found to be necessary for some samples. Bench-top GCion trap mass spectrometers can be operated in the MS/MS mode, in which ions are subjected to a second fragmentation within the trap. The m/z 322 tetrachlorinated dioxin ions fragment to form m/z 259 ions which can then be determined free from the interferences discussed above. This can be used for rapid routine screening of dioxins, although the instruments are signicantly less sensitive than high-resolution instruments.
8.2.4 Quantication
This is normally performed by the addition of known amounts of standards to the sample before extraction (see Section 4.2 earlier). The method will compensate for sample losses in the clean-up stage, assuming that the losses of the standard are identical to those of the analyte, and will also ensure the determination is independent of any variations in the sensitivity of the spectrometer. Fully substituted 13 C isotopically labelled compounds are often used. Ideally, one 13 C standard should be added for each compound to be determined. This is, however, not generally practicable. It is common practice to use just one standard for each isomer group, and this would normally be the compound containing the 2,3,7,8-substitution pattern. Isotopically labelled
246
derivatives are available for all 17 PCDDs and PCDFs which contain this substitution pattern. Concentrations of non-2,3,7,8 isomers can be calculated if their responses with respect to the 2,3,7,8 compound can be determined by using reference samples of pure material. These may not always be available. In general, however, other compounds are not determined individually, with isomer group concentrations (e.g. total tetrachlorinated PCDDs) generally being considered sufcient. Look back at Table 8.1 to nd an example of their use. The group concentrations are determined by using an average response factor calculated from as many individual isomer response factors as are available.
SAQ 8.3 Using GCMS with selected ion monitoring, how would you set about conrming the identity of a low-intensity chromatographic peak as a particular dioxin?
Ultra-Trace Analysis
EXTRACTION Air-dry and sieve 250 g of sample Add 13C standards Extract with hexane/acetone Water wash Remove acetone
247
CLEAN-UP Add to multi-layer column Anhydrous Na2SO4 Conc. H2SO4 on celite Silica gel Anhydrous H2SO4 Elute with petroleum ether
SELECTIVE ELUTION Add to Florisil Column Eluents: Hexane CH2Cl2/hexane CH2Cl2 (PCBs) (discarded) (PCDDs, PCDFs)
FURTHER TREATMENT FOR PROBLEM SAMPLES HPLC clean-up using graphitized carbon column
Figure 8.8 A typical pretreatment scheme for soil. From Determination of polychlorinated biphenyls, polychlorinated dibenzo-p-dioxins and polychlorinated dibenzofurans in UK soils, Technical Report, Her Majestys Inspectorate of Pollution, HMSO, London, 1989.
248
This will form a suitable conclusion to this open learning material on environmental analysis.
8.3.1 Pretreatment
First of all, let us compare the scheme with the analysis of DDT as discussed earlier in Section 4.2. You should note the overall similarity of the individual stages. DQ 8.8 What are the major differences between the two analytical schemes? Answer 1. The initial chromatographic clean-up for the dioxin analysis uses more than one stationary phase, thus reecting the complexity of the extract. The number and type of phases used for dioxin extract cleanup vary considerably between literature methods. Acidic and basic silica and alumina columns are in common use. Note here the use of a multi-layer column rather than individual columns, hence saving analytical time and minimizing the possibility of sample contamination or loss. 2. Additional pretreatment for problem dioxin samples. HPLC separation using graphitized carbon is used. This form of carbon has been found to be highly selective towards planar molecules. It is a straightforward, although time-consuming, operation to determine which sample types need further pretreatment, by comparison of the GCMS chromatogram of one sample with and without the additional step.
Ultra-Trace Analysis
249
Note, for both the steps given above, the necessity to minimize pretreatment time while still maintaining the efciency of the clean-up procedure. DQ 8.9 Why do you think there is a change of solvent composition between extraction and clean-up for the dioxin analysis? Answer The extraction stage uses a hexane/acetone mixture. Acetone is often used as a solvent modier in extractions from solids to increase the polarity of the solvent and to assist in the penetration of the solvent into the samples (see Section 5.3 earlier). The rst clean-up procedure involves application of the extract on to a chromatography column and subsequent elution of the non-polar components with a non-polar solvent (petroleum ether). The presence of a polar solvent in the extract would lower the efciency of the chromatographic separation. In both of the DDT and dioxin analytical procedures, a second column is required to separate chlorinated species (pesticides, PCBs, etc.). DQ 8.10 Why do you think these components were not removed by the rst column? Answer The chlorinated compounds have similar chemical structures. They are all neutral, non-polar, high-molecular-mass compounds and will have similar chromatographic retention properties. The rst column in any clean-up is generally to remove interference from compounds with widely different chromatographic properties. The non-polar eluent used will elute the chlorinated species together. Separation of these closely related species will require a second and more selective column with sequential elution of the compounds by a series of solvents of increasing polarity. The necessity of ensuring purity of solvents and cleanliness of apparatus has been discussed earlier in Sections 2.9 and 4.2 and needs to be re-emphasized here. All batches of solvents and reagents need to be frequently checked to conrm lack of contamination. Pesticide-free or distilled-in-glass grade solvents should be used. Extreme care should be taken with respect to known sources of dioxins. Cigarette smoke and ash can contaminate the laboratory. Extraction thimbles used for solids can be a second source, with dioxins potentially being formed by the bleaching process during their manufacture. The thimbles should be pre-extracted with solvent prior to use in the analysis.
250
SAQ 8.4 Imagine that you were about to analyse a large number of samples by a method such as that described in Section 8.3. What features would you include in your scheme to ensure analytical quality throughout the programme?
SAQ 8.5 There are at least two areas of uncertainty in the analytical procedures for the determination of dioxins in solid samples as exemplied above. What are these?
Ultra-Trace Analysis
251
Summary
Some species (e.g. dioxins and related compounds) have such a great ability to bioaccumulate and such a high degree of toxicity that monitoring their presence at ng 11 or ng kg1 concentrations is necessary. The analyses not only require highly sensitive and selective instrumentation but also a large degree of analytical skill and expertise. Gas chromatographymass spectrometry is most often used. This technique has been discussed, along with the necessary clean-up and concentration stages.
Introduction to Environmental Analysis Roger Reeve Copyright 2002 John Wiley & Sons Ltd ISBNs: 0-471-49294-9 (Hardback); 0-470-84578-3 (Electronic)
Chapter 1
Response 1.1
1. You could write many pages on this rst question. The particular problem mentioned here is the disproportionate proportion of the worlds resources used in the developed world, together with a similar proportion of the waste produced and pollution of the earth. 2. Although volcanic emissions are natural phenomena, at intervals they put into the atmosphere large amounts of gases, vapour and dust, and could be considered a natural source of pollution. 3. The production of methane by cows is again a natural phenomenon. However, since the total cattle population on the earth is largely controlled by mankind, then so is the quantity of methane emitted to the atmosphere from this source. 4. This will directly lead to an increase in the concentration of nitrate above the naturally occurring levels in water supplies surrounding the farms. There may, however, be other consequences. Since all of the species in the nitrogen cycle (see Figure 1.1) are linked, changes in nitrate concentrations may lead to changes in concentrations of other species in the cycle, thus leading to further pollution problems (see Table 1.1). These are all examples of current concern. As countries become developed, more of the earths resources are used. The volcano of Mount Etna in Italy is thought to be a signicant contributor to atmospheric mercury concentrations in Europe. The rising atmospheric methane concentration has, in part, been attributed to increasing cattle populations.
254
Concern has been expressed over the effect of increased nitrate fertilizer usage in the production of nitrous oxide, a greenhouse gas and potential ozone-layer depleter.
Response 1.2
Analysis of the discharge before dispersal into the river will monitor the pollutant being discharged, but will only be related to the nal concentration in the river when used in conjunction with river ow data. Analysis of the river sufciently downstream from the discharge point to allow for dispersal will give a direct measurement of the concentration in the river, but there will be some uncertainty as to the source of the pollution. Analysis of the pollutant in living organisms found in the river will give a direct indication of the environmental problem, but unless the organisms are sampled close to the discharge point, the analytical results would be difcult to relate to individual discharges. The discharge composition was included to encourage you to extend your ideas to consider what extra analytical information would be useful. Quality control of the starting materials would reduce the concentration of the contaminants in the discharge, as would process control to minimize the manufacture of side products. National legislation may in fact specify the requirements of monitoring such as detailed in this response.
Chapter 2
Response 2.1
The rst prerequisite is that the compound must be in a form which allows it to become widely dispersed. Dispersal may be via the atmosphere or the hydrosphere. The properties which would affect this dispersal include volatility, solubility in water, and if the compound is a solid, its particle size. The compound must have a high resistance to degradation within the atmosphere and hydrosphere and to metabolism (chemical reaction) within organisms. If the compound rapidly degraded, there would be little possibility of toxic concentrations building up. Beware, however, of the possibility that the degradation products themselves might pose similar or worse environmental problems. If the pollution problem is related directly to the effect of the material on living organisms, rather than on physical structures, then the compound must have an ability to reconcentrate within organisms. This will be described in detail in the following sections. Finally, if the compound is seen as a pollution problem, it must have some deleterious effect. However, this need not always be the case.
255
Response 2.2
DDT is a high-molecular-mass neutral organic compound. As with all similar compounds, it would be expected to have a signicant vapour pressure. The following illustration indicates some possible dispersal routes drift of the spray from the eld of application, run-off into watercourses, and also volatilization.
Spray drift
Volatilization Run-off
Figure SAQ 2.2 Illustration of the dispersal of a pesticide from its eld of application.
Response 2.3
Both types of pollutant may be dispersed through the atmosphere, as well as in watercourses. Atmospheric dispersal of metals is usually as particulates (in the form of metal salts), whereas organics are found both in the particulate form and in the vapour state. Deposition may occur on to land or into water courses. The solubility of the organic compounds in water is often low, but this can lead to a large bioconcentration in organisms living in the water. The solubility of metals is very dependent on the chemical compounds involved, but for most species will increase with a decrease in pH. There is normally no pH effect on the solubility of neutral organic compounds. The bioconcentration of metals is very dependent on the element being considered; however, for some metals, such as cadmium, this can be extremely high (see Table 2.1).
256
Both types of pollutant will concentrate in sediments. The detailed mechanism for this is quite different in the two cases. Reducing conditions would, for instance, increase the deposition of lead, whereas these would have no effect on neutral organic compounds. Entry into the food chain in an aquatic environment is in both cases by bottomdwelling sh and lter-feeders. Once again, the detailed mechanisms are different in the two cases and this may lead to concentration in different organs in the body. If you had said that there were some similarities in the dispersal and reconcentration you would have been correct, but there are many differences in the detailed mechanisms.
Response 2.4
The metal ions would be likely to concentrate in the sediment on the sea bed and be ingested by lter-feeders. A likely critical group would be the local people who consume large quantities of the sea-food, perhaps the families of the shermen themselves. A second likely path could exist. Some of the sediment may be washed up on the shore. This may dry out and be blown into the atmosphere, or it may be propelled into the atmosphere via sea spray. The critical group could then be people who spend a large proportion of their time on the sea-shore, with the metal ions entering their bodies through inhalation.
Response 2.5
In a highly polluted area, there is the possibility that contamination may occur even at the sampling stage. This is particularly the case if the same apparatus is being used for a number of samples without thorough cleaning. A suitable sample container must be used to prevent contamination or loss during storage and transport. We have already discussed (see Section 2.6) that this should be glass rather than plastic for organic compounds. When working in the laboratory, there is the possibility of contamination by solvents in the laboratory atmosphere. At the instrumental analysis stage, there is the possibility of cross-contamination by consecutive samples. A suitable quality control procedure would be to analyse blank samples which have been introduced at the stages when contamination is likely at the sampling stage, before transportation, before storage in the laboratory, and immediately prior to the instrumental analysis (see Table 2.3). Not only would any contamination be identied but also the point at which it was introduced.
Chapter 3
Response 3.1
Inorganic ions would be expected to increase in concentration further downstream due to evaporation of water, as well as from continual weathering of rocks.
257
The total loading of suspended solids can increase downstream as more solid material accumulates in the stream. Often, however, you will nd large amounts of deposition in slow-moving areas. The buildup of organic compounds will depend on the rate at which they are being introduced into the river compared with the rate of their oxidation. The latter will, in turn, depend on the rate of re-oxygenation of the water. If this is rapid, then the organic content will decrease; if not, the oxygen concentration will decrease and the organic content will then build up. Re-oxygenation (and hence the oxygen concentration) will be high when the river is fast owing near its source. Further downstream, where the river is more placid, oxygen uptake will be slower. Some, or in the worst cases, all, of the oxygen may be consumed by reaction with organic material.
Response 3.2
The top layer is exposed to the atmosphere and sunlight. Photosynthesis can take place producing oxygen and may lead to a lowering of nutrient concentrations. The layer will also be oxygenated from the atmosphere. Chemical species which can exist in either oxidized or reduced forms will be oxidized. The bottom layer is not in direct contact with the atmosphere, thus leading to lower dissolved oxygen levels. Photosynthesis will be reduced. There will, however, be more opportunity for interaction and exchange of chemicals with the sediment on the lake bed.
Response 3.3
Decisions will have to be made concerning the following: the analyses required the timing of the sampling (i.e. the sample programme) the number of samples to be taken the location of the sampling sample volumes and containers the method of sample storage
Ammonia is an alkaline gas which would very easily escape from the sample. The solution could be acidied, so converting the ammonia into the ammonium ion. This is less readily lost: NH3 + H+ NH4 + Glass or polyethylene storage containers can be used. Chloroform is similarly volatile but it is not easy to think of a simple method of xing it in solution. The only easy method to minimize volatilization losses is to completely ll the sample container, store at sub-ambient temperature, and
258
to keep the storage time as short as possible. A glass container should be used. Polyethylene containers may contaminate the samples with compounds which interfere in the subsequent analysis. Organic compounds are readily oxidized by micro-organisms using oxygen from the air. To minimize the biological activity, the container should be completely lled and stored at 4 C. A glass container should again be used.
Response 3.4
Dissolved oxygen is necessary to support animal life within the river. For an unpolluted river, this should be close to saturation. Any organic pollution would tend to diminish this value. BOD measures the oxygen depleting potential within the river. A small quantity of material (a few mg l1 ) will generally be present in any river from decaying vegetation. However, once the BOD value rises above this level, there is the potential of substantially depleting the oxygen content of water. (Remember that saturated water has a concentration of 8.54 mg l1 oxygen at 25 C and 1 atm pressure.) Ammonia is a natural constituent of water, being formed by the decomposition of organic material. It never reaches high concentrations under normal conditions as it is quickly oxidized to nitrate. An increase in concentration would be a further indication of the poor oxygenation of the water. High concentrations of ammonia are also toxic towards sh and would present a pollution problem in their own right.
Response 3.5
Cations Ion Na+ K+ Mg2+ Ca2+ NH4 + /NH3 Absorption Ion Titration Flame Ion-selective spectrometry chromatography photometry electrodes
Note that I have included Ca2+ and Mg2+ in the titration column. The standard method for water hardness gives a measurement of total polyvalent ions (largely Ca2+ and Mg2+ ). You should have noted that a second titration at pH > 10 will measure calcium, and hence, by difference, magnesium can be estimated. Atomic absorption spectrometry was also mentioned as being often used for magnesium analysis. As we will see later in Chapter 4, the technique could also be used for the other metals.
Responses to Self-Assessment Questions Anions Ion Chloride Fluoride Nitrate Nitrite Phosphate Sulfate Absorption spectrometry Indirect Ion chromatography Gravimetric analysis
259
Ion-selective electrodes
Response 3.6
The choice should depend on the following factors: Precision of the technique compare with precision required. Analytical time of the technique compare with urgency of result. Instrument time required for the technique have you sufcient instruments? Analysts time required for the technique. This can often be signicantly different from the instrument time. Time required to set up any instrumentation, or in preparation of reagents. This time becomes more signicant with small numbers of samples. Throughput of the laboratory. There may be instruments available for rapid analysis in a high-throughput laboratory (see Section 3.4.1). Number of analytes to be determined note that some methods can determine more than one analyte. Availability of equipment. Relative cost of instrumentation/labour.
All of the criteria except the last two will be quite independent of the country in which you work. It would be possible for an instrumental method to be favoured in one part of the world where labour costs are high, whereas more labourintensive methods are favoured in other parts of the world, and where, perhaps, instrumentation is less readily available.
Chapter 4
Response 4.1
First of all, let us decide which are the volatile compounds: toluene, methylene chloride, chloroform and benzene (1, 4, 5, 10) These will be analysed by the purge-and-trap technique.
260
There are two phenols in the list: 2,4,6-trichlorophenol and phenol (3, 7) These would need to be extracted under acid conditions. (Under basic conditions, they would be in the form of non-extractable salts.) The other compounds would form the baseneutral group: anthracene, 1,2-dichlorobenzene, naphthalene, hexachlorobenzene (2, 6, 8, 9) Do not be too concerned if you do not have all ten correct, but I hope you were able to think your way through most of them.
Response 4.2
Solid-phase extraction can be used in the eld. You could perhaps load the column with the sample by using a syringe. Microbres, with care, can be immersed directly in water in the eld. A third method, which you may have considered, is purge-and-trap. This has been occasionally used. This method would give a concentration averaged over the purge period rather than an instantaneous value.
Response 4.3
(a) The pesticides will probably be present at the lower end of the trace-level range. Even after extraction and clean-up, a large number of compounds may still be present in the sample. A narrow-bore capillary column would give the required high resolution and detection sensitivity. A medium-polarity silicone polymer column would be a good initial choice. (b) The components of interest would probably be part of a much higher concentration of waste chemicals. A wide-bore capillary column would be better suited than a narrow-bore column since it has a higher sample loading capacity. It would also be more tolerant of any non-volatile impurities in the sample. The column could also be coupled directly to the purge-and-trap system which you would almost certainly have used in the sample preparation. A medium-polarity silicone polymer column would again be a good initial choice. (c) There would be a strong likelihood of non-volatile residues in the oil extract. A wide-bore capillary column would be more tolerant of contamination than narrow-bore ones. A non-polar silicone polymer column would be a good initial choice.
Response 4.4
N-methylcarbamates are analysed by HPLC using post-column derivitization or UV detection. Although not specically stated, you should be able to deduce that MS detection could also be used. The polarity of the molecules and their thermal lability makes this technique preferable to GC.
261
The techniques specically mentioned for atrazine in the present chapter are immunoassay and HPLC. HPLC will produce a result specic to the compound. With the immunoassay there may be cross-reactivity from other triazine pesticides. If individual phenols were not required, the analysis could be performed spectrometrically. For individual phenols, HPLC could be used. This may be after the formation of a uorescent derivative. Once again, the polarity of the molecules can make GC analysis difcult. Individual PAHs can be determined by HPLC with uorescence detection. Their inherent uorescent properties makes this an ideal method. GC may also be used. If individual PAHs were not required, they can be determined by immunoassay. Malathion is not mentioned in this chapter, although you should by now realize that GC is in fact the rst choice technique for all organics unless there are specic reasons (such as in the examples above) why other techniques are preferable.
Response 4.5
Loss of analyte at each stage is possible. This will be a particular problem if it is present in low concentration. For the determination of common pollutants, contamination of the sample may also occur. The problem increases with the number of stages of pretreatment, and the number of reagents involved. Common metal ions are universally found at low concentration in all reagent solids and traces of pesticides are common in organic solvents. Low-molecular-mass organic materials (e.g. solvents) are themselves commonly in use within laboratories. All materials in contact with the sample should be regarded as potential sources of contamination. Had I restricted my question simply to metals, you might also have included the problem of different metal species in the sample. Unless you had converted the metal species completely to a single form, you would risk the loss of metal at each stage of the analysis according to the chemical behaviour of the particular species.
Response 4.6
The pretreatment in (i) ensures that all of the metal species in the sample will have been decomposed and so the total metal concentration will be determined. Procedure (ii) will measure the free metal ions and loosely bound complexes. This measurement is known as the ASV-labile metal content. Procedure (iii) will destroy easily oxidizable organic material. Subtraction of the results, (iii) (ii), will measure the amount of metal found in the complexes. The latter is known as the organically bound labile metal content. Free metal ions will be held by the resin in procedure (iv), as will the metal from loosely bound complexes. Thus procedure (iv) will then determine the amount of metal bound in highly stable complexes. Procedure (v) will extract organic soluble complexes, and hence subtraction of the results, (i) (v), will measure the organic-soluble content.
262
Chapter 5
Response 5.1
The deposition would be expected to be greatest at the side of the road and would decrease with distance. A site should be selected where samples could be taken close to the road, ideally where there is no intervening pavement. The site should be distant from any other potential sources of lead. Both sides of the road should be sampled to compensate for the effects of wind. Sampling (taking duplicate samples) should be more frequent close to the road, perhaps with sampling distances from the road in the ratio 1:2:4:8:, etc. Since the source of the lead is from the atmosphere, surface samples should be taken. Samples taken below the soil surface could give an indication of penetration into the soil. Control samples as similar as possible to the monitoring samples should be taken some distance from the roadway.
Response 5.2
The use of a number of solvents will increase the number of extracted components. This would then require either more comprehensive clean-up procedures prior to chromatographic analysis, and/or a higher degree of resolution in the chromatographic separation. You may also have to consider problems associated with additional solvent peaks in the chromatographic analysis and the trace impurities introduced with each solvent.
Response 5.3
Potassium and calcium can be analysed by ame photometry (see Section 3.4.2) and magnesium and the trace metals by atomic absorption spectrometry or other atomic spectrometric techniques (see Section 4.3.3). Orthophosphate is best determined by visible spectrometry after conversion to a blue-coloured phosphomolybdenum complex (see Section 3.4.1).
Response 5.4
The order of sensitivity is as follows: 1. (b) Atmospheric exposure of residents for long periods, with the possibilities of uptake of contaminants from crops and ingestion of metals in soil by children. 2. (a) The public would spend a more restricted amount of time here, though there would be still be the possibility of direct exposure to contaminants in soil and atmosphere 3. (d) More limited exposure to the public; much of the site may be surfacecovered in subsequent development.
263
4. (c) The hard surface of the car park would form a barrier to soil contaminants. The time spent by any one individual in such an area will be limited. Volatile components are a problem in all areas, with methane a particular problem when it can build up within buildings ((a) and (c)). Toxic metals are a problem where there may be direct intake by, for instance, playing children or where crops are grown for possible human consumption ((a) and (b)). If you are considering heavily polluted industrial sites, you should also consider any aggressive properties from dumped waste (e.g. caustic properties and excessive amounts of leachable ion such as chloride) which may have an adverse affect on buildings as well as the public.
Response 5.5
You could be dealing with samples with concentrations of the analyte from percentage concentrations down to g l1 and these could be taken from highly contaminated locations. There are problems of contamination at the sampling site, during storage and transportation (including cross-contamination of samples if inappropriate bottles or bottle tops are used) and within the equipment (carryover of the analyte between samples). The overall composition of waste samples can vary widely and quite often the total composition is unknown. Matrix effects may vary widely and unpredictably from sample to sample. Great care is necessary to conrm that these analytical problems have been overcome.
Response 5.6
Water will be the easiest to sample (unless you have access to local sheries) and will need less pretreatment to remove potential interferences. The concentrations determined will be lower than in the other samples, and often are little above the lower limits of routine detection. (You may recall the typical concentrations given for DDT in Figure 2.5 and the metal enrichment factors shown in Table 2.1.) Sediment will need more pretreatment to remove potential interferences. Concentrations will vary greatly from site to site and even from sample to sample and so a large number of samples would need to be taken to obtain an average concentration. Seaweed will also need pretreatment and will only be found in specic locations. On the other hand, sediment and seaweed samples are ideal for investigating localized pollution. In each case, the effect of enrichment or bioaccumulation make it easier to detect the species since they will be present at higher concentrations than in the surrounding water. Fish are not static and so it is difcult to relate concentrations found to specic locations. There may be large variations in concentration from specimen to specimen. However, shellsh are more static and measured concentrations may be more easily related to localized pollution.
264
Response 5.7
All of the solids discussed in this chapter have complex structures and there will be a range of binding sites for the analyte. Some of the analyte can be so very strongly bound that it may be unavailable for uptake by organisms. It is quite possible that with length of time the pollutant becomes more tightly bound within the solid. We have considered this in Sections 5.4 and 5.7 for the related problem of metal availability in solids.
Chapter 6
Response 6.1
The denition of the term for gas concentrations is very precise, referring to measurements made as volumes. An atmosphere containing 20 ppm sulfur dioxide would contain 20 l of gas per litre of atmosphere. A complete statement of the unit should be parts per million (volume/volume). When the term is applied to aqueous concentrations, it is often used interchangeably with mg l1 . This would give the complete statement of the unit as parts per million (weight/volume)! Since 1 l of water containing little dissolved material has a mass of 1000 g, this would become: 1 ppm = 1 mg of analyte per 1000 g of water, i.e. parts per million (weight/weight) for water samples.
Response 6.2
Atmosphere External atmospheres Internal atmospheres Exhausts or ue gases Typical pollutant concentrations (volume/volume) parts per billion (ppb) parts per million (ppm) parts per million parts per million parts per hundred (%)
1. Different Concentration Ranges. The concentrations in the two atmospheres span a range of 106 . It is not surprising that some methods are more readily applicable to the low concentrations and others to higher concentrations. 2. Different Analytes. Unless you are concerned with highly localized pollution, the number of gaseous pollutants which can build up to detectable levels in the external atmosphere is small. Although Figure 6.1 presents by no means a comprehensive list, it does give an indication of the type of compounds which may be present simple inorganic gases, a few stable organic compounds, and a number of photochemically generated species. A greater diversity can build up in internal atmospheres, and in particular, many organic compounds. These will require different monitoring techniques.
265
3. Concern over Human Health. You might expect, since internal atmosphere monitoring is largely concerned with human health, that instantaneous concentration measurements (or short-term, time-averaged concentrations) will be important, alongside longer-term, time-averaged values. Longer-term averaged values often predominate for external atmospheres. Different methods may be needed for the two types of determination. 4. Sampling Difculties. We have not discussed this point before, but you should realize that air currents are usually lower and more stable indoors than in the external environment. Representative samples may be easier to obtain in an internal environment. We will nd that both the accuracy and the precision of at least one of the methods we will be discussing is lowered by strong air currents. When a new analytical technique is introduced, there is sometimes a progression of validation, rst for internal atmospheres and only subsequently for external atmospheres.
Response 6.3
1. Hydrogen peroxide solution is readily available. 2. The reaction product may be estimated by volumetric titration (e.g. using sodium hydroxide), removing the necessity of spectrometers and wellequipped laboratories. 3. The method is, however, non-specic. Any atmospheric component which will dissolve to form a strong acid or can be oxidized to a strong acid will be included in the nal analysis. For ambient air monitoring, potential interferences are likely to be at lower concentrations than the sulfur dioxide but for other analyses (e.g. ue gases) this may not necessarily be the case.
Response 6.4
Passive sampling techniques will require longer sampling times than the corresponding active sampling techniques, since they rely on gas diffusion. The minimum sampling time is several hours even for internal atmospheres, and so would be of little use in short-term monitoring. Active sampling techniques have greater exibility. The sampling rate can be adjusted, within limits, according to the application, thus making both long- and short-term monitoring possible. However, if used for personal monitoring, the pumps necessary for active sampling can be inconvenient for the wearer, and most would prefer to be monitored by passive sampling techniques.
Response 6.5
Solvent extraction can use standard laboratory apparatus. It is, however, timeconsuming and can use potentially hazardous solvents.
266
Thermal desorption methods need a specialized instrument but these minimize laboratory manipulation. The sensitivity can be higher than for solvent extraction since the whole sample is introduced into the chromatograph in a single desorption. Only a small fraction of the extract is injected into the chromatograph in the solvent extraction method. However, replicate determinations are not possible with thermal desorption. This is easily achievable by using solvent extraction.
Response 6.6
1. Absorption Trains. These can sample continuously over a 24 or 8 h period to obtain a time-averaged value from a single analysis. In addition, they are less expensive than single instruments, thus leading to the possibility of simultaneous sampling at different locations. Furthermore, they can also be used as reference methods for other techniques. 2. Gas Chromatography. This technique is most frequently used as a central analytical facility for personal and multiple site monitoring, although portable instruments are available for initial site investigations. 3. Direct-reading Instruments. These are used for continuous monitoring of atmospheres at a limited number of sites. In particular, they are employed in national monitoring networks. Their high expense would limit their use for more localized, extensive monitoring exercises.
Response 6.7
(a) An absorption train could be used for the analyses. If a large number of sites were involved, passive samples could be used as an alternative, but with reduced precision. A specic NO2 analyser (e.g. chemiluminescence) would be more appropriate for continuous single-site analysis. (b) The most reliable method would be by sampling the atmosphere using adsorption tubes with subsequent gas chromatographic analysis. Gas detector tubes are available for common solvents, which would give almost instantaneous determinations, but care would have to be taken over possible interferences from other solvents which may be present in the laboratory. (c) A personal monitor responding to carbon monoxide would provide protection. If a data logger is included, this would provide stored information for later, more detailed scrutiny. Continuous monitors (e.g. a non-dispersive infrared spectrometer) could also be located in the most hazardous areas.
Response 6.8
There is a choice of technique for most gas analyses. Considerations in the choice have to include ease of use in the eld as well as other criteria (precision, cost, availability of equipment, etc.) which have already been discussed for laboratory analyses (see SAQ 3.6). This is illustrated in the following gure:
267
Precision
Passive sampling
Active sampling
Electrochemical sensors Detector tubes Low Easy Ease of use in field Hard
Figure SAQ 6.8 Ease of use in eld versus precision for various gas analysis systems.
Chapter 7
Response 7.1
The most relevant sampling would be by using a personal sampler with the lter holder attached to the technicians lapel. However, this should be backed up with static sampling at a number of locations within the room. The location of the static sampling should be in the area where the technician is liable to be working and predominantly in areas where you consider high concentrations of particulates to be likely. The areas of high concentrations will be determined by the air ows in the room which will be produced by the convection currents from the furnace, plus doors, windows and any extraction system. The vertical location should reect, if possible, the height of the breathing zone of the technician in his most usual stance, whether seated or standing. Sampling should be over as long a period as possible to reect the exposure over an 8 h working day. Since large variations in exposure are possible, monitoring should be repeated for several days.
Response 7.2
In order to answer this question, you will need to combine what you have learnt from Sections 6.2.1, 6.3.1 and 7.25. Starting from the sampling position, the
(i) A particulate lter. This may be inside the ue, or outside the ue connected by a heated pipe. Temperature measurement would be necessary to ensure that the heating is at the same temperature as the sampling temperature. (ii) (a) An absorption train, perhaps cooled in icewater to prevent evaporation, and a trap to protect the subsequent pump. Alternatively, you could have: (b) A method for rapid cooling of the gases at the same time preventing condensation of water (dilution, drier or chiller), followed (after a pump and ow meter) by an instrument measuring gases at ambient temperatures. A further possibility could be: (c) An instrument capable of taking measurements at high temperatures, followed by a cooling/drying system to protect the subsequent pump. (iii) A pump. (iv) A gas meter or ow meter. There would also need to be a pitot tube to measure the gas ow at the sampling point within the duct to ensure isokinetic sampling.
Response 7.3
From a practical point of view, routine analysis will often be performed in small laboratories close to the workplace being monitored and with limited facilities. Under such circumstances, ultraviolet/visible spectrometry may be a more appropriate method. As well as a greater capital investment for an atomic absorption spectrometer, adequate ventilation is necessary, and also a regular gas cylinder supply. There would probably be an insufcient throughput of samples to justify the additional cost of ICP-OES or ICP-MS. From an analytical point of view, particulate samples from one workplace will be of relatively constant (and known) composition. Potential interferences, which limit the use of ultraviolet/visible spectrometry for samples of unknown composition, can be readily assessed.
Response 7.4
The small sample masses of atmospheric particulates (mg or below) may mean that you are working close to the limits of detection of the available techniques. The limits of detection of each technique are different for each element (see Table 7.2) and so the most appropriate technique may differ for each analysis. In other areas of environmental analysis, the sample size may not be such a restriction and preconcentration may be used to decrease the lower limit of detection.
269
Response 7.5
With such a general question, I cannot put the criteria in any rank order, but they should include the following: 1. Ease of solubility of the analyte. If the analyte is soluble in water or dilute acid, solution analytical techniques are usually the most convenient to use. 2. Number of elements being analysed. You should re-read the description of the techniques to determine which are most suitable for multiple-element analysis. 3. Availability of equipment. Many of the solid-state techniques will only be found in laboratories dedicated to solid-state analysis. 4. Sensitivity. Often, you will be working close to the limits of detection of the methods. The most sensitive technique will differ for each element. 5. Compliance with specied method. Some legislation requires the use of specic procedures for the analysis. Other legislation accepts that alternative techniques may be used if they have suitable accuracy and reliability for the application. The validation of an alternative method may, however, be a long and costly process.
Chapter 8
Response 8.1
1. Each of the components will have different physical and chemical properties, which in turn leads to different bioconcentration ability, rates of degradation and toxicity. If a value for the total toxicity of a sample is required, this would involve determining individual concentrations and compensating for their different toxicities, for example, by using toxic equivalent factors. 2. The majority of analytical schemes for ng kg1 concentrations of organic compounds would involve chromatographic separation of the interfering compounds (after extensive pretreatment), which in turn provides at least a partial separation of the PCDDs and PCDFs. 3. As you might expect, the relative quantities of each of the compounds will be different from each production source. Under favourable circumstances, estimation of the relative concentrations can give an indication of their likely origin.
Response 8.2
The assumption in the use of internal standards is that the standard will behave identically in the extraction to the compound being analysed. An isotopically
270
labelled compound would be closer in behaviour than a chemically distinct compound. A second benet is that the labelled compound serves for peak identication an important consideration when you remember the large number of peaks which may be found even in a selected ion chromatogram.
Response 8.3
1. The peak should occur at the expected retention time for the chromatographic column. It is easy to forget that the mass spectrometer is simply a highly sophisticated detector for the chromatograph and that retention times are a good primary means of identication. 2. The peak should be monitored at two or more m/z values, corresponding to the same molecular fragment with different distributions of 35 Cl and 37 Cl in the molecule. The relative intensities should correspond to the expected statistical distribution. A complete mass spectrum could be used to attribute the peak to a dioxin or diobenzofuran rather than an impurity. However, the fragmentation patterns of the dioxins and furans are often too similar to allow positive identication of individual members of the two groups. 3. The peak should only be considered genuine if it is at least 2.5 times greater than the background noise. Below this intensity there is a possibility that the peak may simply be part of the background.
Response 8.4
You should include the following in your programme: Blank determinations of all batches of reagents used Analysis of Standards from National Laboratories Replicate analyses, which may be unmarked (blind) replicates Repetition of one unknown sample throughput the sequence Frequent checks on: the purity of reagents throughout the programme the recovery of standards in the pretreatment the resolution of the GC column
These features are little different from those which you would include in any analytical scheme (see Section 2.9), but for PCDD and PCDF analysis there are severe limitations on how many standards and replicates may be included due to the laboratory time required for each sample. Remember that it takes approximately one hour for each GC analysis, as well as the time taken in the pretreatment stage.
271
Response 8.5
The rst of these is common to all analyses where there is extraction from a solid and has been discussed earlier in Section 5.2, i.e. there is always the uncertainty that the extraction is complete. The extraction efciency of the compound within the sample matrix may also differ from that of the internal standard. The second arises from the impracticability of using internal standards for all 210 PCDDs and PCDFs, and the uncertainty involved in the determination of average response factors. The practical limit is often seen as one standard per isomer group, which is usually the compound including the 2,3,7,8-substitution pattern.
Introduction to Environmental Analysis Roger Reeve Copyright 2002 John Wiley & Sons Ltd ISBNs: 0-471-49294-9 (Hardback); 0-470-84578-3 (Electronic)
Bibliography
The opinions expressed within this bibliography are not those of the publisher.
274 600 Series Waste Water 800 Series Solid Waste EPA home page http://www.epa.org NTIS home page http://www.ntis.gov
Summary volume Keith, L. H. (Ed.), Compilation of EPAs Sampling and Analysis Methods, 2nd Edn, CRC Press, Boca Raton, FL, 1996: ISBN 1-56670170-8. Manual of Analytical Methods, National Institute of Occupational Safety and Health (NIOSH), NTIS, Springeld, VA. Methods for the Determination of Hazardous Substances, Health and Safety Executive, HMSO, London. Methods for the Examination of Waters and Associated Materials, Standing Committee of Analysts, HMSO, London. Standard Methods for the Examination of Water and Wastewater published jointly by the American Public Health Association, the American Waterworks Association and the Water Environment Federation, Washington, DC.
Chapter 2
Barcelo, D. (Ed.), Environmental Analysis: Techniques, Applications and Quality Assurance, Elsevier, Amsterdam, 1993: ISBN 0-444-89648-1. Hemond, H. F. and Fechner-Levy, E. J., Chemical Fate and Transport in the Environment, 2nd Edn, Academic Press, New York, 2000: ISBN 0-12340275-1. Howard, A. G. and Stathan, P. J., Inorganic Trace Analysis: Philosophy and Practice, Wiley, Chichester, UK, 1993: ISBN 0-471-94144-1. Prichard, E. (Co-ordinating Author), Quality in the Analytical Chemistry Laboratory, ACOL Series, Wiley, Chichester, UK, 1995: ISBN 0-471-95470-5.
As of August 2001. The material displayed is not endorsed by the author or the publisher.
Bibliography
275
Quevauviller, Ph. (Ed.), Quality Assurance in Environmental Monitoring, Sampling and Sample Pretreatment, VCH, Weinheim, 1995: ISBN 3-52728724-8.
Chapter 3
Bartram, J. and Balance, R. (Eds), Water Quality Monitoring, E and F Spon, London, 1996: ISBN 0-419-22320-7. This book includes both chemical and biological monitoring techniques. Fresenius, W., Quentin, K. E. and Scheider, W. (Eds), Water Analysis, SpringerVerlag, Berlin, 1988: ISBN 3-540-17723-X. HMSO, General principles for sampling waters and waste materials, estimation of ow and load 1996, HMSO, London, 1996: ISBN 0-11-752364-X. Krajca, J. M. (Ed.), Water Sampling, Ellis Horwood, Chichester, UK, 1989: ISBN 0-85312-813-8.
http://www.environment-agency.gov.uk This website contains water quality information of all rivers in England and Wales based on the UK General Quality Assessment (see SAQ 3.4). Click on Whats in your backyard. In order to start, you will need to input a UK postcode. This has the form of one (or two) letters, one (or two) digits, space, digit and two letters. You could start at the University of Sunderland (SR1 3SD), and then navigate westwards along the River Wear to its source in the Pennine Hills. By clicking on the sampling point on the map, you can obtain historical data covering the past 10 years.
Chapter 4
Baugh, P. J., Gas Chromatography: A Practical Approach, IRL Press, OUP, Oxford, 1993: ISBN 0-19-963272-3. Chapter 9, of this text, Environmental Analysis using Gas Chromatography, includes several detailed protocols. Bloemen, H. J. Th. and Burn, J. (Eds), Chemistry and Analysis of Volatile Organic Compounds in the Environment, Blackie, Glasgow, UK, 1993: ISBN 0-7514-0000-9. Boehm, P. D., Douglas, G. S., Burns, W. A., Mankiewicz, P. J., Page, D. S. and Bence, A. E., Application of petroleum hydrocarbon chemical ngerprinting and allocation techniques after the Exxon Valdez oil spill, Marine Pollution Bulletin, 34(8), 599613 (1997). Bruner, F., Gas Chromatographic Environmental Analysis, VCH, New York, 1993: ISBN 1-56081-011-4. Minoia, C. and Caroli, S. (Eds), Application of Zeeman Graphite Furnace Atomic Absorption Spectrometry in the Chemical Laboratory and in Toxicology, Pergamon Press, Oxford, UK, 1992: ISBN 0-09-041019-7. This book includes several chapters on environmental analysis. Smedes, F., de Jong, A. S. and Davies, I. M., Determination of (mono-, diand) tri-butyltin in sediments. Analytical methods, Journal of Environmental
276
Monitoring, 2(6), 541549 (1999). This is a review paper of possible methodologies from sampling and storage, pretreatment, clean-up and concentration, analysis and quality assurance. Thurman, E. M. and Mills, M. S., Solid Phase Extraction: Principles and Practice, Wiley-Interscience, New York, 1998: ISBN 0-471-61422-X. Chapter 7 of this text specically concerns environmental analysis, although there are many other environmental examples given elsewhere in the book.
Chapter 5
Allen, S. E. (Ed.), Chemical Analysis of Ecological Materials, 2nd Edn, Blackwell Scientic Publications, Oxford, UK, 1989: ISBN 0-632-01742-2. British Standards Institute, Investigation of potentially contaminated sites. Code of practice, BS 10175: 2001, BSI, London, 2001: ISBN 0-580-33090-7. Carro, A. M., Lorenzo, R. A., Vazquez, M. J., Abuin, M. and Cela, R., Different extraction techniques in the preparation of methylmercury biological samples: classic extraction, supercritical uid and microwave extraction, International Laboratory, 2327 (November 1998). Dean, J. R., Extraction Methods for Environmental Analysis, Wiley, Chichester, UK, 1998: ISBN 0-471-98287-3. This book describes, compares and contrasts the Soxhlet, automated Soxhlet, sonication, SFE, microwave-assisted extraction and accelerated solvent extraction techniques. Guerin, T. F., The extraction of aged polycyclic aromatic hydrocarbon (PAH) residues from a clay soil using sonication and a Soxhlet procedure: a comparative study, Journal of Environmental Monitoring, 1(1), 6367 (1999). Lopez-Avila, V., Young, R. and Teplitsky, N., Microwave-assisted extractions: an alternative to Soxhlet, sonication, and supercritical uid extraction, Journal of AOAC International, 79(1), 142156 (1996). Que Hee, S. S., Hazardous Waste Analysis, ABS Group Inc., Rockville, MA, 1999: ISBN 0-86587-609-6. The book is a comprehensive guide to all aspects of waste analysis. Reid, B. J., Jones, K. C. and Semple, K. T., Bioavailablity of persistent organic pollutants in soils and sediments a perspective on mechanisms, consequences and assessment, Environmental Pollution, 108, 103112 (2000). This is a discussion paper concerning whether bioavailability of a pollutant can be assessed by chemical extraction methods, as is commonly assumed. Rifai, H. S., Bedient, P. B.and Shorr, G. L., Monitoring hazardous waste sites: characterisation and remediation considerations, Journal of Environmental Monitoring, 2(3), 199212 (2000). This is a review paper which considers possible methods and also includes a specic case study. Rumford, S., Yersin, J., Hetheridge, M. and Cumming, R., Comparison of rapid methods of groundwater sampling using direct push probes, Land Contamination and Reclamation, 7(1), 4148 (1999).
Bibliography
277
Scottish Enterprise Environmental Development, How to investigate Contaminated Land: Requirements for contaminated land site investigations, Scottish Enterprise, Glasgow, UK, 1994: ISBN 0-905574-13-3.
Chapter 6
Clarke, A. G. (Ed.), Industrial Air Pollution Monitoring, Chapman & Hall, London, 1998: ISBN 0-412-63390-6. Couling, S. (Ed.), Measurement of Airborne Pollutants, Butterworth-Heinemann, Oxford, UK, 1993: ISBN 0-7506-0885-4. This book describes the practicalities of atmospheric monitoring, using a number of monitoring programmes as case studies. Krupa, S. V. and Legge, A. H., Passive sampling of ambient, gaseous air pollutants: an assessment from an ecological perspective, Environmental Pollution, 107, 3135 (2000). This paper includes comparisons of passive samplers and continuous monitors. Lodge, Jr, J. P. (Ed.), Methods of Air Sampling and Analysis, 3rd Edn, Lewis, Publishers, Chelsea, MI, 1989: ISBN 0-87371-141-6. Sigrist, M. W. (Ed.), Air Monitoring by Spectroscopic Techniques, WileyInterscience, New York, 1994: ISBN 0-471-55875-3. A detailed but readable book on remote sensing techniques.
http://www.seiph.umds.ac.uk/detr/ss reports/ar98.htm This site describes roadside monitoring at Marylebone Road in London and compares the various techniques used. These include the following:
NO2 diffusion tube and continuous NOx analyser Benzene diffusion tubes versus automatic gas chromatograph TEOM PM10 versus gravimetric PM10 SO2 bubbler versus continuous SO2 analyser
http://www.unep.or.jp/CTT DATA/AMON/Contents 4.html This site describes techniques used in Japan for monitoring ambient air and stationary sources.
Chapter 7
Heal, M. R., Beverland, I. J., McCabe, M., Hepburn, W. and Angus, R. M., Intercomparison of ve PM10 monitoring devices and the implications for exposure measurement in epidemiological research, Journal of Environmental Monitoring, 2(5), 455-461(2000) (2000). HMIP, Monitoring emissions of pollutants at source, Technical Guidance Note (monitoring) M2, HMSO, London, 1993: ISBN 0-117-52922-2.
278
Smith, S., Stribley, T., Barratt, B. and Perryman, C., Determination of PM10 by Partisol, TEOM, ACCU and cascade impactor instruments in the London Borough of Greenwich, Clean Air, 27(3), 7073 (1997).
http://ccar.ust.hk/% 7Ealau/epd cdrom96/aqn This site shows examples of monitoring equipment on site and the mobile air monitoring station in Hong Kong.
Chapter 8
HMIP, Determination of polychlorinated biphenyls, polychlorinated dibenzop-dioxins and polychlorinated dibenzofurans in UK soils, HMSO, London, 1989: ISBN 0-11-752268-6. March, R. E., Splendore, M., Reiner, E. J., Mercer, R. S., Plomley, J. B., Wadell, D. S. and MacPherson, K. A., A comparison of three mass spectrometric techniques for the determination of dioxins/furans, International Journal of Mass Spectrometry, 194, 235246 (2000). Sheridan, R. S. and Meola, J. R., Analysis of pesticide residues in fruits, vegetables and milk by gas chromatography/tandem mass spectrometry, Journal of AOAC International, 82(4) 982990 (1999).
Introduction to Environmental Analysis Roger Reeve Copyright 2002 John Wiley & Sons Ltd ISBNs: 0-471-49294-9 (Hardback); 0-470-84578-3 (Electronic)
Glossary of Terms
This section contains a glossary of terms, all of which are used in the text. It is not intended to be exhaustive, but to explain briey those terms which often cause difculties or may be confusing to the inexperienced reader. Absorbance A measurement of the absorption of light; absorbance = log I0 /I , where I0 is the intensity of the incident radiation and I is the intensity of the transmitted radiation. The operational scale is 01.2, but the normal working range is towards the lower half of the scale. Absorption The process of incorporation of a gas or liquid into the bulk of a body, or the attenuation of light passing through a liquid. Accuracy Closeness of a result to the true value. Acid rain Rain with a pH of less than 5.6 (unpolluted value). The chemistry of its formation is complex but often originates from combustion processes producing SO2 /SO3 (SOx ) and NO/NO2 (NOx ). Activity Concentration of ions in water after correction for their thermodynamic non-ideal behaviour. At low concentration, activity concentration, while at innite dilution, activity = concentration. Adsorption The process where molecules of a gas or liquid adhere to the surface of a body. Aerobic Presence of oxygen, normally referring to microbial activity. Anaerobic Absence of oxygen, normally referring to microbial activity. Analyte The specic compound or ion within a sample which is being analysed. Anion A negatively charged ion. Anthropogenic Man-made. Atmosphere The gases surrounding a body. The most obvious example is the atmosphere surrounding the earth but the term can be applied elsewhere, e.g. internal atmospheres inside buildings.
280
Bioconcentration Increase in concentration of a pollutant in an organism compared with the surrounding environment. Biomagnication Increase in concentration of a pollutant in organisms along a food chain. Buffer solution Solutions which resist a change in pH. Carcinogen A substance (or specic forms of radiation) capable of forming cancer. Cation A positively charged ion. Chelating The ability of a molecule or ion to bond to a metal ion through more than one atom to form a complex. The complexes formed are more stable than similar species where the bond is through one atom, i.e. non-chelating species. Climate change One of the observable effects which is predicted to occur from global warming. In addition to changes in temperature, there may also be changes to weather patterns, including more extreme weather conditions. Colloid Solid particles, with sizes so small to be invisible in a simple microscope, which can be permanently suspended in water. Their suspension is stabilized by ionic forces. Complex The chemical species formed when an ion or compound containing an atom with a lone pair of electrons (e.g. N, O and S) forms a bond to a metal ion. Complexing agent The chemical species (an ion or a compound) which will bond to a metal ion using lone pairs of electrons. Congener A term used with organochlorine compounds such as dioxins, PCBs, PCDFs, etc. This is a member of a group of compounds with similar structural features such as the same number of chlorines or a common substitution pattern, regardless of the total number of chlorines. Co-precipitation The inclusion of otherwise soluble ions during the precipitation of lower-solubility species. Degradation The breakdown of organic molecules into simpler species through a number of distinct stages. This may be by chemical or biological means. Denitrication The process of nitrate being reduced to nitrogen by microorganisms in the absence of oxygen. Diffuse source A source of discharge of a pollutant which occurs over a wide area e.g. methane emissions from a waste site. Ecosystem Plant and animals in an area of the environment together with that part of the physical environment relevant to their well-being. Eluent The mobile liquid phase in liquid or ion chromatography or in solidphase extraction. Endocrine disruptor A compound which can interfere with the maintenance of normal blood hormone levels or the subsequent action of these hormones. Eutrophication The enrichment of a water body with nutrients which lead to excessive plant growth and ultimately death of the ecosystem.
Glossary of Terms
281
Filter feeders Organisms which feed by ingesting small food particles from the surrounding water, e.g. shellsh. Flue gas Gas emitted from a chimney also known as stack gas. Fossil fuel Hydrocarbon fuel derived from fossil remains. It includes coal, oil and natural gas. Fulvic acid Naturally occurring high-molecular-mass organic compounds which are soluble at all pH levels. Global warming The predicted increase in the average world temperature due to increase of greenhouse gases in the atmosphere, coupled with destruction of the worlds forests. Such predictions are based on average temperatures. Some areas may cool, while others increase in temperature. Greenhouse effect The effect caused by certain molecules (notably carbon dioxide and water) in the atmosphere to absorb and re-radiate infrared radiation. In an unpolluted atmosphere, this is a natural effect which maintains the average atmospheric temperature. With an increase in concentration of greenhouse gases, this average temperature is predicted to rise. Greenhouse gas A compound which will absorb infrared radiation and so contribute to any greenhouse effect. The molecules of the compound have to contain at least two atoms and, if diatomic, more than one element. Groundwater Sub-surface water in soils and geological formations where the ground has become saturated with water. Humic acid Naturally occurring high-molecular-mass organic compounds which are acid-soluble but are precipitated by base. Hydrophilic The term applied to compounds, molecules, or sometimes parts of molecules, which have an afnity for water. This afnity may be due to the presence of polar atoms such as oxygen or nitrogen, or may be due to ionic groups. Hydrophobic The term applied to compounds, molecules or sometimes parts of molecules, which lack any afnity for water. Hydrosphere The different forms of water found on or in the earth oceans, seas, lakes, rivers, groundwater, glaciers, etc. Ion exchange The exchange of ions of the same charge between water and a solid in contact with it. Ion trap A form of separation and detection in mass spectrometry in which the charged ions are stored in closed orbits and are selectively extracted for detection and quantication. Isocratic The term used for an eluent in liquid chromatography which remains of constant composition. This is in contrast to some advanced forms of chromatography which optimize separations by a continuous change in eluent composition, known as gradient (rather than isocratic) elution. KudernaDanish evaporator Apparatus for sample concentration consisting of a small (10 ml) graduated test tube connected directly beneath a 250 or
282
500 ml ask. A steam bath provides heat for evaporation with the concentrate collecting in the test tube. Leachate The liquid after passing through a substance which contains soluble extracts. Least squares A method of determining the best straight line to t a series of points on a graph. This best line minimizes the square of the distances of the points to the line as measured along the y-axis the direction in which the greatest experimental error is expected. The calculation is a standard feature of scientic calculators and spreadsheets. Lipid High-molecular-mass organic compound which can be extracted into organic solvents. Lithosphere The crust and mantle of the earths surface. This is the section of the earth which is of greatest relevance when discussing environmental effects. Lysimeter A device for collecting water from the pore spaces of soils and for determining the soluble constituents removed by drainage. Metabolism Chemical reactions which take place within a living organism. Nitrication Oxidation of ammonia to nitrite and then to nitrate by the action of microorganisms. Organometallic An organic compound in which a metal is covalently bonded to carbon. Oxidation Addition of oxygen to a molecule, the removal of electrons or the removal of hydrogen from a molecule. Ozone depletion The destruction of ozone molecules by radicals formed by molecules which are stable enough in the lower atmosphere to be transportable to the upper atmosphere. The molecules often contain a halogen atom. Nitrous oxide, N2 O, can also cause ozone depletion. Ozone layer A section of the upper atmosphere between 1260 km which contains a higher level of ozone than other sections. This section protects the earth from UV radiation between 220 and 330 nm. Pesticide A synthetic compound used to control the number or spread of organisms. The main types are insecticides (insect control), herbicides (weed control) and fungicides (control of fungal growth on crops, in industrial process plant or in commercial products). Photochemical smog An oxidizing haze produced from vehicle exhausts in large conurbations during daylight hours and under thermal-inversion conditions. Photolysis Breakdown of a compound by the action of light. Photosynthesis The chemical process by which green plants synthesize organic compounds from carbon dioxide and water using sunlight as an energy source. Point source A discharge which can be readily identied and located. Precipitation Formation of an insoluble salt by mixing of two previously soluble ions, or rainfall. Precision Reproducibility of an analytical result.
Glossary of Terms
283
Protocol Formal statement of an analytical procedure. Radical An atom or molecule containing an unpaired electron. Reduction The removal of oxygen from a molecule, the addition of electrons or the addition of hydrogen to a molecule. Remote sensing Gathering and recording information by techniques which do not involve direct contact. Saponication Breakdown of fat using alkali. The products are carboxylate salts and alcohols. Sediment Small particles of mineral or organic matter on river or sea beds. Stack gas Gas emitted from a chimney also known as ue gas. Stratosphere The portion of the atmosphere between 10 and 50 km altitude. Thermal inversion Atmospheric conditions which produce a layer of cold gas below a layer of warmer gas (the opposite condition to what is normally found). This produces very placid and stable atmospheric conditions which allow pollutants to build up and inter-react. Vadose zone Soil containing water but not to saturation level.
Introduction to Environmental Analysis Roger Reeve Copyright 2002 John Wiley & Sons Ltd ISBNs: 0-471-49294-9 (Hardback); 0-470-84578-3 (Electronic)
There is a bewildering array of measurement units in common use. The units used to describe water, atmospheres and solids have developed independently and in each of these areas there may be more than one system in frequent use. SI units, which have been recommended by many international scientic bodies, are unfortunately not often used in Environmental Science. This section begins with a description of some of the units likely to be found in the environmental literature and the conventions used in this present textbook. Details of SI units are then presented.
286
An alternative system of units is sometimes found in the environmental literature which is based on parts per million (ppm), parts per billion (ppb), and sometimes parts per trillion (ppt). These are avoided wherever possible owing to possible ambiguities in their interpretation. As shown below, different denitions are used for the terms in liquids and solids, and in gas analysis. For liquids and solids: ppm = parts per million (mass/mass) = mg kg1 mg l1 (assuming density of sample Similarly: ppb ppt For gases: ppm = parts per million (volume/volume) = l l1 ppb = nl l1 ppt = pl l1 You should also note that billion and trillion always follow the US rather than the UK usage, i.e. 1 billion = 109 1 trillion = 1012
g l1
1g ml1 )
ng l1
SI Units
Base SI units and physical quantities Quantity length mass time electric current thermodynamic temperature amount of substance luminous intensity Symbol l m t I T n Iv SI unit metre kilogram second ampere kelvin mole candela Symbol m kg s A K mol cd
Units of Measurement and Physical Constants Prexes used for SI units Factor 1021 1018 1015 1012 109 106 103 102 10 101 102 103 106 109 1012 1015 1018 1021 Prex zetta exa peta tera giga mega kilo hecto deca deci centi milli micro nano pico femto atto zepto Symbol Z E P T G M k h da d c m n p f a z
287
Derived SI units with special names and symbols Physical quantity frequency force pressure; stress energy; work; quantity of heat power electric charge; quantity of electricity electric potential; potential difference; electromotive force; tension electric capacitance electric resistance SI unit Name Symbol hertz newton pascal joule watt coulomb volt Hz N Pa J W C V Expression in terms of base or derived SI units 1 1 1 1 Hz = 1s1 N = 1 kg m s2 Pa = 1 N m2 J=1 Nm
1 W = 1 J s1 1C=1As 1 V = 1 J C1
farad ohm
1 F = 1 C V1 1 = 1 V A1 (continued overleaf)
288
Derived SI units with special names and symbols (continued) Physical quantity electric conductance magnetic ux; ux of magnetic induction magnetic ux density; magnetic induction inductance Celsius temperature luminous ux illuminance activity (of a radionuclide) absorbed dose; specic energy dose equivalent plane angle solid angle
a
SI unit Name Symbol siemens weber tesla henry degree Celsius lumen lux becquerel gray sievert radian steradian
S Wb T H C lm lx Bq Gy Sv rad sr
rad and sr may be included or omitted in expressions for the derived units.
Physical Constants
Recommended values of selected physical constantsa Constant acceleration of free fall (acceleration due to gravity) atomic mass constant (unied atomic mass unit) Avogadro constant Boltzmann constant electron specic charge (charge-to-mass ratio) electron charge (elementary charge) Faraday constant Symbol gn Value 9.806 65 m s2
b
mu
1.660 540 2(10) 1027 kg 6.022 136 7(36) 1023 mol1 1.380 658(12) 1023 J K1 1.758 819 1011 C kg1 1.602 177 33(49) 1019 C 9.648 530 9(29) 104 C mol1
L, NA kB -e/me e F
Units of Measurement and Physical Constants Recommended values of selected physical constantsa (continued) Constant ice-point temperature molar gas constant molar volume of ideal gas (at 273.15 K and 101 325 Pa) Planck constant standard atmosphere speed of light in vacuum
a
289
Symbol Tice R Vm
Value 273.15 K b 8.314 510(70) J K1 mol1 22.414 10(19) 103 m3 mol1 6.626 075 5(40) 1034 J s 101 325 Pab 2.997 924 58 108 m s1 b
h atm c
Data are presented in their full precision, although often no more than the rst four or ve signicant digits are used; gures in parentheses represent the standard deviation uncertainty in the least signicant digits. b Exactly dened values.
Group 1
Group 2
Group : 3 24 Cr 51.996 42 Mo 95.94 74 W 183.85 106 Sg (263) 60 Nd 144.24 92 U 238.03 93 Np (237) 94 Pu (242) 95 Am (243) 96 Cm (247) 61 Pm (147) 62 Sm 150.35 63 Eu 151.96 64 Gd 157.25 65 Tb 158.92 97 Bk (247) 66 Dy 162.50 98 Cf (249) 67 Ho 164.93 99 Es (254) 25 Mn 54.938 43 Tc (99) 75 Re 186.2 107 Bh 26 Fe 55.847 44 Ru 101.07 76 Os 190.2 108 Hs 27 Co 58.933 45 Rh 102.91 77 Ir 192.22 109 Mt 28 Ni 58.71 46 Pd 106.4 78 Pt 195.09 110 Uun 29 Cu 63.546 47 Ag 107.87 79 Au 196.97 111 Uuu 30 Zn 65.37 48 Cd 112.40 80 Hg 200.59 112 Unb
3 0.98 Li 6.941 11 0.93 Na 22.990 19 0.82 K 39.102 37 0.82 Rb 85.47 55 0.79 Cs 132.91 87 Fr (223) 6 7 8 d transition elements 9 10 11 12 5 2.04 B 10.811 13 1.61 Al 26.98 31 1.81 Ga 69.72 1.78 49 In 114.82 81 2.04 Ti 204.37 6 2.55 C 12.011 14 1.90 Si 28.086 32 2.01 Ge 72.59 1.96 50 Sn 118.69 82 2.32 Pb 207.19 68 Er 167.26 100 Fm (253)
4 1.57 Be 9.012 12 1.31 Mg 24.305 20 1.00 Ca 40.08 38 0.95 Sr 87.62 56 0.89 Ba 137.34 88 Ra 226.025
7 3.04 N 14.007 15 2.19 P 30.974 33 2.18 As 74.922 2.05 51 Sb 121.75 83 2.02 Bi 208.98
58 Ce 140.12
59 Pr 140.91
Introduction to Environmental Analysis Roger Reeve Copyright 2002 John Wiley & Sons Ltd ISBNs: 0-471-49294-9 (Hardback); 0-470-84578-3 (Electronic)
90 Th 232.04
91 Pa (231)
Introduction to Environmental Analysis Roger Reeve Copyright 2002 John Wiley & Sons Ltd ISBNs: 0-471-49294-9 (Hardback); 0-470-84578-3 (Electronic)
Index
Bold indicates a reference to an analytical method or methods. Italic indicates an explanation in the Glossary of Terms. Absorbance, 61, 279 Absorption, 62, 183185, 190, 279 Absorption train, 183186, 1978, 210, 266, 268 Accelerated solvent extraction, 169 Accumulation (sediments), 17 Accuracy, 27, 29, 30, 31, 33, 279 Acetic acid, 103 Acetylene, 196 Acid deposition, 224225 Acid rain, 8, 9, 14, 22, 136, 176, 224, 279 Acidity, 27, 5557 Actinides, 26 Activated charcoal, 86, 186 Active sampling (gases), 186189, 211, 265, 267 Activity, 55, 279 Acute toxicity, 24, 234 Adsorption, 17, 22, 167, 186188, 279 Aeration, 39, 40 Aerobic decay, 48, 279 Aldehydes, 177 Alkaline-earth ions, 136 Alkalinity, 5557 Aluminium, 21, 23, 57, 113, 125 American Society for Testing and Materials (ASTM), 32 Amines, 83 2-Aminoperimidine, 75 Ammonia/ammonium, 2, 7, 24, 37, 39, 46, 48, 61, 62, 67, 72, 7374, 136, 149, 176, 181, 182, 183, 191, 198, 207, 257, 258 Ammonium pyrrolidine dithiocarbamate (APDC), 116 Ammonium salts (atmosphere), 213, 224 Anaerobic decay, 48, 279 Analyte, 279 Animal tissues/animal specimens, 135, 136, 146, 168, 173, 263 Anion, 279 Anodic stripping voltammetry (ASV), 113, 125128, 132 Antagonism, 24 Anthracene, 97, 111, 260 Anthropogenic, 9, 279 Arsenic, 118, 124 Asbestos, 230 Ashing, 140 dry ashing, 145, 146 wet ashing, 145, 146 Atmosphere, 1, 2, 13, 175231, 264269, 279 Atomic absorption spectrometry (AAS), 112, 114121, 128, 226, 227, 258, 268 Atomic emission spectrometry, 226, 227
294
Atomic uorescence spectrometry, 226, 227 Atomic spectrometry, 68,114124, 127, 132, 134, 141, 161, 262 Atrazine, 104, 105, 107, 112, 261 Automatic monitoring network (atmosphere), 206 Automated Soxhlet, 169 Available ions, 137, 140, 149 Background correction, 117118, 164 Bailers, 154, 155 BeerLambert law, 61, 115, 194, 198 Benzene, 16, 105, 111, 180, 206, 259 Beta-attenuation instruments (air sampling), 222 Biochemical Oxygen Demand (BOD), 46, 51, 61, 161, 162, 258 Bioconcentration, 1617, 20, 235, 268, 280 Biological samples, 136, 142146 Biomagnication, 18, 280 Biphenyl, 17 Birds of prey, 18 Blank samples, 32, 161, 205, 256 Boreholes, 154, 155, 159 Boron, 7 Bottom-dwelling sh, 18, 256 Breakthrough volume, 188 British Standards Institute, 32 BTEX compounds, 105, 191 Buffer solution, 69, 280 Butadiene, 206 Cadmium, 14, 20, 21, 22,23, 117, 126, 127, 133, 226, 227, 255 Calcium, 36, 37, 38, 39, 55, 57, 58, 68, 72, 112, 118, 151, 226, 227, 229, 258, 262 Carbofuran, 104, 105 Carbon dioxide, 3, 4, 5, 6, 37, 39, 48, 55, 164, 171, 176, 180, 196, 198, 200, 203, 203 Carbon monoxide, 176, 177, 180, 181, 182, 183, 196, 198, 201, 203, 204, 206, 210 Carbon tetrachloride, 16,17,176
Index
Cyclone elutriator, 218 p, p DDA, 19 o, p -DDD, 96 p, p -DDD, 94, 96 p, p -DDE, 16, 19, 94, 96, 244 o, p -DDT, 20, 94, 96 p, p -DDT, 14, 15, 19, 24, 94, 96, 241 DDT (commercial pesticide), 9, 16, 18, 20, 9496, 140, 248, 255 Degradation, 12, 19, 23, 80, 269, 280 Denitrication, 2, 280 Detector tubes (gas), 199201, 211, 266, 267 Detergents, 79 Deuterium lamp background correction (AA), 118 DIAL (Differential Absorption LIDAR), 209 1,2-Dichlorobenzene, 111, 260 1,4-Dichlorobenzene, 17 Dichromate value, 52 Dieldrin, 15 Diffuse source, 12, 178, 280 Diffusion tubes, 189 191 Dioxins, 9, 27, 79, 146, 233251 Diphenylether, 17 Direct push probes (soils), 155 Direct reading instruments (gases), 179183 Discrete analysers, 65 Dispersal (of pollutants), 1215 Dispersive infrared spectrometers, 194 Dissolved gases, 36 Dissolved oxygen, 42, 47, 4951, 61, 257 Diuron, 104 DOAS (Differential Optical Absorption Spectrometry), 207 Dolomite, 56,57 Dredge sampling, 165 Dry deposition, 224225 Ecosystem, 280 EDTA, 58, 119, 131,149 Electrochemical methods, 28 Electrochemical sensors (gases), 198199, 211, 267
295
Electron-capture detection, 83, 89, 90, 237 Electron microprobe analyser, 229, 231 Electron microscope, 230 ELISA (Enzyme-linked immunosorbent assay), 105, 107, 109, 110 Eluent, 69, 129, 280 Emission spectrometry, 7677, 217 Endocrine disruptors, 9, 14,78,79, 280 Energy production/consumption, 3 Environment, 12, 10 Environment Agency (UK), 32 Environmental Protection Agency (US), 32, 105, 160, 183, 192, 196, 220 Essential elements, 6 Ethylbenzene, 105 European Community, 7 European Union, 192 Eutrophication, 5, 280 Evaporation, 40 Exhaust gases, 178 External atmospheres, 174, 182, 184, 211, 213, 216, 264 External standards, 63, 71, 74, 98, 122, 124 Extraction, 28, 77 -from biological material, 144145 solids, 140, 168172 soils, 148, 149 sediment, 167 water, 8188 Extraction discs, 82, 85 Feminization, 9,14 Fertilizers, 4, 5, 12, 42, 147, 254 Ficks law, 190 Field analysis, 2830, 36, 50, 62, 6567, 78, 80, 105, 111, 127, 183201 Filter feeders, 22, 256, 281 Flame atomic absorption spectrometry, 112, 114116, 124 Flame ionization detection, 55, 90, 162, 188, 189, 203, 205 Flame photometric detection, 90 Flame photometry, 68, 224, 258, 262 Flameless atomic absorption spectrometry, 112, 113, 116118, 227 Florisil, 84, 247
296
Flow injection, 124 Flue gas desulfurization, 9 Flue gases, 175, 178, 180, 185186 197198, 205, 211, 264, 281 Fluorescence detection/monitors, 103, 154, 192 Fluoride ions, 37, 62, 71, 74, 259 Food chain, 18, 136 Formaldehyde, 178 Formic acid, 103 Fossil fuel, 4, 103, 281 Freeze drying, 143 Fuel oils, 91, 96 Fulvic acid, 22, 131, 281 Gas chromatography (GC), 79, 86, 88102, 103, 132, 134, 141, 162, 188, 250, 266 Gas chromatographymass spectrometry (GC-MS), 90, 107, 233, 236251 Gel permeation chromatography, 140 Global warming, 1, 5, 176, 281 Good Laboratory Practice (GLP), 33 Grab samplers, 165,166 Graphite furnace atomic absorption spectrometry, 112, 113, 227 Gravimetric methods, 27, 74, 259 Greenhouse effect, 9, 281 Greenhouse gas, 281 Groundwater, 3640, 158, 281 Gypsum, 57 Hall electrolytic conductivity detection, 90 Halogens, 121 Halomethanes, 93 Hartley funnel, 47 Hazardous waste, 156, 235 Headspace analysis, 82, 8586, 93, 148, 162 Heavy metals, 20, 136 Hexachlorobenzene, 70, 111, 260 Hexane, 195, 201 High-molecular-mass organic compounds, 11, 17, 23, 34, 80, 163 High performance liquid chromatography (HPLC), 69, 79, 88, 140, 162, 247, 260, 261
Index
Ion exchange/ ion exchangers, 22, 39, 84, 149, 281 Ion-selective electrodes (ISE), 7374, 258, 259 Ion suppression, 69 Ion-trap mass spectrometer, 90, 239240, 245, 281 Iron, 14,21,22, 37, 48, 57, 112, 115, 125, 126, 136, 161,229 Isocratic, 72, 281 Isokinetic sampling, 220 Isooctane, 12 Isotope dilution analysis, 1001, 124 Kjeldahl method, 7, 150, 168 KudernaDanish evaporator, 95, 281 Lakes, 36, 41, 125 Landll, 12, 135, 137, 147, 156165 Landll sites, 157, 173 Lanthanides, 129, 130 Large-volume injection (GC), 92 Leachate, 157, 1614, 282 Lead, 6, 12, 13, 14, 20, 21, 22, 23, 56, 117, 118, 126, 127, 131, 133, 142, 146, 154, 214, 224, 225226, 227, 229, 262 Least-squares analysis, 63, 99, 119, 282 LIDAR (light detection and ranging), 208209 Limestone, 56, 57 Lipid, 140, 282 Liquid chromatography anions, 101105 metal ions, 128131, 132 Liquid chromatographymass spectrometry, 103, 107 Lithosphere, 12, 282 London smog, 214 Lysimeter, 282 suction, 158159 collection, 158159 Mackereth cell, 50 Magnesium, 37, 55, 57, 588, 68, 72, 112, 115, 125, 151, 226, 258, 262 Malathion, 15, 16, 112, 261
297
Manganese, 6, 14, 21, 37, 57, 112, 115, 125, 136, 148, 227, 229, 230 Mass spectrometry, 89, 90, 237 Maximum Admissible Concentration (MAC), 7, 8 Maximum Exposure Limit (MEL), 180 Mercury, 20, 21, 22, 118, 131, 178, 180, 201, 207 Metabolism, 282 Metalloids, 121 Metals/metal ions, 11, 2023, 34, 37, 46, 112133, 141, 145, 150, 157, 161, 167, 170, 225226 Methane, 5, 8, 12, 16, 39, 38, 154, 164, 165, 176, 196,198, 203, 253, 263 Methanol, 181 Methods for the Determination of Hazardous Substances (MDHS), 188, 191, 226 Methyl chloride (chloromethane), 176 N-Methylcarbamates, 103, 112, 260 Methylene blue, 7, 111 Methylene chloride (dichloromethane), 111, 195, 259 Microtitreplate reader, 105, 106 Microwave-assisted extraction, 169170 Microwave digestion, 169170 Mobile laboratories, 29, 157, 210, 229 Molybdenum, 14 Monitoring networks (atmospheres), 205206 Mount St Helens, 13 Municipal waste, 156 Naphthalene, 12, 111, 260 National Accreditation Management Services (NAMAS), 33 National Air Quality Standards (NAQS), 179,180 Neutron activation analysis, 230 Nickel, 14, 21, 124 Nitrate ions, 2, 5, 8, 25, 37, 39, 42, 43, 45, 48, 62, 67, 71, 72,136, 149, 161, 253, 259 Nitric oxide, 2, 9, 177, 180, 186, 192 Nitrication, 282 Nitrite ions, 2, 7, 37, 62, 67, 71, 149, 259
298
Nitrobenzene, 181, 182 Nitrogen, 2, 5, 194, 201, 203, 203 Nitrogen cycle, 2, 5 Nitrogen dioxide, 2, 9, 176, 177, 180, 182, 186, 190, 191, 192, 207, 210 Nitrogen oxides, 9, 176, 182, 193 , 198, 206 Nitrous oxide, 2, 5, 176, 177, 180, 198, 254 NO3 radical, 208 Non-carbonate hardness, 57 Non-dispersive infrared spectrometers, 194, 196, 260 Non-suppressed ion chromatographs, 71 Nutrients, 39, 42, 51, 136, 257 Occupational Exposure Standards (OES), 180, 181 OH radical, 207, 208 Oil spills, 96 On-line monitors, 30, 55 Organic compounds, 1520, 78112, 144145, 148, 160161, 219, 226227 Organic nitrogen, 149, 150 Organization of Economic Co-operation and Development (OECD), 5, 33 Organochlorine pesticides, 84 Organometallic compounds (organic derivatives of metals), 131, 282 Organophosphorus pesticides, 141 Oxidation, 48, 282 Oxygen, 36, 37, 39, 41, 194, 201, 203, 203 Oxygen demand, 47, 48, 49, 5154 Ozone, 2, 5, 13, 176, 177, 191, 192, 206, 207, 208 Ozone depletion, 282 Ozone-depleting compounds, 5, 9 Ozone layer, 1, 5, 254, 282 PAHs (polynuclear aromatic hydrocarbons), 97, 103, 104, 105, 112, 154, 170, 261 Palmes tubes, 189 Paraquat, 105 Particulates (atmosphere), 12, 13, 213231, 267269
Index
mass spectrometers, 204205 XRF spectrometers, 153, 161, 229 Post column derivatization, 103 Potassium, 37, 38, 68, 72, 112, 115, 148, 151, 226, 258, 262 Precipitation, 22, 282 Precision, 191, 282 Preparative thin-layer chromatography, 95 Pretreatment, 77, 78, 90, 93, 99, 113, 135, 139, 142, 148, 154, 16, 165, 167 Protocol, 154, 275, 283 Purge-and-trap techniques, 82, 86, 91, 93, 148, 160, 165, 167 PVC poly(vinyl chloride), 9 Pyrrolidinedithiocarbamate salts, 131 Quadrupole (MS) spectrometer, 90, 123, 205, 239240 Quality assurance, 11, 3033, 42, 141142, 161, 165 Quality control, 31, 33, 100, 122, 124, 141142, 165, 228, 246, 254 Quantication anodic stripping voltammetry, 127 atomic absorption, 118121 ame photometry, 68 gas chromatography, 97101 gas chromatography/mass spectrometry, 245246 immunoassay, 105107 ion selective electrodes, 74 ultraviolet /visible spectrometry, 62 Quartz, 230 Radical, 207, 283 Rain forests, 1 Rain water, 38, 39, 55 Real-time monitoring (gases), 205206 Reclaimed land, 29, 178 Reconcentration, 12, 15, 20, 23 Reduction, 22, 48, 283 Reference samples, 32 Remote sensing, 175, 206210, 211, 267, 283 Respirable dust, 215, 218 Respiration, 37, 40, 42 River water, 38, 3940
299
Sample bottles/containers, 25, 42, 80, 112113, 202 Sample storage, 25, 35, 41, 45 organic compounds, 80 metals, 112113 plants, 142 solids, 138139 soils, 146 waste, 160 Sampling, 11, 2425, 32, 35, 41 contaminated land, 154156 gases, 186, 201, 202 particulates, 213, 216224 plants, 135, 142 river, 4146 soils, 146 waste disposal sites, 158160 Sampling positions (soils/ contaminated land), 139, 153 Sampling train, 197, 220 Saponication, 140, 283 Sea water, 23, 37, 38, 39, 136 Seaweed, 136, 168, 263 Sediment/sedimentation, 17, 18, 22, 39, 40, 47, 132, 135, 137, 165168, 173, 235, 256, 257, 263, 283 Selected ion monitoring (SIM), 242 Selenium, 118 Sewage, sewage sludge, sewage works, 12, 47, 112, 135, 137, 165168, 173, 236 Silicates in rivers, 38 particulates, 225 SmithHeiftje background correction (AA), 118 Sodium, 36, 37, 68, 72, 112, 115, 226, 258 Soil samplers, 147 Soils, 135, 136137, 146151, 173 Solid phase extraction, 82, 8385, 93, 95, 103, 260 Solid phase microextraction, 82, 8688, 104, 204, 260 Solid waste, 12, 112 Solubilization (metals), 22 Solvent extraction, 82, 83, 125, 133, 160, 167, 187, 265, 266
300
Sonication (ultrasonic extraction), 160, 170 Soxhlet extraction, 144, 167, 168, 170, 172, 219 Special waste, 156 Speciation, 77, 131133 Spectrometric methods/spectrometry, 28, 46 Spiked samples, 32, 161 Split injection (GC), 92 Split-less injection (GC), 92 Spoil heaps, 4 Stack gas, 283 Standard addition, 117121, 124, 127, 164 Standard gas mixtures, 189 Stationary phases (GC), 9092, 248249 Stratosphere, 13, 283 Strontium, 229 Subsampling, 148 Sulfate ions, 36, 37, 38, 48, 71, 7475, 126, 161, 259 Sulde ions, 22 Sulfur, 148, 229 Sulfur dioxide, 8, 14, 24, 176, 179, 180, 183, 186, 191, 192, 195, 198, 206, 207, 208, 214 Sulfur oxides, 8, 9, 13, 176 Sulfur trioxide, 8, 180, 186 Supercritical uid extraction, 170172 Surface water, 43 Surfactants, 7, 110111 Suspended solids, 39, 4647, 257 Synergism, 24, 214 Tandem mass spectrometry (MSMS), 245 TDLAS (Tuneable Diode Laser Absorption Spectrometry), 210 Temporary hardness, 57 TEOM (Tapered Element Oscillating Microbalance), 222, 223, 224 Teon apparatus, 167, 225 Tenax, 86, 186 Tetrachlorobenzene, 16 2,3,7,8-Tetrachlorodibenzo-p-dioxin, 15, 91, 233251, 269271 Tetrachloroethylene, 17
Index
Water vapour, 180, 196 Weathering, 39, 40 West and Gaeke method, 183 Wet deposition, 224225 Wet sieving, 167 Winkler method, 49 X-ray emission, 229
301
X-ray uorescence spectrometry (XRF), 153, 161, 227229, 231 Xylene(s), 105 Zeeman background correction, 118 Zinc, 21, 37, 57, 112, 115, 127, 133, 136, 229 Zirconium, 229